1 . $Cambridge: exim/doc/doc-docbook/spec.xfpt,v 1.56 2009/10/16 08:46:11 tom Exp $
3 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4 . This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
5 . converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printing and online
6 . formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
7 . The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
9 . WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
10 . adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
11 . unwanted vertical space.
12 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18 . This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
19 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
25 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
26 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
28 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
33 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
34 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
35 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
39 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40 . This generate the outermost <book> element that wraps then entire document.
41 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
45 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
46 . These definitions set some parameters and save some typing. Remember that
47 . the <bookinfo> element must also be updated for each new edition.
48 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
50 .set previousversion "4.69"
53 .set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
54 .set I " "
57 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
58 . Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
59 . provided in the xfpt library.
60 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
62 . --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name
64 .flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
66 . --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
67 . --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be roman.
69 .flag &!! "</emphasis>†<emphasis>"
70 .flag &!? "</emphasis>‡<emphasis>"
72 . --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
73 . --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
74 . --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
84 .itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
85 .row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
89 . --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
90 . --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
91 . --- the small number of other 2-column tables override it.
93 .macro table2 196pt 254pt
94 .itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
97 . --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
98 . --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
99 . --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
103 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
107 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
115 . --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
116 . --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
117 . --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
118 . --- ID that ties them together.
121 &<indexterm role="concept">&
122 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
124 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
130 &<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
131 &<primary>&$2&</primary>&
133 &<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
139 &<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
143 &<indexterm role="option">&
144 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
146 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
152 &<indexterm role="variable">&
153 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
155 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
161 .echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
163 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
166 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
167 . The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for Ascii
169 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
173 <title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
174 <titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
175 <date>09 June 2009</date>
176 <author><firstname>Philip</firstname><surname>Hazel</surname></author>
177 <authorinitials>PH</authorinitials>
178 <affiliation><orgname>University of Cambridge Computing Service</orgname></affiliation>
179 <address>New Museums Site, Pembroke Street, Cambridge CB2 3QH, England</address>
180 <revhistory><revision>
181 <revnumber>4.70</revnumber>
182 <date>10 June 2009</date>
183 <authorinitials>PH</authorinitials>
184 </revision></revhistory>
185 <copyright><year>2009</year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
190 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
191 . This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
192 . "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
193 . at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
194 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
196 .chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
199 <indexterm role="variable">
200 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
201 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
203 <indexterm role="concept">
204 <primary>address</primary>
205 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
206 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
208 <indexterm role="concept">
209 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
210 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
212 <indexterm role="concept">
213 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
214 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
216 <indexterm role="concept">
217 <primary>CR character</primary>
218 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
220 <indexterm role="concept">
221 <primary>CRL</primary>
222 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
224 <indexterm role="concept">
225 <primary>delivery</primary>
226 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
227 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
229 <indexterm role="concept">
230 <primary>dialup</primary>
231 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
233 <indexterm role="concept">
234 <primary>exiscan</primary>
235 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
237 <indexterm role="concept">
238 <primary>failover</primary>
239 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
241 <indexterm role="concept">
242 <primary>fallover</primary>
243 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
245 <indexterm role="concept">
246 <primary>filter</primary>
247 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
248 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
250 <indexterm role="concept">
251 <primary>ident</primary>
252 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
254 <indexterm role="concept">
255 <primary>LF character</primary>
256 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
258 <indexterm role="concept">
259 <primary>maximum</primary>
260 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
262 <indexterm role="concept">
263 <primary>monitor</primary>
264 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
266 <indexterm role="concept">
267 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
268 <see>entry for xxx</see>
270 <indexterm role="concept">
271 <primary>NUL</primary>
272 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
274 <indexterm role="concept">
275 <primary>passwd file</primary>
276 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
278 <indexterm role="concept">
279 <primary>process id</primary>
280 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
282 <indexterm role="concept">
283 <primary>RBL</primary>
284 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
286 <indexterm role="concept">
287 <primary>redirection</primary>
288 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
290 <indexterm role="concept">
291 <primary>return path</primary>
292 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
294 <indexterm role="concept">
295 <primary>scanning</primary>
296 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
298 <indexterm role="concept">
299 <primary>SSL</primary>
300 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
302 <indexterm role="concept">
303 <primary>string</primary>
304 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
305 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
307 <indexterm role="concept">
308 <primary>top bit</primary>
309 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
311 <indexterm role="concept">
312 <primary>variables</primary>
313 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
315 <indexterm role="concept">
316 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
317 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
323 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
324 . This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
325 . we can't have the .chapter line here.
326 . chapter "Introduction"
327 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
329 Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
330 Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
331 run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
332 used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
334 Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
335 BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
336 GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
337 OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
338 Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and Unixware.
339 Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
340 tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
342 There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
343 that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
344 not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
346 The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
347 the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
348 Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
350 The use, supply or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
351 unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of the program,
352 which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
353 of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
354 mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
356 Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
357 experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
358 contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
359 were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
360 new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
362 Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
363 development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
364 systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
365 &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
369 .section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
370 . Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
372 .cindex "documentation"
373 This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version; of Exim.
374 Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
375 renditions of the document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
376 capable of showing a change indicator.
379 This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
380 is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
381 with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
382 and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
383 it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
384 Furthermore, the manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
385 a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
388 .cindex "books about Exim"
389 An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
390 introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
391 SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
392 (&url(http://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
394 This book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
395 Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
396 with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
397 published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
399 .cindex "Debian" "information sources"
400 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
401 Debian-specific features in the file
402 &_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
403 The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
406 .cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
407 .cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
409 As the program develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
410 yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
411 digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
412 new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
413 &_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
415 Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
416 incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
417 they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
418 can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
420 All changes to the program (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
421 change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
423 .cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
424 This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
425 that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
429 .row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
430 .row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
431 .row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
432 .row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
433 .row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
434 .row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
435 .row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
438 The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
439 available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
440 &<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
444 .section "FTP and web sites" "SECID2"
447 The primary site for Exim source distributions is currently the University of
448 Cambridge's FTP site, whose contents are described in &'Where to find the Exim
449 distribution'& below. In addition, there is a web site and an FTP site at
450 &%exim.org%&. These are now also hosted at the University of Cambridge. The
451 &%exim.org%& site was previously hosted for a number of years by Energis
452 Squared, formerly Planet Online Ltd, whose support I gratefully acknowledge.
456 As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim web site contains a number of
457 differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
458 online information is the Exim wiki (&url(http://wiki.exim.org)),
459 which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
460 examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
463 An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(http://bugs.exim.org). You can use
464 this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
465 first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
469 .section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
470 .cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
471 The following Exim mailing lists exist:
474 .row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
475 .row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
476 .row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
477 .row &'exim-future@exim.org'& "Discussion of long-term development"
480 You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
481 or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
482 .cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
483 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
484 the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
487 &url(http://lists.alioth.debian.org/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
489 Please ask Debian-specific questions on this list and not on the general Exim
492 .section "Exim training" "SECID4"
493 .cindex "training courses"
494 Training courses in Cambridge (UK) used to be run annually by the author of
495 Exim, before he retired. At the time of writing, there are no plans to run
496 further Exim courses in Cambridge. However, if that changes, relevant
497 information will be posted at &url(http://www-tus.csx.cam.ac.uk/courses/exim/).
499 .section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
500 .cindex "bug reports"
501 .cindex "reporting bugs"
502 Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
503 via the Bugzilla (&url(http://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
504 whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
505 message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
509 .section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
511 .cindex "distribution" "ftp site"
512 The master ftp site for the Exim distribution is
514 &*ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/email/exim*&
518 &*ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim*&
520 The file references that follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at
521 these sites. There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
522 the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
524 Within the &_exim_& directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
525 previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
526 distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
527 subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
530 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
532 where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The two
533 files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
534 The &_.bz2_& file is usually a lot smaller than the &_.gz_& file.
536 .cindex "distribution" "signing details"
537 .cindex "distribution" "public key"
538 .cindex "public key for signed distribution"
539 The distributions are currently signed with Nigel Metheringham's GPG key. The
540 corresponding public key is available from a number of keyservers, and there is
541 also a copy in the file &_nigel-pubkey.asc_&. The signatures for the tar bundles are
544 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
545 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
547 For each released version, the log of changes is made separately available in a
548 separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
549 find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
551 .cindex "documentation" "available formats"
552 The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
553 documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
554 inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
556 &_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
557 &_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
558 &_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
559 &_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
561 These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
562 distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& as well as &_.gz_& forms.
565 .section "Limitations" "SECID6"
567 .cindex "limitations of Exim"
568 .cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
569 Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
570 RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
571 simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
572 configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
573 UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
575 .cindex "domainless addresses"
576 .cindex "address" "without domain"
577 Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
578 local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
579 configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
580 systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
583 .cindex "transport" "external"
584 .cindex "external transports"
585 The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
586 and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
587 transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
588 and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
589 to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
590 handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
592 Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
593 such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
594 (that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
597 Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
598 are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
599 are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
600 compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
601 a number of common scanners are provided.
605 .section "Run time configuration" "SECID7"
606 Exim's run time configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
607 into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
608 values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
609 file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
610 distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
613 .section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
614 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
615 Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
616 can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
617 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
618 about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
619 Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
620 example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages on the queue) do so in Exim's own
621 format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
622 3, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
623 documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
624 made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
626 Control of messages on the queue can be done via certain privileged command
627 line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
628 which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
629 interface to Exim's command line administration options.
633 .section "Terminology" "SECID9"
634 .cindex "terminology definitions"
635 .cindex "body of message" "definition of"
636 The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
637 It is the last part of a message, and is separated from the &'header'& (see
638 below) by a blank line.
640 .cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
641 When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
642 delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
643 &'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
644 called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
645 failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
646 message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
647 rise to further bounce messages.
649 The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
650 value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
651 also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
654 The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
655 destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
656 down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
659 The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
660 host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
661 the part of an email address following the @ sign.
663 .cindex "envelope, definition of"
664 .cindex "sender" "definition of"
665 A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
666 body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
667 be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
668 sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
669 envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
670 messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
672 .cindex "message" "header, definition of"
673 .cindex "header section" "definition of"
674 The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
675 of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
676 &'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
677 indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
680 .cindex "local part" "definition of"
681 .cindex "domain" "definition of"
682 The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to that
683 part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
684 @ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
686 .cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
687 .cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
688 The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
689 delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
690 TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
691 host it is running on are &'remote'&.
693 .cindex "return path" "definition of"
694 &'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
697 .cindex "queue" "definition of"
698 The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery,
699 because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
700 Exim's case the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
701 normally no ordering of waiting messages.
703 .cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
704 The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
705 and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
706 is used by other MTAs, and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
707 the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
709 .cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
710 The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
711 messages on its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
712 delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
713 mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
714 the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
721 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
722 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
724 .chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
725 .cindex "incorporated code"
726 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
728 A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
731 Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
732 Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
733 © University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE is no longer shipped with
734 Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE shipped with your system,
735 or obtain and install the full version of the library from
736 &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
738 .cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
739 Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
740 contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
741 Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
742 It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
743 following statements:
746 Copyright © 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
748 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
749 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
750 Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
752 This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
753 the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
754 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
755 some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
756 restrictions applied to it).
759 .cindex "SPA authentication"
760 .cindex "Samba project"
761 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
762 Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
763 by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
764 Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
768 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
769 .cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
770 Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
771 by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
772 Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
773 conditions expressed therein.
776 Copyright © 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
778 Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
779 modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
783 Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
784 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
786 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
787 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
788 the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
791 The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
792 endorse or promote products derived from this software without
793 prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
794 details, please contact
796 Office of Technology Transfer
797 Carnegie Mellon University
799 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
800 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
801 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
804 Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
807 &"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
808 at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(http://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
810 CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
811 THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
812 AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
813 FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
814 WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
815 AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
816 OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
821 .cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
824 The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
825 modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
826 This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
827 below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
830 Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
831 and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
835 Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
836 documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
837 provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
838 both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
839 supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
840 used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
841 software without specific, written prior permission.
843 DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
844 ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
845 DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
846 ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
847 WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
848 ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
853 Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
854 not covered by any specific licence requirements. It is assumed that the
855 contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
862 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
863 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
865 .chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
866 "Receiving and delivering mail"
869 .section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
870 .cindex "design philosophy"
871 Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
872 to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
873 most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
874 maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
875 it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
876 has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
879 .section "Policy control" "SECID11"
880 .cindex "policy control" "overview"
881 Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
882 Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs being abused as
883 &"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
884 unsolicited junk, and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
885 facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
888 .cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
889 Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
890 incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
891 series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
892 several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
893 host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
894 very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
895 rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
896 two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
899 An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
900 case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
902 When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
903 provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
904 spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
905 which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
907 When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
908 host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
909 function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
910 whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
911 is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
913 Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
914 software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
915 Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
917 After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
918 the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
919 runs at the start of every delivery process.
924 .section "User filters" "SECID12"
925 .cindex "filter" "introduction"
926 .cindex "Sieve filter"
927 In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
928 setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
929 chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
930 configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
931 &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
932 of filtering are available:
935 Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
938 Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
939 powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
942 User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
946 .section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
947 .cindex "message ids" "details of format"
948 .cindex "format" "of message id"
949 .cindex "id of message"
954 Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
955 characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
956 example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
957 normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
958 system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
959 (avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
960 id is used to construct file names, and the names of files in those systems are
961 not always case-sensitive.
963 .cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
964 The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
965 Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
966 within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
967 be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
968 the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
972 The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
973 started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
974 contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
975 way of representing the date and time of day).
977 After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
978 received the message.
980 There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
982 .oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
983 If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
984 time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
985 that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
986 systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
988 If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
989 the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
994 After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
995 appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
996 received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
997 pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
998 will already have ticked while the message was being received.
1001 .section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1002 .cindex "receiving mail"
1003 .cindex "message" "reception"
1004 The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1005 TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1006 SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1007 there are several possibilities:
1010 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1011 non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1012 command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1014 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1015 non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1016 the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1017 command. This is so-called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1018 but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1019 envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1021 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1022 interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1023 passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1024 This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1025 example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1027 A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1028 (127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1029 does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1030 in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1034 .cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1035 .cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1036 In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1037 constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1038 qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1039 option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1040 SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1041 certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender address
1042 unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1043 address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1044 different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1045 users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1046 users to change sender addresses.
1048 Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1049 checking by the non-SMTP ACL, if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1050 (either over TCP/IP, or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1051 number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1052 individual recipients, or the entire message, can be rejected if local policy
1053 requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1054 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1056 Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1057 received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1058 connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1059 queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1060 configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1061 message is received.
1067 .section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1068 .cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1069 .cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1070 When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1071 first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1072 the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1073 the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1074 file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1076 .cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1077 By default all these message files are held in a single directory called
1078 &_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1079 not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1080 improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1081 used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1082 whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1083 processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1084 overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1085 affect file system performance.
1087 The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1088 the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1089 any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1090 a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1091 first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1093 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1094 Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1095 (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1096 both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1097 If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1098 example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1099 generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1100 rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1101 different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1102 addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1103 delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1104 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1108 .section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1109 .cindex "message" "life of"
1110 .cindex "message" "frozen"
1111 A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1112 its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1113 administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1114 cannot proceed &-- for example, when a message can neither be delivered to its
1115 recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1116 spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1118 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1119 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1120 An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1121 corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1122 addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1125 .oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1126 .oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1127 There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1128 &%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1129 The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to any frozen messages.
1131 .cindex "message" "log file for"
1132 .cindex "log" "file for each message"
1133 While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1134 attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1135 delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1136 lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1137 These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator, and are normally
1138 deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1139 The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1140 &%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1143 .cindex "journal file"
1144 .cindex "file" "journal"
1145 All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1146 spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1147 address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1148 message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1149 addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1150 is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1151 Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1152 minimize the possibility of data loss.
1154 Should the system or the program crash after a successful delivery but before
1155 the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1156 time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1157 updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1158 deliveries caused by crashes.
1162 .section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1163 .cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1164 .cindex "router" "definition of"
1165 .cindex "transport" "definition of"
1166 The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1167 &'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1168 number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1169 specify which ones are included in the binary. Run time options specify which
1170 ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1172 .cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1173 Each driver that is specified in the run time configuration is an &'instance'&
1174 of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1175 you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1176 option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1177 instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1178 instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1179 configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1180 the driver's features in general.
1182 A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1183 its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1184 converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1185 alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1188 A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1189 spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1190 transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1191 &'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1192 to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1193 several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1195 .cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1196 An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1197 turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1198 specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1199 detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1200 address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1202 To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1203 routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1204 routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1207 The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1208 addresses in domains that are not recognized specially by the local host. These
1209 are typically addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1210 is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1211 its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1212 match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1213 find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1214 assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1215 configured to fail the address.
1217 The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1218 &"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1219 aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1220 original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1221 router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1222 address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1224 The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1225 address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1226 see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1227 local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1228 the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1229 the address is bounced.
1233 .section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1234 .cindex "router" "for verification"
1235 .cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1236 As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1237 are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1238 one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1239 sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1240 &%-bvs%& command line options.
1242 When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1243 does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1244 detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1245 when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1246 sends all messages to a message-scanning program, unless they have been
1247 previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1248 checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1249 would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1254 .section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1255 .cindex "router" "running details"
1256 .cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1257 .cindex "router" "result of running"
1258 As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1259 running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1260 passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1261 the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1265 &'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1266 transport, or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1267 original address ceases,
1268 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
1269 unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1270 can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1271 for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1272 passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1275 Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1276 starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1277 setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1278 child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1279 &%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1281 &'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1282 requests that the address be passed to another router. By default the address
1283 is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1284 &%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1285 must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1287 &'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1288 recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1289 this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1290 set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1291 &'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1293 &'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1294 the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1295 original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1297 &'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1298 database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1299 processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1300 next time the message is considered for delivery.
1302 &'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1303 its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1306 If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1307 any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1308 situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1309 making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1310 router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1312 Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1313 met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1314 You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1315 when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1316 facility for this purpose.
1319 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1320 .cindex "case of local parts"
1321 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1322 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
1323 Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1324 and remote transports, and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1325 check, local parts are treated as case-sensitive. This happens only when
1326 actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1327 routed addresses are shown.
1331 .section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1332 .cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1333 .cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1334 The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1335 order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1336 described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1339 The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1340 the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1341 suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1342 skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1343 removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1344 of any other conditions.
1346 Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1347 only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1348 &%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1350 Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1351 &%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1352 sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1353 you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1355 If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1356 run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1357 when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1358 makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1359 having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1361 Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1362 opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1364 Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1365 check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1367 If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1368 of domains that it defines.
1370 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1371 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
1372 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1373 If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1374 the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1375 &%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1376 part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1377 that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1378 that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&, and
1379 &$local_part_suffix$& as necessary.
1381 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1382 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1384 If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1385 an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1386 local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1387 user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1388 remaining preconditions.
1390 If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1391 because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1392 later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1393 subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1394 could lead to confusion.
1396 If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1397 set of addresses that it defines.
1399 If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1400 specified files is tested.
1402 .cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1403 If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1404 uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1405 Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1409 Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1410 it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1411 part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1412 &%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1413 &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1414 going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1415 example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1419 .section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1420 .cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1421 When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1424 If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1425 filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1426 message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1427 fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1428 files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1430 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1431 (&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1433 Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1434 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1435 filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1436 if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1437 be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1438 condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1441 Each recipient address is offered to each configured router in turn, subject to
1442 its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1443 address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1444 can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1445 processed entirely independently of each other.
1447 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
1448 .cindex "loop" "while routing"
1449 A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1450 transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1451 is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1452 Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1453 from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1454 process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1455 which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1457 When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1458 handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1459 doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1460 local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1461 collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1462 addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1463 address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1464 addresses to the same domain.
1466 Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1467 non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1468 deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1469 to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1470 run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1471 one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1472 The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1473 deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1475 .cindex "queue runner"
1476 When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1477 database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1478 address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1479 Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1480 reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1481 queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1482 follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1483 better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1484 causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1486 .cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1487 Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1488 deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1489 retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1490 reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1491 not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1493 If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1494 appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1495 for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1496 messages to other addresses.
1498 .cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1499 If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1500 the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1503 When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1504 handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1505 deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1511 .section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1512 .cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1513 .cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1514 .cindex "queue runner"
1515 Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1516 attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1517 uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1518 intervals, or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1519 not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1520 first attempt will remain on your queue for ever. A queue runner process works
1521 its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1522 passed its retry time.
1523 You can run several queue runners at once.
1525 Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1526 address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1527 should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1528 bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1529 error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1534 .section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1535 .cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1536 There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1537 particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1538 connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1539 detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1540 Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1541 is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1542 impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1545 If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1546 waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1547 connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1550 .cindex "hints database"
1551 Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1552 SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1553 for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1554 connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1560 .section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1561 .cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1562 .cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1563 When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1564 bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1565 errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1566 delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1567 many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1568 attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1569 message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1570 See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1572 .cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1573 Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1574 failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1577 .cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1578 A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1579 obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1580 address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1581 forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1582 failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1583 &<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1588 .section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1589 .cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1590 If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1591 itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left on the queue,
1592 but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1593 that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1594 for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1595 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1601 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1602 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1604 .chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1605 .scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1607 .section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1608 Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1609 creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1610 &_exim-&version;_&) into which the following files are placed:
1613 .irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1614 .irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1616 .irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1617 .irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1618 .irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1619 .irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1623 Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1624 following subdirectories are created:
1627 .irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1628 .irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1629 .irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1630 .irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1631 .irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1632 .irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1633 .irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1636 The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory, and are built
1637 with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1638 that may be useful to some sites.
1641 .section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1642 .cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1643 The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1644 a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1645 source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1646 Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1648 .cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1649 Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1650 the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1651 architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1652 overridden if necessary.
1655 .section "PCRE library" "SECTpcre"
1656 .cindex "PCRE library"
1657 Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
1658 modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need
1659 to install the PCRE or PCRE development package for your operating
1660 system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
1661 process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1662 headers are in an unusual location you will need to set the PCRE_LIBS
1663 and INCLUDE directives appropriately. If your operating system has no
1664 PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
1665 from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
1667 .section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1668 .cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1669 .cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1670 Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1671 DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1672 databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1673 different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1675 .cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1676 .cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1677 .cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1678 .cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1679 If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1680 Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1681 may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1682 you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1684 .cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1685 Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1686 via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1687 versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1688 some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1689 distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1690 versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1691 Berkeley DB library.
1693 Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1694 use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1698 A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1699 Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1701 .cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1702 The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1703 compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1704 &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1705 file name is used unmodified.
1707 .cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1708 The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1709 operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1710 programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1712 If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1713 file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1714 the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1716 To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1717 Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
1718 2.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions are now
1719 numbered 4.&'x'&. Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All
1720 versions of Berkeley DB can be obtained from
1721 &url(http://www.sleepycat.com/).
1723 .cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1724 Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1725 &url(http://download.sourceforge.net/tdb). It has its own interface, and also
1726 operates on a single file.
1730 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1731 Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1732 to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1733 USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1734 &_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1738 Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1739 error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1741 At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1742 thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1743 configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1744 Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1745 configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1746 &_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1748 As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1749 necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1750 in one of these lines:
1755 Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1756 place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1757 the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1758 file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1761 INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1762 DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1764 There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1765 file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1769 .section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1770 .cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1771 .cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1772 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1773 .cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1774 Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1775 independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1776 &_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1777 &_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1778 therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1779 building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1780 &_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1782 There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1783 without them. They are the location of the run time configuration file
1784 (CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1785 (BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1786 maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1787 a colon-separated list of file names; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1789 There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1790 at run time, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1791 machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1792 directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1793 you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at run time, so that errors
1794 detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1797 .cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1798 Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1799 access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1800 facilities, you need to set
1802 WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1804 in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1805 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1808 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1809 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1810 If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1811 required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1812 your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1813 happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1814 &_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1816 This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1817 operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1818 to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1819 configuration files, for example to change the name of the C compiler, which
1820 defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1825 .section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1826 .cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1828 The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1829 described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1830 in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1831 character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1832 mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1833 (default ISO-8859-1). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1834 supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1836 However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1837 very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1838 &url(http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1839 systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1840 &[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1844 to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1848 .section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1849 .cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1850 .cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1851 .cindex "SUPPORT_TLS"
1852 .cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1853 .cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1854 Exim can be built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1855 command as per RFC 2487. It can also support legacy clients that expect to
1856 start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1857 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1860 If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1861 OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1864 If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1867 TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1869 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1870 OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1873 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1874 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1876 .cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1877 If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1881 TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1883 in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1884 library and include files. For example:
1888 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1889 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1891 You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1892 specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1893 given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1898 .section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1899 .cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1900 .cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1901 Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1902 SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1903 alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1904 already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1905 should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1906 &_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1907 &_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1908 EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1911 USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1912 CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1913 EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1915 in &_Local/Makefile_&. The name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control files is
1916 &"exim"&. For example, the line
1918 exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1920 in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1921 the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1922 All other connections are denied. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
1927 .section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
1928 .cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
1929 Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1930 &`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1931 it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
1932 where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
1935 Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
1936 defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
1937 currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
1938 as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
1939 over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&. It is not known
1940 if anyone is actually using A6 records. Exim has support for A6 records, but
1941 this is included only if you set &`SUPPORT_A6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
1942 support has not been tested for some time.
1946 .section "The building process" "SECID29"
1947 .cindex "build directory"
1948 Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
1949 created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
1950 operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
1951 For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
1952 &_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
1953 .cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
1954 Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
1956 &*Warning*&: The &%-j%& (parallel) flag must not be used with &'make'&; the
1957 building process fails if it is set.
1959 If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
1960 a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
1961 &_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
1962 &'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
1963 then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
1964 number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
1965 makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
1966 directory, should this ever be necessary.
1968 If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
1969 &_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
1970 FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
1974 .section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
1975 The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
1976 unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
1977 output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
1978 appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
1979 each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
1980 get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
1984 The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
1985 command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
1986 given in addition to the short output.
1990 .section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
1991 .cindex "build-time options, overriding"
1992 The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
1993 consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
1994 values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
1995 more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
1996 convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
1999 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2000 &_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2002 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2003 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2004 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2005 &_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2007 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2008 .cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2009 .cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2010 where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2011 architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2012 process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2013 and are often not needed.
2015 The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2016 called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2017 the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2018 values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2019 Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2020 fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2021 of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2022 that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2023 to find out what values are being used on your system.
2026 &_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2027 therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2028 needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2029 file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2033 .cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2034 If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2035 or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2036 need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2037 putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2038 .cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2039 when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2040 formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2041 compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2042 called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2043 Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2044 default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2045 containing the lines
2050 If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2051 these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2053 Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2054 files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2055 the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2058 .cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2059 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2060 .cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2061 .cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2062 Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2063 lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2064 not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2065 and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2066 which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2067 case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2073 and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2074 &_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2075 libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2076 .cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2077 However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2078 the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2079 files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2080 binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause run time configuration
2083 .cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2084 Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2085 subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2089 must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2090 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2092 .cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2093 The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2094 operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2095 with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2096 monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2097 The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2100 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2101 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2103 These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2104 example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2107 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2108 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2110 If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2111 definition of all three of these variables into your
2112 &_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2115 If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2116 variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2117 default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2118 command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2120 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2121 There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2122 use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2123 EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2124 binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2127 .cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2128 The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2129 files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2130 necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2131 &_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2134 .section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2136 .cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2137 The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2138 &_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2139 normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2140 recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2141 are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2145 .section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2146 .cindex "building Eximon"
2147 A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2148 where the files that are involved are
2150 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2151 &_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2152 &_Local/eximon.conf_&
2153 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2154 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2155 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2157 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2158 As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2159 &_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2160 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2161 variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2162 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2163 LOG_DEPTH at run time.
2167 .section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2168 .cindex "installing Exim"
2169 .cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2170 The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2171 arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2172 whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2173 .cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2174 The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2175 going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2176 &'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2177 install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2178 some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2179 it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2180 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2182 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2183 Exim's run time configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2184 in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2185 exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2186 by the installation script. If a run time configuration file already exists, it
2187 is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2188 alternative files, no default is installed.
2190 .cindex "system aliases file"
2191 .cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2192 One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2193 default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2194 The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2195 SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2196 If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2197 and outputs a comment to the user.
2199 The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2200 aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2201 kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2202 &_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2203 Exim's configuration if necessary.
2205 The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2206 and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2207 running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2208 directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2209 other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2212 It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2213 distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2216 make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2218 This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2219 paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2220 configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2221 For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2222 but this usage is deprecated.
2224 .cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2225 Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2226 &'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2227 upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2228 directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2229 INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2231 For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2232 to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2233 installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2234 for example &_exim-&version;-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2235 called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2236 of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2237 from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2239 .cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2240 If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2241 real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2244 make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2246 The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2247 script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2248 the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2249 directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2252 (cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2254 .cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2255 There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2258 &%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2259 to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2261 &%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2265 INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2267 make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2269 The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2270 to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2271 without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2273 make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2278 .section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2279 .cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2280 Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2281 reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2282 distribution. Instead it is available separately from the ftp site (see section
2285 If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2286 source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2287 install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2291 .section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2292 .cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2293 When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2294 exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2295 directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2301 .section "Testing" "SECID34"
2302 .cindex "testing" "installation"
2303 Having installed Exim, you can check that the run time configuration file is
2304 syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2305 Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2309 If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2310 Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2311 the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2312 other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2313 Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2316 &`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2318 should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2320 &`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2322 a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2323 This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2324 user agent. For example:
2326 exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2327 From: user@your.domain.example
2328 To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2329 Subject: Testing Exim
2331 This is a test message.
2334 The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2335 In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2336 arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2338 .cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2339 If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2340 &'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2341 of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2342 &%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2343 with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2345 &`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2347 You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2348 produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2349 For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2350 relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2351 &<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2353 .cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2354 .cindex "lock files"
2355 One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2356 local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2357 &"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2358 writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2359 is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2360 directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2361 that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2362 &(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2363 approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2364 &[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2365 agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2366 see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2368 One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2369 the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2370 &%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2371 port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2372 &'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2375 Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2376 be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2377 within the run time configuration, all other file and directory names
2378 that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2382 .section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2383 .cindex "replacing another MTA"
2384 Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2385 general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2386 is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2387 operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2388 binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2389 normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2390 or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2391 .cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2392 a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2393 privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2394 and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2396 .cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2397 .cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2398 Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2399 example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2400 &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2401 described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2404 sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2405 send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2406 mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2407 newaliases /usr/bin/true
2409 Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2410 your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2411 favourite user agent.
2413 You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2414 have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2415 various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2416 command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2417 use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2418 &'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2422 .section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2423 .cindex "upgrading Exim"
2424 If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2425 version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2426 call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2427 to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2428 new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2429 version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2435 .section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2436 .cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2437 The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2439 /etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2441 If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2442 fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2443 for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2444 (that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2445 solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2447 pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2449 to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2451 Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2452 still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2453 (the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2458 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2459 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2461 .chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2462 .scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2463 .scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2464 Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2465 each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2466 options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2467 some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2468 combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2469 The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2472 .section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2474 If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2475 were present before any other options.
2476 The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2478 This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2479 that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2480 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2483 If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2484 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2485 &%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2489 If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2490 &%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2491 Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2494 .cindex "queue runner"
2495 If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2496 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2497 option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2499 .cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2500 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2501 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2502 If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2503 &%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2504 This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2505 the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2506 command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2509 .section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2510 Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2511 available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2512 user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2513 EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2514 &%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2517 .cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2518 .cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2519 The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2520 &%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2521 supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2522 configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2524 .cindex '&"From"& line'
2525 .cindex "envelope sender"
2526 Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2527 &"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2528 Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2529 See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2530 users to set envelope senders.
2532 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
2533 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
2534 For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2535 header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2536 &'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2538 Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2539 protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2540 locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2541 have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2542 users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2543 that are available to trusted users.
2545 .cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2546 .cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2547 The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2548 Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2549 The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2551 Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2552 operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2553 necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2554 the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2556 By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2557 Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2558 However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2559 option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2561 Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2562 is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2567 &*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2568 edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2569 getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2575 .section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2576 Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2577 of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2578 a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2579 format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2580 on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2581 with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2582 outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2584 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2585 . Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2586 . options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2587 . creates a man page for the options.
2588 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2591 <!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2598 .cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2599 This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2600 therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2601 rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2604 .oindex "&%--help%&"
2605 This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2606 The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2609 .vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2611 .cindex "8-bit characters"
2612 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2613 This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2614 clean; it ignores this option.
2619 .cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2620 .cindex "queue runner"
2621 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2622 the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2623 that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2625 The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2626 (debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2627 disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2628 stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2630 By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2631 all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2632 ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2633 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2635 When a listening daemon
2636 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2637 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2638 is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2639 configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2640 in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2641 PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2644 When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2645 process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2646 used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2650 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2651 can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2652 whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2653 means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2654 of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2655 referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2656 because these are reread each time they are used.
2660 This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2661 from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2665 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2666 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2667 Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2668 prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2669 files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2670 of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2672 If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2673 to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2674 used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2675 function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2676 test data. A line history is supported.
2678 Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2679 continuations. As in Exim's run time configuration, white space at the start of
2680 continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2681 string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2682 configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2683 message-specific values (such as &$sender_domain$&) are set, because no message
2684 is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2686 &*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2687 files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2688 the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2689 of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2691 .vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2693 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2694 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2695 This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2696 of a file. For example:
2698 exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2700 The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2701 message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2702 variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2703 no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2704 recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2705 &$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2706 line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2709 .vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2711 .cindex "system filter" "testing"
2712 .cindex "testing" "system filter"
2713 This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2714 tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2715 system filters are recognized.
2717 .vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2719 .cindex "filter" "testing"
2720 .cindex "testing" "filter file"
2721 .cindex "forward file" "testing"
2722 .cindex "testing" "forward file"
2723 .cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2724 This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2725 to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2726 there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2729 If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2730 can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2731 filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2733 exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2735 This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2736 variables that are used by the user filter.
2738 If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2743 it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2744 that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2745 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2748 The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2749 detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2750 with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2751 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2753 When testing a filter file,
2754 .cindex "&""From""& line"
2755 .cindex "envelope sender"
2756 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2757 the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2758 or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2759 that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2760 can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2763 .vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2765 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2766 This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2767 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2770 .vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2772 This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2773 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2774 process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2775 suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2776 actually being delivered.
2778 .vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2780 This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2781 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2784 .vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2786 This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2787 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2790 .vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2792 .cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2793 .cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2794 .cindex "testing" "relay control"
2795 .cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2796 .cindex "policy control" "testing"
2797 .cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2798 This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2799 standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2800 after a full stop. For example:
2802 exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2803 exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2805 When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2806 of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2807 conversion to the canonical form is
2808 &`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2810 Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2811 include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2812 This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2813 messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2814 test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2818 You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2819 information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2820 an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2823 &*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2824 are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2825 occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2827 Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2828 written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2829 lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2830 can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2831 and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2832 session were authenticated.
2834 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2835 output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2836 acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2838 Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2839 plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2840 specialized SMTP test program such as
2841 &url(http://jetmore.org/john/code/#swaks,swaks).
2843 .vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2845 This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
2846 verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2847 updating the callout cache database.
2851 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2852 .cindex "building alias file"
2853 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
2854 Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2855 Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2856 this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
2857 tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
2860 If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
2861 configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
2862 the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
2863 The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
2864 use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
2865 if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
2870 .cindex "local message reception"
2871 This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
2872 locally-generated message on the current input. The recipients are given as the
2873 command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
2874 argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
2875 default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
2876 if no other conflicting option is present.
2878 If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
2879 qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
2880 options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
2881 suppressing this for special cases.
2883 Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
2884 the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
2886 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
2887 The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
2888 action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
2891 .cindex "message" "format"
2892 .cindex "format" "message"
2893 .cindex "&""From""& line"
2894 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
2895 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
2896 of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
2897 compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
2899 From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
2900 From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
2902 (with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
2903 is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
2904 authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
2905 matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
2906 option, which can be changed if necessary.
2908 .oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
2909 The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
2910 &%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
2911 preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
2912 trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
2916 .cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
2917 By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
2918 without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
2919 is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
2920 envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
2921 &%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
2922 defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
2924 Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
2925 being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
2926 content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
2927 header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
2928 syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
2930 The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
2931 messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
2932 addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
2933 unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
2938 .cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
2939 .cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
2940 If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
2941 main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
2942 of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
2943 arguments, for example:
2945 exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
2947 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
2948 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
2949 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
2950 However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
2951 configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
2952 users, the output is as in this example:
2954 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
2956 If &%configure_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the run time
2957 configuration file is output.
2958 If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
2959 is the name of the file that was actually used.
2961 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2962 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2963 If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
2964 directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
2965 respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
2966 sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
2967 written directly into the spool directory.
2969 If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
2971 exim -bP +local_domains
2973 it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
2974 local part) and outputs what it finds.
2976 .cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
2977 .cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
2978 If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
2979 followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
2980 that driver are output. For example:
2982 exim -bP transport local_delivery
2984 The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
2985 options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
2986 using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
2987 &%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
2988 settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
2994 .cindex "queue" "listing messages on"
2995 .cindex "listing" "messages on the queue"
2996 This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2997 standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
2998 just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
2999 admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3000 to allow any user to see the queue.
3002 Each message on the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3004 25m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3005 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3008 .cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3009 .cindex "size" "of message"
3010 The first line contains the length of time the message has been on the queue
3011 (in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3012 identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3013 envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3014 &"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3015 the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3016 before the sender address.
3018 .cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3019 If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3020 &"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3022 The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3023 displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3024 been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3025 expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3026 displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3032 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3033 that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3034 alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3040 .cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3041 This option counts the number of messages on the queue, and writes the total
3042 to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3043 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3048 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3049 chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3050 lots of messages on the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3051 going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3055 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3059 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3064 This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3065 addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3066 forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3067 router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3072 .cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3073 .cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3074 This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3075 arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3076 and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3078 exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3079 Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3081 See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3082 argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3083 &'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3084 contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3085 retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3086 with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3087 rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3088 sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3089 used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3091 exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3092 Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3097 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3098 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3099 This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3100 a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3101 complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3102 would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3103 &<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3107 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3108 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
3109 This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3110 for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3111 submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3112 input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3113 input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3114 &%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3115 believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3117 The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3118 dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3119 provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3121 As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3122 messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3123 Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3124 &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3126 Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3127 as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3128 QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3130 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3131 If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3132 error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3133 was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3134 was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3136 More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3137 &<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3141 .cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3142 .cindex "local SMTP input"
3143 This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3144 on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3145 policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3146 Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3147 messages to the MTA.
3150 .cindex "sender" "source of"
3151 this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3152 set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3153 Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3154 the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3155 &%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3156 &%-bnq%& option is used.
3160 &%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3161 using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3162 whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3163 &'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3164 above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3165 Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3166 the listening daemon.
3170 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
3171 .cindex "address" "testing"
3172 This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3173 as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3174 written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3175 user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3176 sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3178 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3179 right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3181 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3182 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3185 Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3186 (compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3187 written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3188 &%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3189 genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3192 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3193 The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3194 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3195 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3197 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
3198 &*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3199 addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3200 This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3203 &*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3204 routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3206 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3207 you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3208 &%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3209 default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3210 whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3211 those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3216 .cindex "version number of Exim"
3217 This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3218 number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3219 It also lists the DBM library this is being used, the optional modules (such as
3220 specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3221 name of the run time configuration file that is in use.
3223 As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3224 configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3225 values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3226 detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3227 alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3228 realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3229 dynamic testing facilities.
3233 .cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3234 .cindex "address" "verification"
3235 This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3236 taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3237 not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3238 happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3239 (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3240 including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3242 If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3243 failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3244 usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3246 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3247 right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3249 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3250 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3253 Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3254 that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3255 router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3256 verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3257 address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3259 If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3260 address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3261 latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3262 causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3263 addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3264 and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3267 When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3268 and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3269 considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3272 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3273 return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3274 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3275 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3277 If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3278 address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3279 sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3280 calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3284 This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3285 than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3288 .vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3290 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3291 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3292 .cindex "alternate configuration file"
3293 This option causes Exim to find the run time configuration file from the given
3294 list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3295 compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single file
3296 name, but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3297 file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3298 proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3300 When this option is used by a caller other than root or the Exim user, and the
3301 list is different from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege
3302 immediately, and runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of
3303 the caller. However, if ALT_CONFIG_ROOT_ONLY is defined in
3304 &_Local/Makefile_&, root privilege is retained for &%-C%& only if the caller of
3307 That is, the Exim user is no longer privileged in this regard. This build-time
3308 option is not set by default in the Exim source distribution tarbundle.
3309 However, if you are using a &"packaged"& version of Exim (source or binary),
3310 the packagers might have enabled it.
3312 Setting ALT_CONFIG_ROOT_ONLY locks out the possibility of testing a
3313 configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery, even
3314 if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is running
3315 as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the delivery,
3316 the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception
3317 and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message on the queue,
3318 using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3320 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3321 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3322 must start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3323 However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3324 CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3325 usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3326 unset, any file name can be used with &%-C%&.
3328 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3329 to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3330 broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3333 The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3334 syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3335 caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3336 require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3337 specified by this option.
3339 .vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3341 .cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3342 This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3343 (see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3344 unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3345 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3346 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3348 The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3349 command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3350 string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3356 To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3357 quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3360 exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3362 &%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3364 .vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3366 .cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3367 .cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3368 This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3369 error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3370 database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3371 filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3372 writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3375 When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3376 standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3377 some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3378 made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3379 of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3380 debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3381 no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3384 &`acl `& ACL interpretation
3385 &`auth `& authenticators
3386 &`deliver `& general delivery logic
3387 &`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3388 &`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3389 &`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3390 &`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3391 &`filter `& filter handling
3392 &`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3393 &`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3394 &`ident `& ident lookup
3395 &`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3396 &`lists `& matching things in lists
3397 &`load `& system load checks
3398 &`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3399 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3400 &`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3401 &`memory `& memory handling
3402 &`pid `& add pid to debug output lines
3403 &`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3404 &`queue_run `& queue runs
3405 &`receive `& general message reception logic
3406 &`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3407 &`retry `& retry handling
3408 &`rewrite `& address rewriting
3409 &`route `& address routing
3410 &`timestamp `& add timestamp to debug output lines
3412 &`transport `& transports
3413 &`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3414 &`verify `& address verification logic
3415 &`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3417 The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3418 for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3419 tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3420 is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3421 generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3422 turn everything off.
3424 .cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3425 .cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3426 The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3427 with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3428 unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3431 The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3432 &`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3433 However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3434 daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3435 automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3438 The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3439 of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3442 If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3443 any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3445 .vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3447 This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3448 starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3449 subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3450 behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3453 .oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3454 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3455 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3456 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3460 .cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3461 This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3462 failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3463 and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3464 generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3465 could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3466 follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3467 new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3470 .oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3471 There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3472 called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3473 example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3474 form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3476 .vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3478 .cindex "sender" "name"
3479 .cindex "name" "of sender"
3480 This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3481 message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3482 entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3483 their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3484 between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3486 .vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3488 .cindex "sender" "address"
3489 .cindex "address" "sender"
3490 .cindex "trusted users"
3491 .cindex "envelope sender"
3492 .cindex "user" "trusted"
3493 This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3494 message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3495 by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3498 Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3499 trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3500 options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3501 of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3504 There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3505 can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3506 never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3507 string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3508 examples of shell commands:
3510 exim -f '<>' user@domain
3511 exim -f "" user@domain
3513 In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3514 with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3517 Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3518 it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3519 refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3520 though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3523 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3524 space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3525 given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3526 locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3527 &"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3528 if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3532 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-G%& option ignored"
3533 This is a Sendmail option which is ignored by Exim.
3535 .vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3537 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3538 This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3539 Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3544 .cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3545 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3546 This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3547 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3548 no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3549 command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3551 .vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3553 .cindex "forcing delivery"
3554 .cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3555 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3556 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3557 any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3558 delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3559 and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3562 .cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3563 hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3564 the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3565 to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3566 which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3567 for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3569 The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3570 not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3571 produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3572 use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3574 .vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3576 .cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3577 .cindex "recipient" "adding"
3578 This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3579 message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3580 id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3581 active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3582 can be used only by an admin user.
3584 .vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3585 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3587 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3588 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3589 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3590 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3591 by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3592 an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3593 given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3594 must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3598 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3599 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3600 connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3604 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3605 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3606 which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3608 .vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3610 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3611 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3612 started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3613 together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3614 signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3615 messages through the same SMTP connection.
3619 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3620 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3621 SMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3626 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3627 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3628 host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3630 .vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3632 .cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3633 .cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3634 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn,
3635 but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3636 that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3637 provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3638 order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3639 However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3640 respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3641 overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3642 If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3643 &%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3644 and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3646 .vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3648 .cindex "message" "changing sender"
3649 .cindex "sender" "changing"
3650 This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3651 given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3652 &"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3653 be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3654 is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3655 This option can be used only by an admin user.
3657 .vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3659 .cindex "freezing messages"
3660 .cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3661 This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3662 prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3663 either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3664 However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3665 attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3668 .vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3670 .cindex "giving up on messages"
3671 .cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3672 .cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3673 This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3674 including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3675 their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3676 is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3677 Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3680 .vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3682 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
3683 This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3684 as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
3685 message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3686 altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3688 .vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3690 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
3691 .cindex "recipient" "removing"
3692 .cindex "removing recipients"
3693 This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
3694 (&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
3695 the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
3696 addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
3697 (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
3698 can be used only by an admin user.
3700 .vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3702 .cindex "removing messages"
3703 .cindex "abandoning mail"
3704 .cindex "message" "manually discarding"
3705 This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
3706 bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
3707 the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
3708 only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
3709 placed on the queue.
3711 .vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3713 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
3714 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
3715 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
3716 string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
3717 the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
3718 &$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
3719 available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
3720 make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
3721 user. See also &%-bem%&.
3723 .vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3725 .cindex "thawing messages"
3726 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
3727 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
3728 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
3729 This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
3730 &"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
3731 messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
3734 .vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3736 .cindex "listing" "message body"
3737 .cindex "message" "listing body of"
3738 This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
3739 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3741 .vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3743 .cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
3744 .cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2922 format"
3745 This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
3746 be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
3747 only by an admin user.
3749 .vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3751 .cindex "listing" "message headers"
3752 .cindex "header lines" "listing"
3753 .cindex "message" "listing header lines"
3754 This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
3755 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3757 .vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3759 .cindex "listing" "message log"
3760 .cindex "message" "listing message log"
3761 This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
3762 the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3766 This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
3767 treats it that way too.
3771 .cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
3772 .cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
3773 This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
3774 level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
3775 it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
3776 had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
3777 database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
3780 Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
3781 user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
3782 words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
3783 which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
3784 address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
3785 routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
3786 the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
3791 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-n%& option ignored"
3792 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&. It is ignored
3795 .vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
3797 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
3800 .vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
3802 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
3803 This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
3804 alternative alias file name. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
3807 .vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
3809 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3810 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3811 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3812 This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
3813 be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
3814 transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
3818 .cindex "background delivery"
3819 .cindex "delivery" "in the background"
3820 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
3821 including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
3822 messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
3823 delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
3824 processes to finish.
3826 When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
3827 leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
3828 and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
3829 This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
3831 If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
3832 (&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
3833 overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
3834 setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
3838 .cindex "foreground delivery"
3839 .cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
3840 This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
3841 accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
3842 &%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
3843 and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
3845 The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
3846 process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
3849 However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
3850 false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
3852 If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
3853 message is left on the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
3854 process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
3855 restricted configuration that never queues messages.
3860 This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
3865 .cindex "non-immediate delivery"
3866 .cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
3867 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
3868 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
3869 including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
3870 not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
3871 are placed on the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
3872 process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
3873 &%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
3874 conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
3879 .cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
3880 This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
3881 However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
3882 &%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
3883 configuration file is in effect.
3885 When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
3886 message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
3887 also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
3888 in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
3889 done at this time, so the message remains on the queue until a subsequent queue
3890 runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
3891 messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
3892 host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
3893 configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
3898 .cindex "error" "reporting"
3899 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
3900 example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
3903 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
3905 this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
3906 exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
3907 is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 any other error. This is
3908 the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
3912 .cindex "error" "reporting"
3913 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
3914 This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
3915 return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
3916 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
3920 .cindex "error" "reporting"
3921 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
3922 error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
3923 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
3924 The return code is 1 for all errors.
3928 .cindex "error" "reporting"
3929 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
3934 .cindex "error" "reporting"
3935 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
3940 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3941 This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
3942 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
3943 single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
3944 lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
3945 &'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
3948 .oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
3949 This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
3951 .vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
3953 .cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
3954 A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
3955 with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
3956 over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
3957 &%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
3958 other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
3960 The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
3961 number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
3963 exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
3965 An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
3966 followed by a colon and the port number:
3968 exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
3970 The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
3971 port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
3972 are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
3973 whichever one is last.
3975 .vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
3977 .cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
3978 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
3979 option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
3980 name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
3981 This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
3982 authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
3984 .vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
3986 .cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
3987 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
3988 option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
3989 This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
3990 where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
3991 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
3993 .vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
3995 .cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
3996 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
3997 option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
3998 overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
3999 messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4000 default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4001 specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4002 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4004 .vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4006 .cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4007 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4008 option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4009 using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4010 &$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4012 .vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4014 .cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4015 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4016 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4017 option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4018 &$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4019 or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4020 SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4021 &<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4022 one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4025 .vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4027 .cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4028 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4029 option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4030 present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4031 uses the name it is given.
4033 .vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4035 .cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4036 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4037 option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4038 local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4039 used, when there is no default.
4043 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4044 In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4045 message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4046 expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4050 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4051 This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4052 whatever that means.
4054 .vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4056 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4057 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4058 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4059 value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4060 written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4061 without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4062 because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4064 .vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4066 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4067 This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4068 set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4069 by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4070 described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4072 .vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4074 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4075 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4076 This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4077 applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4078 the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4079 for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4083 This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4085 .vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4087 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4088 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4089 .cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4090 This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4091 is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4092 of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4093 in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4094 file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid file name.
4098 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4099 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4100 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4101 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4106 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4107 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4108 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4109 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4112 .vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4114 For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4116 &`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4118 It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4119 host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4120 Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4121 to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`p`&
4122 or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4126 .cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4127 This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4128 configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4129 relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4130 and &%-S%& options).
4132 .cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4133 The &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4134 waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4135 for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4136 process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4137 have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4140 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4141 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4142 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4143 the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4144 passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4147 When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4148 process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4149 mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4150 this to be repeated periodically.
4152 Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4153 random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4154 If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4155 MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4157 It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4158 order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4159 &%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4161 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4162 The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4163 behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4164 appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4168 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4169 .cindex "queue" "routing"
4170 .cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4171 An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4172 stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4173 every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4176 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4177 The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4178 is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4179 complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4180 place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4181 delivered down a single SMTP
4182 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4183 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4184 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4185 connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4186 This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4189 .vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4191 .cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4192 If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4193 those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4194 delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages on the queue using
4195 &%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4197 .vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4199 .cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4200 .cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4201 If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4202 message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4203 their retry times are tried.
4205 .vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4207 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4208 If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4211 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4213 .cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4214 The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4215 be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains on the queue
4218 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4219 .cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4220 When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4221 lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4222 starting message id. For example:
4224 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4226 Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4227 second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4228 are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4230 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4232 just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4233 &%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4234 that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4235 mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4236 are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4237 queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4239 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4240 .cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4241 .cindex "periodic queue running"
4242 When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4243 starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4244 (whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4245 &%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4246 single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4247 combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4249 /usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4251 Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4252 process every 30 minutes.
4254 When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4255 pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4257 .vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4259 This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4262 .vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4264 This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4266 .vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4268 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4269 .cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4270 .cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4271 The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4272 is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4273 which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4274 <&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4276 This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4277 perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4278 queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4279 address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4280 way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4281 regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4283 If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4284 you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4286 exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4288 This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4289 every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4290 applied to each queue run.
4292 Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4293 are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4294 information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4295 means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4296 existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4297 address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4298 will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4299 information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4300 address will be skipped.
4302 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4303 If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4304 all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4307 The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4308 to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4309 command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4310 effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4311 an arbitrary command instead.
4315 This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4317 .vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4319 .cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4320 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4321 This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4322 message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4323 conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4324 has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4326 .vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4328 This an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4329 recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4330 &"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4334 .cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4335 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
4336 .cindex "&'Cc:'& header line"
4337 .cindex "&'To:'& header line"
4338 When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4339 input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4340 from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4341 from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4342 takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4344 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4345 If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4346 is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4347 the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4348 and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4349 Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4350 Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4351 argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4352 Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4353 instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4354 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4356 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4357 If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4358 recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4359 lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4360 with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4361 &%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4363 RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4364 message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4365 added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4366 not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4367 nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4368 In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4369 are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4370 once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4371 &%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4375 This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4376 compatibility with Sendmail.
4378 .vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4379 .oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4380 .cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4381 .cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4382 This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4383 incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4384 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4385 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4390 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4391 Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4392 documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4393 syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4394 set. Exim ignores this option.
4398 This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4399 describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4400 receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4401 dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4402 the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4403 selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4408 AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4409 National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4410 It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4418 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4419 . Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4420 . line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4421 . creates a man page for the options.
4422 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4425 <!-- === End of command line options === -->
4432 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4433 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4436 .chapter "The Exim run time configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4437 "The runtime configuration file"
4439 .cindex "run time configuration"
4440 .cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4441 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4442 .cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4443 .cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4444 .cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4445 Exim uses a single run time configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4446 binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4447 because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4450 If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4451 writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4452 The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4453 errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4454 not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4455 actually alter the string.
4457 The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4458 reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4459 most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4460 give a colon-separated list of file names, in which case Exim uses the first
4461 existing file in the list.
4464 .cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4465 .cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4466 .cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4467 .cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4468 .cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4469 The run time configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4470 specified at compile time by the EXIM_USER option, or by the user that is
4471 specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4472 configuration file must not be world-writeable or group-writeable, unless its
4473 group is the one specified at compile time by the EXIM_GROUP option or by the
4474 CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4476 &*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4477 to root, anybody who is able to edit the run time configuration file has an
4478 easy way to run commands as root. If you make your mail administrators members
4479 of the Exim group, but do not trust them with root, make sure that the run time
4480 configuration is not group writeable.
4482 A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4483 is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4484 defines just one file name, the installation process copies the default
4485 configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4486 CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4487 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4492 .section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4493 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4494 A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4495 option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4496 &%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root or the
4497 Exim user (or unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value
4498 from CONFIGURE_FILE). &%-C%& is useful mainly for checking the syntax of
4499 configuration files before installing them. No owner or group checks are done
4500 on a configuration file specified by &%-C%&.
4502 The privileged use of &%-C%& by the Exim user can be locked out by setting
4503 ALT_CONFIG_ROOT_ONLY in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. However,
4504 if you do this, you also lock out the possibility of testing a
4505 configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery, even
4506 if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is running
4507 as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the
4508 use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and
4509 delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message on the queue, using
4510 &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
4512 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4513 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4514 start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4515 There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any file
4516 name can be used with &%-C%&.
4518 One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4519 option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4520 configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4521 non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4522 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4523 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4525 Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4526 share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4527 If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4528 looks for a file whose name is the configuration file name followed by a dot
4529 and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4530 file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4531 each file name in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4533 In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4534 different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4535 help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4539 .section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4540 .cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4541 .cindex "format" "configuration file"
4542 Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4543 option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4544 are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4545 is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by the name of the part. The
4549 &'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4552 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4553 &'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4554 are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4556 &'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4557 addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4558 &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4560 &'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4561 define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4562 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4564 &'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4565 If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4566 defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4567 are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4570 &'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4571 when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4572 chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4574 &'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4575 want to use this feature, you must set
4577 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4579 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4580 facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
4583 .cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
4584 .cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
4585 .cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
4586 Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
4588 Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4589 leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
4590 # character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4591 and does not introduce a comment.
4593 Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4594 the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
4595 backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
4596 lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4597 appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
4599 A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
4600 default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
4601 change settings as required.
4603 The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
4604 described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
4605 respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
4606 items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
4607 onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
4612 .section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
4613 .cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
4614 .cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
4615 .cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
4616 .cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
4617 You can include other files inside Exim's run time configuration file by
4620 &`.include`& <&'file name'&>
4621 &`.include_if_exists`& <&'file name'&>
4623 on a line by itself. Double quotes round the file name are optional. If you use
4624 the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
4625 second form does nothing for non-existent files. In all cases, an absolute file
4628 Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
4629 configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
4630 If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
4631 because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
4633 The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
4634 comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
4637 hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
4640 Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
4641 process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
4646 .section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
4647 .cindex "macro" "description of"
4648 .cindex "configuration file" "macros"
4649 If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
4650 &"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
4651 definition, and must be of the form
4653 <&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
4655 The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
4656 in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
4657 continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
4658 space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
4659 a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
4661 Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
4662 definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
4663 ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
4665 .section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
4666 Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
4667 files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
4668 scanned for each in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
4669 replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
4670 for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
4671 the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
4674 &`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
4675 &`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
4677 but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
4678 error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
4679 before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
4680 consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
4681 line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
4682 comment line or a &`.include`& line.
4685 .section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
4686 Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
4687 (or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
4692 MAC == updated value
4694 Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
4695 subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
4696 the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
4697 Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
4701 MAC == MAC and something added
4703 This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
4704 from a number of other files.
4706 .section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
4707 The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
4708 &%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
4709 used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
4710 using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
4715 .section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
4716 As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
4717 up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
4718 strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
4720 ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
4721 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
4723 This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
4725 data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
4727 In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
4728 address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
4729 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
4732 .section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
4733 .cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
4734 .cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
4735 You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
4736 &`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
4737 portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
4738 read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
4740 The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
4741 be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
4742 that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
4746 message_size_limit = 50M
4748 message_size_limit = 100M
4751 sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined, and 100M
4752 otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
4753 is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
4754 obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
4756 Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
4757 it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
4758 in this line"& will always be true.
4760 Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
4761 to clarify complicated nestings.
4765 .section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
4766 .cindex "common option syntax"
4767 .cindex "syntax of common options"
4768 .cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
4769 For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
4770 each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
4771 lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
4772 these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
4773 space) and then the value. For example:
4775 qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
4777 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
4778 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
4779 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
4780 Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
4781 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
4782 line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
4783 word &"hide"&. For example:
4785 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
4787 For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
4789 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
4791 If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
4792 all instances of the same driver.
4794 The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
4795 that are found in option settings.
4798 .section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
4799 .cindex "format" "boolean"
4800 .cindex "boolean configuration values"
4801 .oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
4802 .oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
4803 Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
4804 different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
4805 the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
4806 if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
4807 boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
4808 &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
4809 the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
4814 The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
4819 You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
4824 .section "Integer values" "SECID48"
4825 .cindex "integer configuration values"
4826 .cindex "format" "integer"
4827 If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
4828 hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
4829 number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
4830 with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
4833 If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
4834 it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024. When the values
4835 of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
4836 1024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
4837 and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
4841 .section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
4842 .cindex "integer format"
4843 .cindex "format" "octal integer"
4844 If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
4845 interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
4846 Such options are always output in octal.
4849 .section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
4850 .cindex "fixed point configuration values"
4851 .cindex "format" "fixed point"
4852 If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
4853 integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
4857 .section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
4858 .cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
4859 .cindex "format" "time interval"
4860 A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
4861 the following letters, with no intervening white space:
4871 For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
4872 intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
4873 is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
4877 .section "String values" "SECTstrings"
4878 .cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
4879 .cindex "format" "string"
4880 If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
4881 or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
4882 consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
4883 the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
4884 removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
4885 Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
4886 appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
4887 therefore equivalent:
4889 trusted_users = uucp:mail
4890 trusted_users = uucp:\
4891 # This comment line is ignored
4894 .cindex "string" "quoted"
4895 .cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
4896 If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
4897 double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
4898 continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
4901 .irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
4902 .irow &`\n`& "newline"
4903 .irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
4905 .irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
4906 .irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
4910 If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
4911 character, that character replaces the pair.
4913 Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
4914 insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
4915 trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
4916 current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
4917 in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
4918 and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
4921 .section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
4922 .cindex "expansion" "definition of"
4923 Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
4924 by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
4925 circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
4926 is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
4927 strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
4928 However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
4929 backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
4930 within a quoted configuration string.
4933 .section "User and group names" "SECID52"
4934 .cindex "user name" "format of"
4935 .cindex "format" "user name"
4936 .cindex "groups" "name format"
4937 .cindex "format" "group name"
4938 User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
4939 above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
4940 either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
4941 &[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
4944 .section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
4945 .cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
4946 .cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
4947 .cindex "string" "list, definition of"
4948 The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
4949 default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
4950 the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
4951 &"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
4952 are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
4953 particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
4954 &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
4956 In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
4957 input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
4958 &<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
4959 in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
4960 on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
4961 start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
4964 local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
4966 contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
4968 &*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
4969 list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The space after the first
4970 colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
4971 be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
4973 .section "Changing list separators" "SECID53"
4974 .cindex "list separator" "changing"
4975 .cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
4976 Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
4977 introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
4978 with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
4979 character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
4980 above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
4982 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
4984 This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
4985 &%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
4986 confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
4988 .cindex "list separator" "newline as"
4989 .cindex "newline" "as list separator"
4990 It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
4991 code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
4992 must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
4993 are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
4994 sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
4995 interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
4996 generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
4998 domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5000 This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5001 to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5002 expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5003 the value in quotes. For example:
5005 local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5007 Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5008 doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5009 set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5010 enclosing an empty list item.
5014 .section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5015 .cindex "list" "empty item in"
5016 An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5017 separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5019 senders = user@domain :
5021 contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5022 in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5023 items, the second of which is empty:
5025 senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5027 &*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5028 are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5029 would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5030 just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5034 In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5035 is at the end of the list.
5040 .section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5041 .cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5042 There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5043 and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5044 instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5045 a sequence of lines like this:
5047 <&'instance name'&>:
5052 In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5053 followed by three options settings:
5058 transport = local_delivery
5060 For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5061 setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5062 settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5063 deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5064 a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5065 described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5067 You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5068 the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5070 The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5071 passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5072 transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5073 authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5074 them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5077 .cindex "generic options"
5078 .cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5079 Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5080 and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5081 same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5082 &%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5083 .cindex "private options"
5084 The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5085 they all have default values.
5087 The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5088 precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5089 this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5091 Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5092 elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5093 with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5094 a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5095 instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5096 confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5097 configuration lines:
5102 create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5103 &(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5104 different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5105 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5111 command_timeout = 10s
5113 The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5114 these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5117 Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5118 list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5119 defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5127 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5128 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5130 .chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5131 .scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5132 .cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5133 The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5134 is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5135 the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5136 configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5137 of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5138 itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5139 initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5140 mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5144 .section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5145 The main (global) configuration option settings must always come first in the
5146 file. The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is
5149 # primary_hostname =
5151 This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5152 to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5153 can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5154 it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5156 The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5158 domainlist local_domains = @
5159 domainlist relay_to_domains =
5160 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5162 These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5163 domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5164 domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5165 configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5167 The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5168 later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5171 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
5172 There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5173 of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5174 called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5175 be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5176 the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5178 The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5179 list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5180 controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5181 domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5182 domain is permitted.
5184 The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5185 used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5186 that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5187 loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5188 submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5189 hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5191 Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5192 we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5193 and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5195 The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5197 acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5198 acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5200 These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5201 during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5202 command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5203 respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5204 &'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5205 section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5206 accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5207 to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5208 contents of a message to be checked.
5210 Two commented-out option settings are next:
5212 # av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5213 # spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5215 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5216 content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5217 scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5218 details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5220 Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5222 # tls_advertise_hosts = *
5223 # tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5224 # tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5226 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5227 support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5228 first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5229 connecting to this server; in this case the wildcard means all clients. The
5230 other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5231 key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5232 More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5234 Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5236 # daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5237 # tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5239 .cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5240 .cindex "port" "for message submission"
5241 .cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5242 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5243 .cindex "smtps protocol"
5244 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5245 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5246 These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5247 server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5248 TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5249 more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&). The usual SMTP port 25 is often blocked
5250 on end-user networks, so RFC 4409 specifies that message submission should use
5251 port 587 instead. However some software (notably Microsoft Outlook) cannot be
5252 configured to use port 587 correctly, so these settings also enable the
5253 non-standard &"smtps"& (aka &"ssmtp"&) port 465 (see section
5254 &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&).
5256 Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5259 # qualify_recipient =
5261 The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5262 complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5263 receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5264 the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5265 you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5266 addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5268 .cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5269 The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5270 addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5271 (an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5273 # allow_domain_literals
5275 The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5276 Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5277 quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5278 try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5279 people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5280 &'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5282 The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5286 It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5287 convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5288 setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5289 The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5290 list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5291 FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5292 contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5293 FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5295 When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5296 Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5301 specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5302 in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5303 information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5304 or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5305 Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5306 because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5309 The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
5310 1413 (hence their names):
5313 rfc1413_query_timeout = 5s
5315 These settings cause Exim to make ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5316 You can limit the hosts to which these calls are made, or change the timeout
5317 that is used. If you set the timeout to zero, all ident calls are disabled.
5318 Although they are cheap and can provide useful information for tracing problem
5319 messages, some hosts and firewalls have problems with ident calls. This can
5320 result in a timeout instead of an immediate refused connection, leading to
5321 delays on starting up an incoming SMTP session.
5323 When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5324 be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5325 if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5326 find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5328 # sender_unqualified_hosts =
5329 # recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5331 show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5332 and recipient addresses, respectively.
5334 The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5336 # percent_hack_domains =
5338 It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5339 This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5340 anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5342 The last two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5343 concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5344 message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5345 occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5346 address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5347 bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5348 are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5349 always bounce messages.
5351 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5352 timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5354 The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5355 discarded after 2 days on the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5356 message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5357 after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5358 bounce message ever lasts a week.
5362 .section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5363 .cindex "default" "ACLs"
5364 .cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5365 In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5366 It starts with the line
5370 and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5371 &'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5372 and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5374 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5375 The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5376 RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5377 are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5378 rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5379 result of the ACL processing.
5383 This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5388 This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5389 But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5390 names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5391 list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5392 host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5393 important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5395 What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5396 messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5397 input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5400 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5401 domains = +local_domains
5402 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5404 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5405 domains = !+local_domains
5406 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5408 These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5409 characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5410 Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5411 &"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5412 in Internet mail addresses.
5414 The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5415 addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5416 option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5417 in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5418 programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5419 at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5420 characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5421 policy of being as safe as possible.
5423 The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5424 to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5425 first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5426 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5427 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5428 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5430 The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5431 block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5432 or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5433 have to modify this rule.
5435 Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5436 allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5437 common convention of local parts constructed as
5438 &"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5439 the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5440 with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5441 file name (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5442 that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5443 is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5445 The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5446 allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5447 and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5448 with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5449 local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5450 and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5451 (or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5453 accept local_parts = postmaster
5454 domains = +local_domains
5456 This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5457 local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5458 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5459 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5460 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5462 The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5463 by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5464 in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5466 require verify = sender
5468 This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5469 ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5470 address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5471 see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5472 addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5473 used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5474 discusses the details of address verification.
5476 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5477 control = submission
5479 This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
5480 hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
5481 verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
5482 that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
5483 second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
5484 is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
5485 messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
5486 &'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
5487 probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
5489 accept authenticated = *
5490 control = submission
5492 This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
5493 Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
5494 likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
5495 authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
5496 examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
5497 fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
5499 require message = relay not permitted
5500 domains = +local_domains : +relay_domains
5502 This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
5503 one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
5505 require verify = recipient
5507 This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
5508 fails, the address is rejected.
5510 # deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
5511 # is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
5513 # dnslists = black.list.example
5515 # warn dnslists = black.list.example
5516 # add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
5517 # a black list at $dnslist_domain
5518 # log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
5520 These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
5521 sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
5522 from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
5525 # require verify = csa
5527 This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
5528 authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
5533 The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
5534 address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
5538 This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
5539 of this ACL are commented out:
5542 # message = This message contains a virus \
5545 These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
5546 viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
5547 suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
5548 virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
5550 # warn spam = nobody
5551 # message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
5552 # X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
5553 # X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
5554 # X-Spam_report: $spam_report
5556 These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
5557 SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
5558 and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
5559 &`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
5560 series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
5561 whatever the spam score.
5565 This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
5568 .section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
5569 .cindex "default" "routers"
5570 .cindex "routers" "default"
5571 The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
5576 Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
5577 messages. An address is passed to each router in turn, until it is either
5578 accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
5579 matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
5580 manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
5583 # driver = ipliteral
5584 # domains = !+local_domains
5585 # transport = remote_smtp
5587 .cindex "domain literal" "default router"
5588 This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
5589 support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
5590 you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
5591 &%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
5595 domains = ! +local_domains
5596 transport = remote_smtp
5597 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
5600 The first uncommented router handles addresses that do not involve any local
5601 domains. This is specified by the line
5603 domains = ! +local_domains
5605 The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
5606 exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
5607 that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
5608 the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
5609 indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
5610 passed on to the following routers.
5612 The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
5613 and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
5614 the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
5615 instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
5616 one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
5618 The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
5619 DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
5620 router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
5621 specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
5622 in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
5623 the address fails and is bounced.
5625 The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
5626 be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
5627 encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
5628 whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
5629 Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
5630 email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
5631 continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
5638 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
5640 file_transport = address_file
5641 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5643 Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
5644 domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
5645 alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
5646 data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
5647 the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
5650 &_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
5651 often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
5652 file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
5653 &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
5658 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5659 # local_part_suffix_optional
5660 file = $home/.forward
5665 file_transport = address_file
5666 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5667 reply_transport = address_reply
5669 This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
5670 redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
5671 individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
5672 local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
5673 router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
5676 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5677 # local_part_suffix_optional
5679 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
5680 show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
5681 is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
5682 by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
5683 variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
5684 presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
5685 the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
5687 When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
5688 home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
5689 declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
5690 redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
5692 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
5693 Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
5694 files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
5695 is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
5696 of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
5697 filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
5698 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
5700 The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
5701 verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
5702 There are two reasons for doing this:
5705 Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
5706 checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
5709 More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
5710 command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
5711 The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
5712 It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
5716 The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
5717 address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
5718 works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
5719 forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
5721 The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
5722 forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
5723 auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
5725 a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
5727 the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
5733 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5734 # local_part_suffix_optional
5735 transport = local_delivery
5737 The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
5738 part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
5739 the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
5740 routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
5741 same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
5744 .section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
5745 .cindex "default" "transports"
5746 .cindex "transports" "default"
5747 Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
5748 only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
5749 not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
5753 One remote transport and four local transports are defined.
5758 This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections. All its
5759 options are defaulted. The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
5763 file = /var/mail/$local_part
5770 This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
5771 traditional BSD mailbox format. By default it runs under the uid and gid of the
5772 local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
5773 directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
5774 under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
5775 show how this can be done.
5777 Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
5778 &'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
5779 similarly-named options above.
5785 This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
5786 redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
5787 option specifies that any output generated by the pipe is to be returned to the
5796 This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
5797 redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
5798 &(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
5803 This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
5808 .section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
5809 .cindex "retry" "default rule"
5810 .cindex "default" "retry rule"
5811 The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
5812 Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
5813 introduced by the line
5817 In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
5820 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
5822 This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
5823 2 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
5824 1.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
5825 is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced.
5827 If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
5828 if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
5829 temporary errors into permanent errors.
5832 .section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
5833 The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
5837 contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
5838 rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
5842 .section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
5843 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
5844 The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
5846 begin authenticators
5848 defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
5849 configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
5850 which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
5851 standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
5852 mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
5853 to support most MUA software.
5855 The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
5858 # driver = plaintext
5859 # server_set_id = $auth2
5860 # server_prompts = :
5861 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
5862 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_cipher }
5864 And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
5867 # driver = plaintext
5868 # server_set_id = $auth1
5869 # server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
5870 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
5871 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_cipher }
5874 The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
5875 in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
5876 &%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
5877 that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
5878 i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
5879 when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
5880 when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
5881 need to add support for TLS as described in &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
5883 The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
5884 password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
5885 To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
5886 expression like one of the examples in &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
5888 Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
5889 usercode and password are in different positions. &<<CHAPplaintext>>&
5892 .ecindex IIDconfiwal
5896 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5897 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5899 .chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
5901 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
5903 Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
5904 uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
5905 matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
5906 regular expressions is discussed in many Perl reference books, and also in
5907 Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
5908 O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
5910 The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
5911 are supported by PCRE is included in the PCRE distribution, and no further
5912 description is included here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using
5913 the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that
5914 the PCRE_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
5917 In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
5918 it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
5919 or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
5920 second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
5922 domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
5924 The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
5925 precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
5926 of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
5927 regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
5928 backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
5929 normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
5932 There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
5933 recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
5934 string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
5935 these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
5936 it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
5937 match anywhere in the subject string.
5939 In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
5940 you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
5942 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
5944 matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
5947 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
5949 if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
5950 $ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
5954 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5955 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5957 .chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
5958 .scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
5959 .scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
5960 .cindex "lookup" "description of"
5961 Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
5962 messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
5965 A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
5966 cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
5967 lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
5968 can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
5969 &<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
5971 Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
5972 way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
5973 returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
5974 succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
5975 chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5978 String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
5979 that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
5980 involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
5981 if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
5982 time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
5983 chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
5985 .section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
5986 It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
5987 lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
5988 processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
5989 Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
5991 domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
5992 domains = lsearch;/some/file
5994 The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
5995 No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
5996 defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
5997 The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
5998 file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6000 192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6001 192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6003 When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6004 possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6006 In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6007 Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6008 in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
6013 Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6014 matches the list item.
6016 It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6017 Consider a file containing lines like this:
6019 192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6021 If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6022 first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6023 causes a second lookup to occur.
6025 The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6026 available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6027 lookup is permitted.
6030 .section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6031 .cindex "lookup" "types of"
6032 .cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6033 Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6036 The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6037 and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6038 lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6040 .cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6041 The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6042 key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6043 Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6046 The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6047 the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6048 default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6053 which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6054 For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6055 libraries and header files before building Exim.
6060 .section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6061 .cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6062 .cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6063 The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6066 .cindex "cdb" "description of"
6067 .cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6068 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6069 &(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6070 string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6071 indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6072 re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6073 aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb can
6074 be found in several places:
6076 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html)
6077 &url(ftp://ftp.corpit.ru/pub/tinycdb/)
6078 &url(http://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb.html)
6080 A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6081 because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6082 However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6083 you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6085 .cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6086 .cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6087 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6088 &(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6089 DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6090 zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6091 &<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6093 .cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6094 For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6095 when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6096 using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6097 the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6098 that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6099 other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6101 .cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6102 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6103 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6105 .cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6106 .cindex "dmbnz lookup type"
6107 &(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6108 is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6109 if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6110 other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6111 use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6112 calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6113 utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6114 by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6116 .cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6117 .cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6118 &(dsearch)&: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for an entry
6119 whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function. The key may not
6120 contain any forward slash characters. If &[lstat()]& succeeds, the result of
6121 the lookup is the name of the entry, which may be a file, directory,
6122 symbolic link, or any other kind of directory entry. An example of how this
6123 lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6124 &<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6126 .cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6127 .cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6128 &(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6129 terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6130 file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6131 IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6132 being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6134 1.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6135 192.168.0.0/16 data for 192.168.0.0/16
6136 "abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6137 "abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6139 The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6140 file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6141 key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6142 &"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6143 &(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6145 &*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6146 &(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6147 lookup types support only literal keys.
6149 &*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6150 the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6151 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6153 .cindex "linear search"
6154 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6155 .cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6156 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6157 &(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6158 line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6159 end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6160 letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6161 in the file is used.
6163 White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6164 line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6165 continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6166 space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6167 junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6172 Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6173 middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6174 that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6175 wildcarding of any kind.
6177 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6178 .cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6179 In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6180 characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6181 If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6182 matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6183 contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6184 quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6185 quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6188 .cindex "NIS lookup type"
6189 .cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6190 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6191 &(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6192 the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6193 &(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6194 reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6195 aliases; the full map names must be used.
6198 .cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6199 .cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6200 .cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6201 .cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6202 &(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6203 &(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6204 the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6205 that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6206 used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6208 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6209 Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6210 file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6211 &`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6213 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
6214 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
6217 The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6219 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6220 *fish data for anythingfish
6223 The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6224 example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6226 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6228 Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6229 expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6230 string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6232 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6234 The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6235 expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6236 For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6238 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6241 If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6242 either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6243 ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6244 colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6245 escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6247 &*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6248 match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6249 is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6250 takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6251 &((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6254 Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6255 is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6256 lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6259 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
6261 The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
6264 Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6265 continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
6266 be followed by optional colons.
6268 &*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6269 &((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6270 lookup types support only literal keys.
6274 .section "Query-style lookup types" "SECID62"
6275 .cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
6276 .cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
6277 The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
6278 many of them are given in later sections.
6281 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6282 .cindex "lookup" "DNS"
6283 &(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
6284 are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
6285 records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
6287 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
6288 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
6289 &(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
6291 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
6292 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6293 &(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
6294 returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
6295 that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
6296 called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
6297 any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
6299 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
6300 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
6301 &(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6302 MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6304 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
6305 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
6306 &(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
6307 the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
6309 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
6310 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
6311 &(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
6312 Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6314 .cindex "lookup" "passwd"
6315 .cindex "passwd lookup type"
6316 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
6317 &(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
6318 lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
6319 success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
6320 lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
6321 password value. For example:
6323 *:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
6326 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
6327 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
6328 &(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6329 PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6332 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
6333 .cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
6334 &(sqlite)&: The format of the query is a file name followed by an SQL statement
6335 that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
6338 &(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
6339 not likely to be useful in normal operation.
6341 .cindex "whoson lookup type"
6342 .cindex "lookup" "whoson"
6343 &(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
6344 allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
6345 address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
6346 obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
6347 at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
6348 superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
6349 &"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
6351 require condition = \
6352 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
6354 The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
6355 the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
6356 this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
6357 one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
6362 .section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
6363 .cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
6364 Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
6365 completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
6366 reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
6367 options such as a list of local domains.
6369 When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
6370 of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
6371 temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
6372 or may give up altogether.
6376 .section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
6377 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6378 .cindex "lookup" "default values"
6379 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6380 .cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
6381 .cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
6382 In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
6383 that is to be used if a lookup fails.
6385 &*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
6386 lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
6387 specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
6389 If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
6390 and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
6391 provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
6393 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
6394 .cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
6395 .cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
6396 Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
6397 &%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
6398 character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
6399 by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
6400 that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
6401 take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
6402 For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
6404 data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
6406 Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
6407 looks up these keys, in this order:
6413 The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
6414 &(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
6415 complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
6416 Exim move on to try the next key.
6420 .section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
6421 .cindex "partial matching"
6422 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6423 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
6424 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6425 .cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
6426 The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
6427 match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
6428 being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
6429 information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
6430 domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
6431 a key in a DBM file is
6433 *.dates.fict.example
6435 then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
6436 &'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
6437 by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
6440 &*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
6441 also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
6442 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
6444 Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
6445 keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
6446 be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
6447 partial matching keys
6448 beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
6449 Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
6450 unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
6452 Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
6453 the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
6454 is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
6455 is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
6456 fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
6457 start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
6460 A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
6461 by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
6462 &%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
6463 modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
6464 subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
6465 up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
6467 2250.dates.fict.example
6468 *.2250.dates.fict.example
6469 *.dates.fict.example
6472 As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
6475 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
6476 .cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
6477 The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
6478 changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
6479 formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
6480 parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
6482 domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
6484 In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6485 &`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
6486 components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
6487 other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
6489 domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
6491 For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6492 &`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
6494 If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
6495 just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
6496 down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
6499 If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
6501 If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
6502 example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
6504 Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
6505 remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
6506 for &"*"& on its own.
6508 Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
6512 If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
6513 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
6514 this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
6515 specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
6516 prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
6517 lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
6518 &"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
6520 The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
6521 in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
6522 dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
6523 in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
6524 subject key is always followed by a dot.
6529 .section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
6530 .cindex "lookup" "caching"
6531 .cindex "caching" "lookup data"
6532 Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
6533 lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
6534 of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
6535 single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
6537 For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
6538 another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
6539 many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
6540 the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
6541 closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
6542 own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
6544 The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
6545 strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
6551 .section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
6552 .cindex "lookup" "quoting"
6553 .cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
6554 When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
6555 is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
6556 the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
6560 will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
6561 For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
6563 [name="$local_part"]
6565 but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
6566 NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
6567 rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
6568 of the following form is provided:
6570 ${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
6572 For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
6574 [name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
6576 See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
6577 operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
6578 lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
6583 .section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
6584 .cindex "dnsdb lookup"
6585 .cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
6586 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6587 The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
6588 of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
6589 an expansion string could contain:
6591 ${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
6593 If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
6594 is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
6595 &`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
6596 &<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
6598 The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SRV, and TXT, and,
6599 when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA (and A6 if that is also
6600 configured). If no type is given, TXT is assumed. When the type is PTR,
6601 the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
6602 &%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
6604 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
6606 If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
6607 altered and nothing is added.
6609 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6610 .cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6611 For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
6612 each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
6613 port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
6615 For any record type, if multiple records are found (or, for A6 lookups, if a
6616 single record leads to multiple addresses), the data is returned as a
6617 concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
6618 depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
6619 between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
6620 by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
6622 ${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
6624 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6625 white space is ignored.
6627 .section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
6628 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6629 By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
6630 each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
6631 the pseudo-type MXH:
6633 ${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
6635 In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
6638 .cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
6639 Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
6640 records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
6641 component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
6642 records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
6643 error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
6644 but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
6645 top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
6647 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
6648 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
6650 Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
6651 the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
6652 the name servers for &%edu%&.
6654 You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
6655 top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
6656 sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
6657 given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
6658 for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
6661 .cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6662 A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
6663 records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
6664 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
6665 not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
6666 result of a successful lookup such as:
6668 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
6670 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
6671 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
6672 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
6675 .section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
6676 In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
6677 However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
6678 &(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
6679 the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
6681 ${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
6682 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6683 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
6685 In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
6686 the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
6687 to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
6688 case, it does not treat it as a list.
6690 The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
6691 in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
6692 different separator can be specified, as described above.
6694 The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
6695 temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
6696 an optional keyword followed by a comma that may appear before the record
6697 type. The possible keywords are &"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and
6698 &"defer_lax"&. With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
6699 whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
6700 ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
6701 With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
6702 error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
6703 succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
6705 ${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6706 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6708 Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
6709 yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
6714 .section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
6715 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
6716 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6717 .cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
6718 The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
6719 become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
6720 implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
6721 contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
6722 the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
6723 it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
6724 indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
6725 your &_Local/Makefile_&:
6727 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
6728 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
6729 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
6730 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
6731 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
6733 If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
6734 same interface as the University of Michigan version.
6736 There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
6737 the way they handle the results of a query:
6740 &(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
6743 &(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
6744 Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
6746 &(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
6747 from all of them are returned.
6751 For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
6752 Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
6753 the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
6754 First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
6757 .section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
6758 .cindex "LDAP" "query format"
6759 An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
6760 the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
6762 data = ${lookup ldap \
6763 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
6764 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
6766 .cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
6767 The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
6768 secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
6769 encrypted TLS connection is used.
6772 .section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
6773 .cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
6774 Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
6775 and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
6776 within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
6777 reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
6779 The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
6780 filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
6788 in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
6789 to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
6793 are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
6795 ${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
6799 %20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
6801 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
6803 a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
6805 The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
6806 base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
6807 by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
6811 It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
6812 before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
6813 is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
6815 ${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
6819 %5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
6821 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
6823 \ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
6825 There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
6826 authentication below.
6829 .section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
6830 .cindex "LDAP" "connections"
6831 The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
6832 is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
6833 an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
6836 ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
6838 If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
6839 used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
6840 taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
6841 colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
6842 handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
6843 returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
6844 are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
6845 Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
6846 failures, and timeouts.
6848 For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
6849 of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
6850 &%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
6851 doubled. For example
6853 ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
6855 If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
6856 to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
6857 the local host) is used.
6859 If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
6860 a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
6861 &`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
6862 to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
6865 For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
6866 for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
6867 can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
6868 the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
6870 ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
6872 When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
6873 &`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
6875 ${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
6877 When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
6878 a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
6879 specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
6880 socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
6881 &%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
6882 or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
6883 the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
6886 If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
6887 specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
6888 &%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
6891 Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
6894 Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
6898 Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
6899 &%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
6903 .section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
6904 .cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
6905 The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
6906 information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
6907 be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
6908 spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
6909 when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
6910 them. The following names are recognized:
6912 &`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
6913 &`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
6914 &`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
6915 &`PASS `& set the password, likewise
6916 &`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
6917 &`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
6918 &`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
6920 The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
6921 &"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
6922 must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
6923 library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
6925 The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
6926 backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
6927 enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
6928 network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
6929 &'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
6930 LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
6931 if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
6932 SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
6933 Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
6935 The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
6936 set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
6939 Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
6940 values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
6943 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
6944 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
6947 The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
6948 any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
6949 which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
6950 non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
6952 The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
6953 connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
6954 on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
6956 When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
6957 removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
6958 some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
6959 quoting has two advantages:
6962 It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
6963 DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
6965 It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
6968 For example, a setting such as
6970 USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
6972 should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
6974 Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
6975 expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
6976 field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
6977 does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
6981 The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
6982 SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
6987 .section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
6988 .cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
6989 The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
6990 as a sequence of values, for example
6992 cn=manager, o=University of Cambridge, c=UK
6994 The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
6995 search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
6996 the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
6997 values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
6998 you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7001 In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7002 result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7003 has multiple values, they are separated by commas.
7005 If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7006 strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7007 quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7008 backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7009 Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7010 output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7011 same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7013 Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7014 LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7015 &%attr1%& has two values, whereas &%attr2%& has only one value:
7017 ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7020 ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7023 ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7024 attr1="value1.1, value1.2" attr2="value two"
7026 ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7027 objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1, value1.2" attr2="value two"
7029 The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7030 individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs. You can
7031 make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7032 results of LDAP lookups.
7037 .section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7038 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7039 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7040 NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7041 and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7042 contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7043 of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7044 values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7046 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7048 might return the string
7050 name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7051 home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7053 (split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7055 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7061 with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7062 for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7063 operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7067 .section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7068 .cindex "SQL lookup types"
7069 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7070 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7071 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7072 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7073 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7074 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7075 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7076 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7077 Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, and SQLite
7078 databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7081 ${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7084 If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7085 field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7087 ${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7092 home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7094 Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7095 quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7096 field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7100 If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7101 with a newline between the data for each row.
7104 .section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, and InterBase" "SECID72"
7105 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7106 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7107 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7108 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7109 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7110 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7111 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7112 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7113 If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, or InterBase lookups are used, the
7114 &%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, or &%ibase_servers%&
7115 option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7117 (For MySQL and PostgreSQL only, the global option need not be set if all
7118 queries contain their own server information &-- see section
7119 &<<SECTspeserque>>&.) Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
7120 items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
7121 Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
7122 name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
7124 hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
7126 Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
7127 &"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
7128 option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
7130 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
7131 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
7133 For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
7134 because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
7135 query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
7136 a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
7137 found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
7138 servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
7140 The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
7141 convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
7142 respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
7143 itself are escaped with backslashes. The &%quote_pgsql%& expansion operator, in
7144 addition, escapes the percent and underscore characters. This cannot be done
7145 for MySQL because these escapes are not recognized in contexts where these
7146 characters are not special.
7148 .section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
7149 For MySQL and PostgreSQL lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
7150 it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
7151 done by starting the query with
7153 &`servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&&`;`&
7155 Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
7157 If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
7158 global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
7159 of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
7162 If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
7164 The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
7165 Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
7166 successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
7168 This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
7169 are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
7170 master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
7173 mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
7177 In an updating lookup, you could then write:
7179 ${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
7181 That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
7182 the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
7183 option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
7185 ${lookup pgsql{servers=master/db/name/pw; UPDATE ...} }
7189 .section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
7190 For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
7191 causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
7192 socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses. The full syntax of
7193 each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
7195 <&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)/<&'database'&>/&&&
7196 <&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
7198 Any of the three sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
7199 the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
7201 No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
7204 If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
7205 or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
7207 &*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
7208 anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
7209 is zero because no rows are affected.
7212 .section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
7213 PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
7214 This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
7215 However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
7216 database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
7219 hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
7221 In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
7222 given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
7223 visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
7225 If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
7226 update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
7229 .section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
7230 .cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
7231 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
7232 SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a file name is required in
7233 addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
7234 daemon as in the other SQL databases. The interface to Exim requires the name
7235 of the file, as an absolute path, to be given at the start of the query. It is
7236 separated from the query by white space. This means that the path name cannot
7237 contain white space. Here is a lookup expansion example:
7239 ${lookup sqlite {/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7240 select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
7242 In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
7244 domainlist relay_domains = sqlite;/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7245 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
7247 The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
7248 quote, which it doubles.
7250 The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
7251 internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
7252 update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
7253 are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
7254 waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
7255 to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
7261 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7262 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7264 .chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
7265 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
7266 "Domain, host, and address lists"
7267 .scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
7268 A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
7269 email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
7270 contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
7271 are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
7272 arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
7274 Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
7275 host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
7276 different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
7277 general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
7281 .section "Expansion of lists" "SECID75"
7282 .cindex "expansion" "of lists"
7283 Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used. The result of
7284 expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
7285 into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
7286 but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
7287 &<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
7288 discusses the way to specify empty list items.
7291 If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
7292 testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
7293 expansion failures cause temporary errors.
7295 If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
7296 other special characters in the expression must be protected against
7297 misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
7298 the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
7299 expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
7301 deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
7302 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
7304 The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
7305 &`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
7306 senders based on the receiving domain.
7311 .section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
7312 .cindex "list" "negation"
7313 .cindex "negation" "in lists"
7314 Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
7315 leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
7316 defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
7317 it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
7318 (respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
7320 The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
7321 subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
7322 subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
7323 subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
7324 was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
7326 domainlist relay_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
7328 matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
7329 neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
7330 list is positive. However, if the setting were
7332 domainlist relay_domains = !a.b.c
7334 then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
7335 list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
7336 as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
7338 Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
7339 the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
7344 .section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
7345 .cindex "list" "file name in"
7346 If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute file
7347 name (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
7348 processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
7349 file names are not allowed,
7350 and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
7351 Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
7355 For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
7356 file, it and all following characters are ignored.
7358 Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
7359 address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
7360 white space or the start of the line. For example:
7362 not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
7366 Putting a file name in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
7367 file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
7368 is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
7369 so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
7371 If a file name is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
7372 within the file is inverted. For example, if
7374 hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
7376 and the file contains the lines
7381 then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
7382 any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
7386 .section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
7387 As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
7388 to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
7389 confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
7390 an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
7391 sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
7392 non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
7393 always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
7395 If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
7396 list, just give the file name on its own, without a search type, as described
7397 in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
7398 &(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
7403 .section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
7404 .cindex "named lists"
7405 .cindex "list" "named"
7406 A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
7407 which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
7408 particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
7409 places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
7410 the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
7411 a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
7412 locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
7414 domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
7416 Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
7417 for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
7418 configured with the line
7420 domains = +local_domains
7422 The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
7423 except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
7427 domains = ! +local_domains
7428 transport = remote_smtp
7431 The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
7432 the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
7433 respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
7434 equals sign and the list itself. For example:
7436 hostlist relay_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
7437 addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
7439 A named list may refer to other named lists:
7441 domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
7442 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
7443 domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
7445 &*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
7446 effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
7447 out to the higher level. For example, consider:
7449 domainlist dom1 = !a.b
7450 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
7452 The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
7453 list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
7454 means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
7456 domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
7458 where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
7459 referenced lists if you can.
7461 Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
7462 address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
7463 lists. So, if you have a setting such as
7465 domains = +local_domains
7467 on several of your routers
7468 or in several ACL statements,
7469 the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
7470 if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
7471 references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
7472 the same each time they are referenced.
7474 By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
7475 extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
7476 is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
7477 hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
7481 .section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
7482 .cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
7483 .cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
7484 At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
7485 configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
7488 ALIST = host1 : host2
7489 auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
7491 it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
7493 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
7495 Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
7498 hostlist alist = host1 : host2
7499 auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
7501 the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
7503 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
7507 .section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
7508 .cindex "list" "caching of named"
7509 .cindex "caching" "named lists"
7510 While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
7511 it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
7512 the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
7513 that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
7514 an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
7515 message. For example:
7517 domainlist special_domains = \
7518 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
7520 This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
7521 address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
7522 in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
7523 cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
7524 same list each time.
7526 By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
7527 cache the result anyway. For example:
7529 domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
7531 If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
7532 the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
7536 .section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
7537 .cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
7538 .cindex "list" "domain list"
7539 Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
7540 The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
7543 .cindex "primary host name"
7544 .cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
7545 .oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
7546 .cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
7547 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
7548 If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
7549 as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
7550 possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
7551 differ only in their names.
7553 .cindex "@[] in a domain list"
7554 .cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
7555 .cindex "domain literal"
7556 If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
7557 in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
7558 only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
7559 &%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
7560 control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
7561 In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
7564 .cindex "@mx_primary"
7565 .cindex "@mx_secondary"
7566 .cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
7567 If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
7568 has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
7569 .oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
7570 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
7571 are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
7572 local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
7573 but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
7574 preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
7576 The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
7577 performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
7578 example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
7579 resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
7580 options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
7582 Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
7583 patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
7584 list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
7585 ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
7586 on a router). For example:
7588 domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
7590 This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
7591 the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
7593 The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
7594 host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
7595 contain negative items.
7597 Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
7598 be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
7599 list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
7601 domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
7602 an.other.domain : ...
7604 so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
7605 involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
7607 domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
7608 an.other.domain ? ...
7611 .cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
7612 .cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
7613 .cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
7614 If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
7615 are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
7616 domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
7617 list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
7618 matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
7619 list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
7623 .cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
7624 .cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
7625 If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
7626 expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
7627 function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
7628 Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
7629 default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
7630 with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
7631 are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
7633 &*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
7634 must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
7635 use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
7636 it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
7637 expression by expansion, of course).
7639 .cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
7640 .cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
7641 If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
7642 semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
7643 must be a file name in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
7644 &"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
7646 domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
7648 The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
7649 key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
7650 only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
7651 is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
7652 or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
7653 &$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
7654 other statements in the same ACL.
7657 Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
7658 &`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
7660 domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
7662 This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
7663 works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
7666 .cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
7667 Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
7668 a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
7669 original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
7670 select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
7671 value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
7674 If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
7675 semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
7676 pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
7677 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
7679 hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
7680 where domain = '$domain';
7682 In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
7683 example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
7684 whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
7685 &%domains%& option on a router, the data is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
7686 variable and can be referred to in other options.
7688 .cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
7689 If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
7690 between the pattern and the domain.
7693 Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
7695 domainlist funny_domains = \
7698 *.foundation.fict.example : \
7699 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
7700 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
7701 nis;domains.byname : \
7702 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
7704 There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
7705 an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
7706 explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
7707 but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
7708 patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
7713 .section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
7714 .cindex "host list" "patterns in"
7715 .cindex "list" "host list"
7716 Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
7717 example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
7718 may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
7719 two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
7720 pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
7721 You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
7722 involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
7725 .section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
7726 .cindex "empty item in hosts list"
7727 .cindex "host list" "empty string in"
7728 If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
7729 involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
7730 process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
7733 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
7734 The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
7735 the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
7739 .section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
7740 .cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
7741 If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
7742 the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
7743 &`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
7744 list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
7745 systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
7748 The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
7749 inspecting its IP address:
7752 If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
7753 with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
7754 to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
7755 &[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
7756 This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
7757 with the IP address of the subject host.
7759 If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
7760 lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
7761 ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
7762 temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
7763 what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
7766 .cindex "@ in a host list"
7767 If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
7768 domain name, as just described.
7771 If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
7772 subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
7773 IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
7774 be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
7775 separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
7776 without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
7777 IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
7778 that can never match a client host.
7781 .cindex "@[] in a host list"
7782 If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
7783 the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
7784 interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
7786 accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
7790 .cindex "CIDR notation"
7791 If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
7792 example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
7793 host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
7794 included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
7795 specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
7796 significant end of the address.
7798 &*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
7799 of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
7800 address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
7801 addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
7805 matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
7806 32 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
7809 Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
7811 recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
7812 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
7814 The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
7815 appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
7818 recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
7820 could make use of a file containing
7825 to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
7826 addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
7827 changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
7829 recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
7832 The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
7838 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
7839 "SECThoslispatsikey"
7840 .cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
7841 When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
7842 address, the pattern takes this form:
7844 &`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
7848 hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
7850 The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
7851 IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
7852 letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
7853 &(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
7854 quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
7855 returned by the lookup is not used.
7857 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
7858 .cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
7859 Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
7860 patterns of this form:
7862 &`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
7866 net24-dbm;/networks.db
7868 The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
7869 length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
7870 mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
7871 is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
7872 &"192.168.34.0/24"&.
7874 When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
7875 of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
7876 terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
7877 to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
7878 recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
7879 (notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
7880 For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
7881 converted using colons and not dots. In all cases, full, unabbreviated IPv6
7882 addresses are always used.
7884 Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
7885 colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
7886 However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
7889 &*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
7890 IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
7891 the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
7892 case the IP address is used on its own.
7896 .section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
7897 .cindex "host" "lookup failures"
7898 .cindex "unknown host name"
7899 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
7900 There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
7901 remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
7902 complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
7903 address to match against, as described in the section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
7906 If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
7907 patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
7908 Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
7909 DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
7910 Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
7911 effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
7912 Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
7914 Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
7915 against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
7917 By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
7918 if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
7919 &[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
7920 are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
7921 security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
7922 for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
7923 Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
7924 discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
7925 found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
7927 There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
7928 found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
7930 .cindex "host" "alias for"
7931 .cindex "alias for host"
7932 As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
7933 of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
7936 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
7937 If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
7938 the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
7939 &'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
7940 requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
7943 .cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
7944 .cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
7945 If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
7946 matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
7947 expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
7948 case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
7949 syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
7954 is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
7955 &'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
7956 that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
7957 string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
7958 part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
7960 sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
7962 &*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
7963 &`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
7964 example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
7971 .section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
7972 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
7973 While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
7974 name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
7975 from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
7976 behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
7978 &*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
7979 apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
7981 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
7982 .cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
7983 By default, Exim behaves as if the host does not match the list. This may not
7984 always be what you want to happen. To change Exim's behaviour, the special
7985 items &`+include_unknown`& or &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at
7986 top level &-- they are not recognized in an indirected file).
7989 If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
7990 cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
7992 host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
7994 rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
7995 any hosts whose name it cannot find.
7998 If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
7999 be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
8002 accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
8005 accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
8006 whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
8007 name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
8010 Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
8011 list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
8015 .section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
8017 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
8018 .cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
8019 .cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
8020 A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
8021 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
8022 host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analagous to
8023 &`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
8024 section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
8025 host lists such as whitelists.
8029 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
8030 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
8031 .cindex "unknown host name"
8032 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8033 If a pattern is of the form
8035 <&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
8039 dbm;/host/accept/list
8041 a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
8042 lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
8045 &*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
8046 keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
8047 addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
8048 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
8049 two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
8050 lookup, both using the same file.
8054 .section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
8055 If a pattern is of the form
8057 <&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
8059 the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
8060 data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
8061 &$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
8063 hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
8064 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
8066 The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
8067 can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
8068 use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
8071 If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
8072 looks up the host name if has not already done so. (See section
8073 &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
8075 Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
8076 host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
8077 &`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
8078 still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
8079 effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
8080 See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
8084 .section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
8086 .cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
8087 If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same
8088 host list, you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, in an
8091 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8093 The reason for this lies in the left-to-right way that Exim processes lists.
8094 It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an
8095 item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to
8096 compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8097 &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even if its
8098 IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8100 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8101 address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8103 accept hosts = *.friend.example
8104 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8106 If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8107 &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs.
8113 .section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
8114 .cindex "list" "address list"
8115 .cindex "address list" "empty item"
8116 .cindex "address list" "patterns"
8117 Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
8118 is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
8119 always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
8120 list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
8121 using this option setting:
8125 The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
8126 data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
8127 detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
8128 and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
8130 Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
8133 senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
8135 A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
8136 character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
8137 semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
8138 subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
8139 with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
8140 the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
8141 wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
8143 deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
8144 *@+hostile_domains:\
8145 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
8146 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
8148 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8149 .cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
8150 If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
8151 specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
8152 treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
8154 If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
8155 contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
8156 address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
8157 domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
8158 is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
8160 deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
8163 The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
8164 address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
8168 .cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
8169 .cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
8170 If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
8171 done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
8172 You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
8173 as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
8174 to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8176 deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
8177 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
8179 The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
8180 start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
8183 .cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
8184 Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
8185 lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
8188 deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
8189 mysql;select address from blocked where \
8190 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
8192 Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
8193 lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
8194 not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
8195 always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
8197 Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
8198 cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
8200 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
8201 However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
8202 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
8203 default. For example, with this lookup:
8205 accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
8207 the file could contains lines like this:
8209 user1@domain1.example
8212 and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
8215 nimrod@jaeger.example
8219 &*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
8220 would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
8222 &*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
8224 deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
8225 deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
8227 The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
8228 because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
8229 domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
8233 The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
8234 If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
8239 .cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
8240 .cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
8241 .cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
8242 If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
8243 (for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
8244 split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
8245 it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
8246 from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
8247 of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
8249 .cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
8250 The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
8251 keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
8252 patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
8253 even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
8256 deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
8258 the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
8260 baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
8262 to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
8264 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8265 If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
8266 has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
8267 may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
8268 but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
8269 surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
8271 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
8274 As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
8277 If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
8278 of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
8279 list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
8280 might have entries like
8282 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
8283 xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
8286 in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
8287 local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
8288 each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
8289 chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
8291 .cindex "loop" "in lookups"
8292 It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
8293 them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
8296 The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
8297 lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
8298 can only return a single list of local parts.
8301 &*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
8302 in these two examples:
8305 senders = *@+my_list
8307 In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
8308 example it is a named domain list.
8313 .section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
8314 .cindex "case of local parts"
8315 .cindex "address list" "case forcing"
8316 .cindex "case forcing in address lists"
8317 Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
8318 case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
8319 Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
8320 Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
8321 blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
8322 lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
8325 The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
8326 address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
8327 comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
8328 the address list itself, in files included as plain file names, and in any file
8329 that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
8330 keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
8331 works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
8334 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
8335 To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
8336 an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
8337 part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
8338 longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
8339 lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
8340 performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
8341 become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
8345 .section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
8346 .cindex "list" "local part list"
8347 .cindex "local part" "list"
8348 Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
8349 lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
8350 setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
8351 set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
8352 case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
8353 matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
8354 &%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
8355 option is case-sensitive from the start.
8357 If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
8358 comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
8359 only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
8360 Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
8361 that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
8362 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
8363 Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
8365 .ecindex IIDdohoadli
8370 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8371 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8373 .chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
8374 .scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
8375 Many strings in Exim's run time configuration are expanded before use. Some of
8376 them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
8378 When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
8379 when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
8380 start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
8381 below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
8382 escape character, as described in the following section.
8386 .section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
8387 .cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
8388 An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
8389 backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
8390 character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
8391 If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
8392 required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
8393 the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
8395 .cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
8396 A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
8397 two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
8398 expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
8400 deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
8402 On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
8403 without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
8408 .section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
8409 .cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
8410 A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
8411 expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
8412 carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
8413 octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
8414 backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
8417 These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
8418 in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
8419 and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
8422 .section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
8423 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
8424 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
8426 Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
8427 takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
8428 arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
8429 to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
8430 since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
8431 value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
8432 database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
8435 Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
8436 instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
8437 using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
8440 If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
8441 from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
8442 option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a file name. The file is
8443 read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
8445 exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
8447 The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
8448 Exim message identifier. For example:
8450 exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
8452 This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
8453 is therefore restricted to admin users.
8456 .section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
8457 .cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
8458 A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
8459 alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
8460 (which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
8461 used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
8462 instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
8463 the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
8464 that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
8465 its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
8466 from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
8467 taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
8473 .section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
8474 The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
8475 between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
8476 outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
8477 white space is significant.
8480 .vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
8481 .cindex "expansion" "variables"
8482 Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
8487 The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
8488 characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
8489 &'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
8490 section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
8491 given, the expansion fails.
8493 .vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
8494 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
8495 The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
8496 <&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
8500 The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
8501 leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
8502 below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
8503 one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
8504 string easier to understand.
8506 .vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
8507 This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
8508 expansion item below.
8510 .vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
8511 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
8513 This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
8514 This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
8518 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
8519 object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
8520 (but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
8522 There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function. When compiling
8523 a local function that is to be called in this way, &_local_scan.h_& should be
8524 included. The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
8525 are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
8526 must have the following type:
8528 int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
8530 Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
8531 function should return one of the following values:
8533 &`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
8534 into the expanded string that is being built.
8536 &`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
8537 from &'yield'&, if it is set.
8539 &`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
8540 taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
8542 &`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
8544 When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
8545 you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
8546 configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
8548 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
8549 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
8550 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
8551 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
8552 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
8553 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
8554 must not consist entirely of digits. The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the
8557 <&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
8560 where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
8561 values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
8562 values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
8563 described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
8564 for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
8565 the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
8566 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
8567 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
8568 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
8570 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
8571 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
8572 extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
8575 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
8576 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
8578 Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
8579 appear, for example:
8581 ${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
8583 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
8584 {<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
8587 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
8588 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
8589 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
8590 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
8591 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
8592 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
8593 This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
8594 behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
8595 extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
8596 argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
8597 <&'string3'&> as before.
8599 The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
8600 separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
8601 The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
8602 counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
8603 number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
8604 number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
8605 expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
8606 provided. For example:
8608 ${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
8612 ${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
8614 yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
8615 empty (for example, the fifth field above).
8618 .vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
8619 .cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
8620 .cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
8622 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
8623 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
8624 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
8625 evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
8626 item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
8627 separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
8628 input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
8630 ${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}
8632 yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
8633 to what it was before. See also the &*map*& and &*reduce*& expansion items.
8636 .vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
8637 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
8638 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
8639 This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
8640 early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
8641 (numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
8643 The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
8644 <&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
8645 <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
8646 use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
8648 ${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
8650 The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
8651 or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
8652 Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
8653 function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
8654 first <&'m'&> characters of the string
8656 abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
8658 If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
8659 letters appear. For example:
8661 &`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
8662 &`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
8663 &`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
8666 .vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
8667 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
8668 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
8669 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
8670 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
8671 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
8672 .cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
8673 .vindex "&$header_$&"
8674 .vindex "&$bheader_$&"
8675 .vindex "&$rheader_$&"
8676 .cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
8677 .cindex "header lines" "character sets"
8678 .cindex "header lines" "decoding"
8679 Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
8683 The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
8684 internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
8685 lines) may be present.
8687 The difference between &%rheader%&, &%bheader%&, and &%header%& is in the way
8688 the data in the header line is interpreted.
8691 .cindex "white space" "in header lines"
8692 &%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
8693 processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
8696 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
8697 &%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
8698 or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
8699 character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
8700 &"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
8701 .cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
8702 produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
8703 what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
8706 &%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
8707 standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
8708 be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
8709 returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
8710 &[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
8711 a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
8714 In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
8715 command of the following form:
8717 headers charset "UTF-8"
8719 This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
8720 subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
8721 character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
8722 option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
8723 value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
8726 Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
8727 any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
8728 &'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
8729 if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
8731 Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
8732 this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
8733 message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
8734 filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
8735 router or transport are not accessible.
8737 For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in ACLs that are obeyed
8738 before the DATA ACL, because the header structure is not set up until the
8739 message is received. Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
8740 are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
8741 point they are added. When a DATA ACL is running, however, header lines added
8742 by earlier ACLs are visible.
8744 Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
8745 following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
8746 this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
8747 white space terminates the header name, it is included in the expanded string.
8748 If the message does not contain the given header, the expansion item is
8749 replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in section
8750 &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a header.)
8752 If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
8753 to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
8754 &%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
8755 each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
8756 newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
8757 newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
8758 those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
8759 junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
8762 .vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
8763 .cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
8765 This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
8766 shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
8767 RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
8768 &`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
8769 cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
8770 or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
8771 present. For example:
8773 ${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
8775 For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
8778 dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
8780 As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
8781 an Exim configuration:
8783 SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
8785 In a router or a transport you could then have:
8788 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
8789 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
8790 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
8792 Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
8793 &'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
8794 this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
8795 host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
8796 using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example by using the
8797 &'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
8800 .vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
8801 .cindex "expansion" "conditional"
8802 .cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
8803 If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
8804 item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
8805 in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
8807 ${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
8809 The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
8810 true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
8811 be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
8812 case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
8813 &<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
8815 If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
8816 is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
8817 cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
8819 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
8823 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
8826 .vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
8827 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
8828 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
8829 The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
8830 strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
8831 you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
8832 change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
8835 ${length_<n>:<string>}
8837 The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> characters or the whole
8838 of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
8839 &%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
8842 .vitem "&*${lookup{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
8843 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
8844 This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
8845 described in the next item.
8847 .vitem "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
8848 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
8849 .cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
8850 .cindex "file" "lookups"
8851 .cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
8852 The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
8853 discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
8854 lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
8855 <&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
8857 If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
8858 a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
8859 other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
8860 in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
8861 out by the system administrator.
8864 If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
8865 During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
8866 lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
8867 level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
8868 the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
8869 string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
8870 lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
8871 original lookup fails.
8873 If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
8874 data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
8875 expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
8876 the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
8877 appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
8878 to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
8879 {<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
8880 successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
8882 For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
8883 search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
8884 type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
8885 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
8887 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
8888 If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
8889 and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
8890 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
8892 This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
8894 ${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
8896 This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
8897 the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
8899 ${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
8904 .vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
8905 .cindex "expansion" "list creation"
8907 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
8908 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
8909 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
8910 expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
8911 for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
8912 setting is not included in the output. For example:
8914 ${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
8916 expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
8917 value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &*filter*&
8918 and &*reduce*& expansion items.
8920 .vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
8921 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
8922 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
8923 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
8924 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
8925 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
8926 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
8928 ${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
8930 The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
8931 the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
8932 processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
8933 slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
8936 ${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
8938 returns the string &"6/33"&.
8942 .vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
8943 .cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
8944 .cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
8945 This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
8946 interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
8947 expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
8948 additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
8949 name of the subroutine, is nine.
8951 The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
8952 the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
8953 way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
8954 Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
8955 return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
8958 If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
8959 with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
8960 Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
8962 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
8963 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
8966 .vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
8967 .cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
8968 The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
8969 keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
8970 it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
8971 to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
8972 as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
8973 and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
8975 .vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
8976 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
8977 .cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
8978 This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
8979 checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
8980 yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
8981 empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
8982 prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
8983 version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
8984 variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
8986 These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
8987 retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
8988 against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
8989 which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
8991 The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
8992 string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
8993 result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
8994 whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
8995 is the expansion of the third argument.
8997 All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
8998 However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
8999 For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9001 .vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
9002 .cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
9003 .cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
9004 .cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
9005 The file name and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
9006 then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
9007 the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
9008 newlines are left in the string.
9009 String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
9010 you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
9011 the string expansion fails.
9013 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
9014 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9018 .vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
9019 {*&<&'timeout'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
9020 .cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
9021 .cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
9022 .cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
9023 This item inserts data from a Unix domain or Internet socket into the expanded
9024 string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
9027 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
9028 ${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
9030 For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
9031 For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
9032 a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
9033 number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
9034 optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
9037 ${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
9039 Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
9040 one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
9041 both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
9042 (unless it is an empty string) and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
9043 is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
9044 extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
9046 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
9048 A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
9049 that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
9050 turns them into spaces:
9052 ${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
9054 As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
9055 happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
9056 addition, the following errors can occur:
9059 Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
9061 Failure to connect the socket;
9063 Failure to write the request string;
9065 Timeout on reading from the socket.
9068 By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
9069 you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
9070 errors occurs. For example:
9072 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
9075 You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
9076 expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
9077 and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
9078 if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
9079 non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
9081 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
9082 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9085 .vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9086 .cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
9087 .cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
9090 This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
9091 <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
9092 separator can be changed in the usual way. Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
9093 assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
9094 list is assigned to &$item$& in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
9095 them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
9096 iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
9097 added to the expansion output. The &*reduce*& expansion item can be used in a
9098 number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
9100 ${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
9102 The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
9105 ${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
9107 At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
9108 restored to what they were before. See also the &*filter*& and &*map*&
9111 .vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9112 This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9113 expansion item above.
9115 .vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
9116 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9117 .cindex "expansion" "running a command"
9118 .cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
9119 The command and its arguments are first expanded separately, and then the
9120 command is run in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in
9121 other command executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If you want
9122 a shell, you must explicitly code it.
9124 The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
9125 and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
9126 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
9128 If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
9129 and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
9130 from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
9131 <&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
9132 expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
9135 If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
9136 can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
9137 command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
9138 of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
9141 The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
9142 remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
9144 if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
9145 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
9149 If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
9150 the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
9153 &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
9154 option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
9155 testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
9156 by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
9158 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
9159 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9162 .vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
9163 .cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
9164 .cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
9165 This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
9166 option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
9167 modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
9168 into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
9169 a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
9171 ${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
9173 yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
9174 if any $ or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
9175 substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
9177 ${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
9179 yields &"defabc"&, and
9181 ${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
9183 yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
9184 the regular expression from string expansion.
9188 .vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9189 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
9190 .cindex "substring extraction"
9191 .cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
9192 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9193 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9194 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9195 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9197 ${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9199 The second number is optional (in both notations).
9200 If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
9203 The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
9204 &%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
9205 length required. For example
9207 ${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
9209 If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
9210 null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
9211 length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
9212 given offset. The first character in the string has offset zero.
9214 The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
9215 from the right-hand end of its operand. The last character is offset -1, the
9216 second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
9218 ${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
9220 yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
9221 length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
9222 the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
9224 ${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
9226 yields an empty string, but
9228 ${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
9232 When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
9233 is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all characters in the
9234 string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
9235 no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
9238 ${substr{-1}{abcde}}
9240 yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
9244 .vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
9245 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
9246 .cindex "expansion" "character translation"
9247 .cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
9248 This item does single-character translation on its subject string. The second
9249 argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
9250 matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
9251 replacement list. For example
9253 ${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
9255 yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
9256 last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
9257 last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
9263 .section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
9264 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
9265 For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
9266 the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
9267 The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
9268 following operations can be performed:
9271 .vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9272 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9273 .cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
9274 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
9275 header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
9276 not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9279 .vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9280 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9281 .cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
9282 The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
9283 2822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
9284 operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
9285 result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
9286 doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
9287 Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
9289 It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
9290 separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
9291 character. For example:
9293 ${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
9295 expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. Compare the &*address*& (singular)
9296 expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
9297 address. See the &*filter*&, &*map*&, and &*reduce*& items for ways of
9301 .vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
9302 .cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
9303 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
9304 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
9305 base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
9306 the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
9307 its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive file
9308 names), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just to
9309 be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
9311 .vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
9312 .cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
9313 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
9314 The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
9315 environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
9316 identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
9319 .vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9320 .cindex "domain" "extraction"
9321 .cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
9322 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
9323 from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9326 .vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9327 .cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
9328 .cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
9329 If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
9330 escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
9331 significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
9332 is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
9335 .vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9336 .cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
9337 .cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
9338 .cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
9339 These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
9340 expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
9341 arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
9342 logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
9343 integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
9344 C programming language):
9346 .irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
9347 .irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
9348 .irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
9349 .irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
9352 .irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
9354 Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
9355 space is permitted before or after operators.
9357 For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
9358 hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
9359 decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
9360 permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
9361 times, which often do have leading zeros.
9363 A number may be followed by &"K"& or &"M"& to multiply it by 1024 or 1024*1024,
9364 respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
9365 a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"& or &"M"&). For example:
9368 &`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
9369 &`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
9370 &`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
9371 &`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
9372 &`${eval:0xc&5} `& yields 4
9373 &`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
9374 &`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
9375 &`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
9376 &`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
9377 &`${eval:~255&0x1234} `& yields 4608
9378 &`${eval:-(~255&0x1234)} `& yields -4608
9381 As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
9383 deny message = Too many bad recipients
9386 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
9389 {$recipients_count} \
9390 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
9394 The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
9395 fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
9398 .vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9399 .cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
9400 The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
9403 ${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
9405 first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
9406 and then re-expands what it has found.
9409 .vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9411 .cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
9412 .cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
9413 .cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
9414 The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
9415 email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
9416 to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
9417 UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
9418 converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
9419 the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
9421 Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
9422 ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
9423 For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
9424 way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
9425 characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
9426 single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
9427 translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
9430 .vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9431 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
9432 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9433 The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
9434 be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
9435 change when expanded). The effect is the same as
9437 ${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
9439 See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
9440 abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
9444 .vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
9445 .cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
9446 .cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
9447 .cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
9448 This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
9449 be useful for processing the output of the MD5 and SHA-1 hashing functions.
9452 .vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9453 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
9454 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
9455 .cindex "lower casing"
9456 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
9457 .cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
9458 This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
9463 .vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9464 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9465 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9466 The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
9467 can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
9468 changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
9470 ${length{<number>}{<string>}}
9472 See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
9473 &%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
9474 when &%length%& is used as an operator.
9477 .vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9478 .cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
9479 .cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
9480 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
9481 extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
9485 .vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
9486 .cindex "masked IP address"
9487 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
9488 .cindex "CIDR notation"
9489 .cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
9490 .cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
9491 If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
9492 slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
9493 expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
9494 masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
9495 the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
9497 ${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
9499 returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
9500 be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
9501 address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
9502 terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
9504 ${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
9508 3ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
9510 Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
9513 .vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9515 .cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
9516 .cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
9517 The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
9518 as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
9521 .vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9522 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
9523 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
9524 The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
9525 that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
9526 strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
9528 ${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
9530 See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
9533 .vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9534 .cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
9535 .cindex "expansion" "quoting"
9536 .cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
9537 The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
9538 is an empty string or
9539 contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
9540 Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
9541 Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
9542 respectively For example,
9550 The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
9551 variable or a message header.
9553 .vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9554 .cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
9555 This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
9556 required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
9557 example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
9558 If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
9559 (or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
9562 .vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9563 .cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
9564 This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
9565 query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
9566 the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
9568 ${quote_ldap:two * two}
9574 For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
9575 yields an unchanged string.
9578 .vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9579 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
9580 .cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
9581 .cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
9582 This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
9583 encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
9584 assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
9585 &%headers_charset%& option, which defaults to ISO-8859-1. If the string
9586 contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
9589 ? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
9591 it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
9592 string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
9596 .vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9597 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
9598 .cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
9599 .cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
9600 This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
9601 bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
9602 character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
9603 not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
9605 &*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
9606 access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
9607 to use this operator as well.
9611 .vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9612 .cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
9613 .cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
9614 .cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
9615 The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
9616 characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
9617 variables or headers inside regular expressions.
9620 .vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9621 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
9622 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
9623 .cindex "&%sha2%& expansion item"
9624 The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
9625 it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
9628 .vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9629 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
9630 .cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
9631 .cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
9632 The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
9633 function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
9634 expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
9635 series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
9636 except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
9637 a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
9638 10-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
9639 &"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
9640 can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
9642 The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
9643 the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
9644 systems for files larger than 2GB.
9646 .vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9647 .cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
9648 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
9649 .cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
9650 This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
9654 .vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9655 .cindex "expansion" "string length"
9656 .cindex "string" "length in expansion"
9657 .cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
9658 The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
9659 decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
9662 .vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9663 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
9664 .cindex "substring extraction"
9665 .cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
9666 The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
9667 can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
9668 that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
9670 ${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
9672 See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
9673 abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
9675 .vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9676 .cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
9677 .cindex "time interval" "decoding"
9678 This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
9681 .vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9682 .cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
9683 .cindex "time interval" "formatting"
9684 The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
9685 represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
9686 number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
9689 .vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9690 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
9691 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
9692 .cindex "upper casing"
9693 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
9694 .cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
9695 This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
9703 .section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
9704 .scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
9705 The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
9706 while expanding strings:
9709 .vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
9710 .cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
9711 .cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
9712 Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
9715 .vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
9716 .cindex "numeric comparison"
9717 .cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
9718 There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
9724 &`>= `& greater or equal
9726 &`<= `& less or equal
9730 ${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
9732 Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
9733 two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
9734 optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"& or &"M"& (in either upper or
9735 lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024 or 1024*1024, respectively.
9736 As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
9739 .vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9740 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
9741 .cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
9742 This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
9743 a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
9744 (case-insensitively); also positive integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
9745 false if zero. Leading whitespace is ignored.
9746 All other string values will result in expansion failure.
9748 When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
9749 make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
9752 ${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
9755 .vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
9756 .cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
9757 .cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
9758 .cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
9759 This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
9760 authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
9761 necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
9762 included in the binary.
9764 The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
9765 compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
9766 be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
9767 encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
9768 does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
9769 &[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
9770 Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
9771 string in LDAP form is:
9773 {md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
9775 If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
9776 be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
9778 ${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
9780 The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
9785 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
9786 &%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
9787 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
9788 length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
9789 (as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
9790 hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
9794 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
9795 &%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
9796 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
9797 length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
9798 If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
9799 SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
9802 .cindex "&[crypt()]&"
9803 &%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
9804 only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
9805 systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
9806 whatever its length.
9809 .cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
9810 &%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
9811 use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
9812 modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
9814 Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
9815 &[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
9816 HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
9817 operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
9818 the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
9819 support &[crypt16()]&.
9821 Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
9822 it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
9823 turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
9824 &[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
9825 algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
9827 However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
9828 functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
9829 Exim is seen as very low priority.
9831 If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
9832 comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
9833 determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
9834 default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
9835 function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
9837 .vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
9838 .cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
9839 .cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
9840 The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
9841 variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
9842 variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
9844 ${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
9846 Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
9847 variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
9849 .vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
9850 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9851 .cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
9852 This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
9853 exists in the message. For example,
9855 ${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
9857 &*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
9858 the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
9860 .vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
9861 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
9862 .cindex "string" "comparison"
9863 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
9864 .cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
9865 .cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
9866 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
9867 resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
9868 letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent.
9870 .vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
9871 .cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
9872 .cindex "file" "existence test"
9873 .cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
9874 The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
9875 condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
9876 is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
9877 users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
9879 .vitem &*first_delivery*&
9880 .cindex "delivery" "first"
9881 .cindex "first delivery"
9882 .cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
9883 .cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
9884 This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
9885 attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
9888 .vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
9889 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
9890 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
9891 .cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
9892 .cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
9894 These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
9895 the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
9896 the normal method. The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
9897 be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
9898 condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
9900 For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
9901 the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
9902 items in the list, the overall condition is false.
9904 For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
9905 and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
9906 all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
9908 Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
9909 items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
9910 that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
9911 list separator is changed to a comma:
9913 ${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
9915 The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &*forany*& or &*forall*& is
9916 being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
9919 .vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
9920 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
9921 .cindex "string" "comparison"
9922 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
9923 .cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
9924 .cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
9925 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
9926 string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
9927 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
9930 .vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
9931 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
9932 .cindex "string" "comparison"
9933 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
9934 .cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
9935 .cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
9936 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
9937 string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
9938 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
9941 .vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
9942 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
9943 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9944 .cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
9945 .cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
9946 .cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
9947 .cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
9948 .cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
9949 The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
9950 an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
9951 &%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
9953 For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
9954 which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
9955 colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
9956 hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
9957 component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
9959 &*Note*&: The checks are just on the form of the address; actual numerical
9960 values are not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passes the IPv4
9961 check. The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
9962 host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
9964 ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
9966 to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
9968 .vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
9969 .cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
9970 .cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
9971 .cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
9972 This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
9973 &<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
9974 queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
9975 query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
9976 password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
9977 server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
9978 with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
9979 will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
9980 of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
9984 .vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
9985 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
9986 .cindex "string" "comparison"
9987 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
9988 .cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
9989 .cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
9990 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
9991 string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
9992 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
9995 .vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
9996 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
9997 .cindex "string" "comparison"
9998 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
9999 .cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
10000 .cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
10001 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10002 string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
10003 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
10007 .vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10008 .cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
10009 .cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
10010 .cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
10011 The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
10012 expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
10013 regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
10014 escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
10015 (curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
10016 premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
10017 &`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
10020 ${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
10022 If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
10023 backslashes is also required.
10025 The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
10026 The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
10027 metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
10028 and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
10029 the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
10030 metacharacter at an appropriate point.
10032 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
10033 At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
10034 substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
10035 succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
10036 will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
10037 of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
10038 combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
10039 variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
10041 .vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10042 .cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
10043 See &*match_local_part*&.
10045 .vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10046 .cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
10047 See &*match_local_part*&.
10049 .vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10050 .cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
10051 This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
10052 be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
10053 address or an empty string. The second (after expansion) is a restricted host
10054 list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
10056 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
10058 The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
10061 An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
10063 A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
10065 An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
10066 useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
10067 in a single test such as
10068 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
10069 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
10070 . ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
10071 . ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
10073 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
10075 where the first item in the list is the empty string.
10077 The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
10079 Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
10080 even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
10081 address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
10082 &*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
10083 masks. For example:
10085 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
10087 It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
10088 do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
10089 address mask, for example:
10091 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
10093 However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
10094 just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
10096 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
10100 Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
10102 .vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10103 .cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
10104 .cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
10105 .cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
10106 .cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
10107 This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
10108 possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
10109 condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
10112 ${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
10114 In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
10115 list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument (after
10116 expansion) is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
10117 Thus, you can use conditions like this:
10119 ${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
10121 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
10122 For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
10123 item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
10124 have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
10127 &*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
10128 hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
10129 how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
10130 matched using &%match_ip%&.
10132 .vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
10133 .cindex "PAM authentication"
10134 .cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
10135 .cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
10136 .cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
10137 .cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
10138 &'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
10139 (&url(http://www.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
10140 available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
10141 distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
10142 the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
10146 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
10147 in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
10149 The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
10150 colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
10151 The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
10152 taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
10153 The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
10154 from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
10155 request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
10157 There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
10158 characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
10159 separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the &%sg%& expansion
10160 item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
10161 of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
10163 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${sg{$auth2}{:}{::}}}}
10165 For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
10167 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth2:${sg{$auth3}{:}{::}}}}
10169 In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
10170 running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
10171 messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
10172 A patched version of the &'pam_unix'& module that comes with the
10173 Linux PAM package is available from &url(http://www.e-admin.de/pam_exim/).
10174 The patched module allows one special uid/gid combination, in addition to root,
10175 to authenticate. If you build the patched module to allow the Exim user and
10176 group, PAM can then be used from an Exim authenticator.
10179 .vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10180 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
10182 .cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
10183 .cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
10184 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
10185 This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
10186 that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
10187 deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
10189 The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
10190 the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
10191 building Exim. For example:
10193 CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
10195 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
10196 the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
10197 from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
10198 access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
10200 The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
10201 password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
10202 configuration, you might have this:
10204 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
10206 Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
10208 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
10210 .vitem &*queue_running*&
10211 .cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
10212 .cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
10213 .cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
10214 This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
10215 initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
10218 .vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
10220 .cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
10221 .cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
10222 Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
10223 set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
10224 the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
10227 With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
10228 library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
10229 this library, you need to set
10231 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
10233 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
10234 &%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
10236 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
10238 in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
10239 You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
10240 Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
10242 The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
10243 Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
10244 the authentication is successful. For example:
10246 server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
10250 .vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
10251 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
10252 .cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
10254 .cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
10255 .cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
10256 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
10257 daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
10258 Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
10259 by a process that is not running as root.
10261 The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
10262 the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
10263 building Exim. For example:
10265 CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
10267 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
10268 the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
10269 from the Cyrus SASL library.
10271 Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
10272 two are mandatory. For example:
10274 server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
10276 The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
10277 in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
10278 realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
10283 .section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
10284 .cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
10285 Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
10286 and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
10287 conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
10288 sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
10289 the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
10293 .vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
10294 .cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
10295 .cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
10296 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
10297 any one of the sub-conditions is true.
10300 ${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
10302 When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
10303 evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
10304 numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
10306 .vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
10307 .cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
10308 .cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
10309 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
10310 all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
10311 sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
10312 the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
10313 parsed but not evaluated.
10315 .ecindex IIDexpcond
10320 .section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
10321 .cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
10322 This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
10323 of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
10324 support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
10327 .vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
10328 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
10329 When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
10330 captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
10331 processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
10332 However, they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
10333 values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
10334 variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
10335 precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
10336 Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
10337 matching condition.
10339 .vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
10340 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
10341 can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
10342 long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
10343 example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
10344 variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
10345 used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
10346 same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
10347 with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
10348 during subsequent delivery.
10350 .vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
10351 These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
10352 are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
10353 received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
10354 message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
10355 also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
10356 message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
10357 and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
10360 .vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
10361 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
10362 After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
10363 message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
10364 be preserved by coding like this:
10366 warn !verify = sender
10367 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
10369 You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
10370 &%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
10373 .vitem &$address_data$&
10374 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
10375 This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
10376 value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
10377 and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
10378 the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
10379 for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
10382 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
10383 a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
10384 conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
10385 to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
10386 of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
10387 from the child's routing.
10389 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
10390 sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
10391 &$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
10394 In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
10395 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
10396 these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
10398 .vitem &$address_file$&
10399 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
10400 When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
10401 to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
10402 is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
10403 default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
10405 /home/r2d2/savemail
10407 then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
10408 contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
10409 .cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
10410 For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
10411 then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
10412 to the relevant file.
10414 .vitem &$address_pipe$&
10415 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
10416 When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
10417 this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
10419 .vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
10420 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
10421 These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
10422 &<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPspa>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
10424 .vitem &$authenticated_id$&
10425 .cindex "authentication" "id"
10426 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
10427 When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
10428 preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
10429 &$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
10430 user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
10431 in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
10432 &$sender_host_authenticated$&.
10433 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
10434 the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
10435 process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
10436 command line option.
10441 .vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
10442 .cindex "sender" "authenticated"
10443 .cindex "authentication" "sender"
10444 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
10445 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
10446 When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
10447 SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
10448 described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
10449 &"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
10450 available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
10451 sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
10453 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
10454 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
10455 value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
10456 name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
10457 can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
10460 .vitem &$authentication_failed$&
10461 .cindex "authentication" "failure"
10462 .vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
10463 This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
10464 command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
10465 possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
10466 (&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
10467 &"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
10468 is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
10469 negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
10470 an undefined mechanism.
10472 .vitem &$body_linecount$&
10473 .cindex "message body" "line count"
10474 .cindex "body of message" "line count"
10475 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
10476 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
10477 number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
10479 .vitem &$body_zerocount$&
10480 .cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
10481 .cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
10482 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
10483 .vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
10484 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
10485 number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
10487 .vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
10488 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
10489 This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
10490 it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
10491 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
10493 .vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
10494 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
10495 This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
10496 up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
10497 file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
10499 .vitem &$caller_gid$&
10500 .cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
10501 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
10502 The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
10503 not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
10504 &$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
10505 incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
10507 .vitem &$caller_uid$&
10508 .cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
10509 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
10510 The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
10511 not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
10512 &$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
10513 incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
10515 .vitem &$compile_date$&
10516 .vindex "&$compile_date$&"
10517 The date on which the Exim binary was compiled.
10519 .vitem &$compile_number$&
10520 .vindex "&$compile_number$&"
10521 The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
10522 of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
10523 compilations of the same version of the program.
10525 .vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
10526 .vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
10527 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with
10528 the content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For
10529 details, see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
10531 .vitem &$demime_reason$&
10532 .vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
10533 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
10534 content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
10535 see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
10537 .vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
10538 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
10539 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
10541 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
10542 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
10543 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
10544 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
10545 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
10546 When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
10547 the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
10548 looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
10549 main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
10552 .vindex "&$domain$&"
10553 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
10554 contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
10555 case for &$domain$&.
10557 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
10558 &$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
10559 is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
10560 message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
10562 When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
10563 RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
10564 have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
10565 at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
10566 the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
10567 which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
10569 .oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
10570 At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
10571 set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
10573 The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
10576 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
10577 the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
10578 &$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
10579 normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
10580 is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
10581 &$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
10582 the &(smtp)& transport.
10585 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
10586 &$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
10587 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
10588 rewrite domains by file lookup.
10591 With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
10592 &$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
10593 a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
10594 is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
10595 that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
10596 recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
10599 .cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
10600 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
10601 When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
10602 the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
10606 .vitem &$domain_data$&
10607 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
10608 When the &%domains%& option on a router matches a domain by
10609 means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
10610 of the router as &$domain_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the
10611 address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
10612 transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
10615 &$domain_data$& is also set when the &%domains%& condition in an ACL matches a
10616 domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
10617 the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
10620 .vitem &$exim_gid$&
10621 .vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
10622 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
10624 .vitem &$exim_path$&
10625 .vindex "&$exim_path$&"
10626 This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
10628 .vitem &$exim_uid$&
10629 .vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
10630 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
10632 .vitem &$found_extension$&
10633 .vindex "&$found_extension$&"
10634 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
10635 content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
10636 see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
10638 .vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
10639 This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
10640 inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
10641 be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
10642 characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
10646 When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
10647 directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
10648 means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
10649 explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
10650 by a setting on the transport itself.
10652 When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
10653 of the environment variable HOME.
10657 If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
10658 list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
10659 to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
10660 to local and remote transports.
10662 .cindex "transport" "filter"
10663 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
10664 For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
10665 &$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
10666 particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
10667 using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
10668 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
10671 When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
10672 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
10673 client is connected.
10676 .vitem &$host_address$&
10677 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
10678 This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
10679 for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
10680 when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
10682 .vitem &$host_data$&
10683 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
10684 If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
10685 result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
10686 allows you, for example, to do things like this:
10688 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
10689 message = $host_data
10691 .vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
10692 .cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
10693 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
10694 This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
10695 message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
10696 name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
10697 variables is set to &"1"&.
10700 If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
10701 succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
10704 If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
10705 tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
10706 lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
10709 Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
10710 single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
10711 names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
10712 is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
10713 &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
10714 IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
10715 sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
10716 lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
10717 the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
10718 &"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
10720 .vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
10721 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
10722 See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
10726 .vindex "&$inode$&"
10727 The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
10728 option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
10729 of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
10730 a unique name for the file.
10732 .vitem &$interface_address$&
10733 .vindex "&$interface_address$&"
10734 This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
10736 .vitem &$interface_port$&
10737 .vindex "&$interface_port$&"
10738 This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
10742 This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
10743 conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
10744 &*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
10748 .vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
10749 This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
10750 contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
10753 .vitem &$load_average$&
10754 .vindex "&$load_average$&"
10755 This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
10756 is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
10757 variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
10759 .vitem &$local_part$&
10760 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
10761 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
10762 variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
10763 delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
10764 session), &$local_part$& is not set.
10766 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
10767 &$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
10768 &$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
10769 because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
10772 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
10773 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
10774 If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
10775 value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
10776 any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
10777 &$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
10779 When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
10780 result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
10781 the parent address, not to the file name or command (see &$address_file$& and
10784 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
10785 local part of the recipient address.
10787 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
10788 &$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
10789 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
10791 In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
10794 "abc:xyz"@test.example
10795 abc\:xyz@test.example
10797 the value of &$local_part$& is
10801 If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
10802 inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
10805 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
10807 &*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
10808 to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
10809 &%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
10811 .vitem &$local_part_data$&
10812 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
10813 When the &%local_parts%& option on a router matches a local part by means of a
10814 lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
10815 router as &$local_part_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the address
10816 to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
10817 handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
10819 &$local_part_data$& is also set when the &%local_parts%& condition in an ACL
10820 matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
10821 available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
10822 variable expands to nothing.
10824 .vitem &$local_part_prefix$&
10825 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
10826 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
10827 specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
10828 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
10830 .vitem &$local_part_suffix$&
10831 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
10832 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
10833 specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
10834 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
10836 .vitem &$local_scan_data$&
10837 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
10838 This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
10839 a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
10841 .vitem &$local_user_gid$&
10842 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
10843 See &$local_user_uid$&.
10845 .vitem &$local_user_uid$&
10846 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
10847 This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
10848 &%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
10849 are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
10850 and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
10851 router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
10852 are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
10854 .vitem &$localhost_number$&
10855 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
10856 This contains the expanded value of the
10857 &%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
10860 .vitem &$log_inodes$&
10861 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
10862 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
10863 log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
10864 referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
10865 the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
10867 .vitem &$log_space$&
10868 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
10869 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
10870 partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
10871 whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
10872 ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
10873 the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
10876 .vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
10877 .vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
10878 This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
10879 &(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
10880 &%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
10881 contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
10882 without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
10885 .vitem &$malware_name$&
10886 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
10887 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
10888 content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
10889 when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
10891 .vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
10892 .vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
10893 .cindex "maximum" "line length"
10894 .cindex "line length" "maximum"
10895 This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
10896 received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
10899 .vitem &$message_age$&
10900 .cindex "message" "age of"
10901 .vindex "&$message_age$&"
10902 This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
10903 of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
10906 .vitem &$message_body$&
10907 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
10908 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
10909 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
10910 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
10911 .oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
10912 This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
10913 being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
10914 number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
10915 &%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
10917 .oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
10918 By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
10919 easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
10920 this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
10921 zeros are always converted into spaces.
10923 .vitem &$message_body_end$&
10924 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
10925 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
10926 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
10927 This variable contains the final portion of a message's
10928 body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
10931 .vitem &$message_body_size$&
10932 .cindex "body of message" "size"
10933 .cindex "message body" "size"
10934 .vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
10935 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
10936 in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
10937 separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
10938 also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
10940 .vitem &$message_exim_id$&
10941 .vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
10942 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
10943 unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
10944 An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
10945 received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
10946 line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
10947 &`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
10949 .vitem &$message_headers$&
10950 .vindex &$message_headers$&
10951 This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
10952 is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
10953 lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
10954 same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
10956 .vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
10957 .vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
10958 This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
10959 contents of header lines is done.
10961 .vitem &$message_id$&
10962 This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&, which is now deprecated.
10964 .vitem &$message_linecount$&
10965 .vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
10966 This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
10967 message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
10968 During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
10969 number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
10970 routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
10971 &'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
10972 lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
10973 from the body is not counted. Here is an example of the use of this variable in
10976 deny message = Too many lines in message header
10978 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
10980 In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
10981 message has not yet been received.
10983 .vitem &$message_size$&
10984 .cindex "size" "of message"
10985 .cindex "message" "size"
10986 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
10987 When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
10988 most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
10989 message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
10990 deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
10991 expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
10992 doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
10993 precise size of the file that has been written. See also
10994 &$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
10996 .cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
10997 While running an ACL at the time of an SMTP RCPT command, &$message_size$&
10998 contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
10999 value may not, of course, be truthful.
11001 .vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
11002 A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
11003 available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
11004 details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
11006 .vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
11007 These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
11008 of the &%add%& command in filter files.
11010 .vitem &$original_domain$&
11011 .vindex "&$domain$&"
11012 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
11013 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
11014 same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
11015 generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
11016 variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
11017 differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
11018 aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
11019 single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
11021 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
11022 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
11023 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
11025 .vitem &$original_local_part$&
11026 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
11027 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
11028 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
11029 same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
11030 local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
11031 part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
11032 filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
11033 the original address.
11035 If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
11036 case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
11037 This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
11038 one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
11039 delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
11041 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
11042 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
11043 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
11045 .vitem &$originator_gid$&
11046 .cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
11047 .cindex "sender" "gid"
11048 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11049 .vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
11050 This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
11051 message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
11052 gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
11053 normally the gid of the Exim user.
11055 .vitem &$originator_uid$&
11056 .cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
11057 .cindex "sender" "uid"
11058 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11059 .vindex "&$originaltor_uid$&"
11060 The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
11061 messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
11062 For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
11065 .vitem &$parent_domain$&
11066 .vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
11067 This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
11068 above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
11070 .vitem &$parent_local_part$&
11071 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
11072 This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
11073 (see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
11076 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
11078 This variable contains the current process id.
11080 .vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
11081 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11082 .cindex "transport" "filter"
11083 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
11084 This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
11085 &`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
11086 &(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
11087 (described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
11088 It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
11089 variable"& error if encountered.
11091 .vitem &$primary_hostname$&
11092 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
11093 This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
11094 configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
11095 a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
11096 &[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
11097 qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
11100 .vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
11101 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11102 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11103 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11105 .vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
11106 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11107 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11108 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11110 .vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
11111 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11112 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11113 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11115 .vitem &$qualify_domain$&
11116 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
11117 The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
11119 .vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
11120 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
11121 The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
11122 or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
11124 .vitem &$rcpt_count$&
11125 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
11126 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11127 RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
11128 RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
11130 .vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
11131 .vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
11132 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
11133 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11134 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
11135 temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
11137 .vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
11138 .vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
11139 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11140 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
11141 permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
11143 .vitem &$received_count$&
11144 .vindex "&$received_count$&"
11145 This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
11146 including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
11147 is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
11150 .vitem &$received_for$&
11151 .vindex "&$received_for$&"
11152 If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
11153 variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
11154 built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
11155 the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
11157 .vitem &$received_ip_address$&
11158 .vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
11159 As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
11160 variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
11161 is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
11162 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
11163 the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
11166 As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
11167 could be used, for example, to make the file name for a TLS certificate depend
11168 on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
11169 values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
11170 messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
11173 &*Note:*& There are no equivalent variables for outgoing connections, because
11174 the values are unknown (unless they are explicitly set by options of the
11175 &(smtp)& transport).
11177 .vitem &$received_port$&
11178 .vindex "&$received_port$&"
11179 See &$received_ip_address$&.
11181 .vitem &$received_protocol$&
11182 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
11183 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
11184 protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
11185 by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
11186 &"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
11187 (encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
11188 is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
11189 connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
11191 Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
11192 automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
11193 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
11194 encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
11195 where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
11196 STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
11198 The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
11199 messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
11200 identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
11202 .vitem &$received_time$&
11203 .vindex "&$received_time$&"
11204 This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
11205 as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
11207 .vitem &$recipient_data$&
11208 .vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
11209 This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
11210 condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
11211 until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
11213 &`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
11214 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
11216 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
11217 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
11218 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
11219 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
11221 .vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
11222 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
11223 In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
11224 information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
11227 &"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
11228 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
11231 &"route"&: Routing failed.
11234 &"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
11235 or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
11239 &"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
11242 &"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
11245 The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
11246 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
11248 .vitem &$recipients$&
11249 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
11250 This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
11251 a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
11252 is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
11253 unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
11257 In a system filter file.
11259 In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
11260 is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
11261 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
11262 &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
11264 From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
11268 .vitem &$recipients_count$&
11269 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
11270 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
11271 envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
11272 from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
11273 increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
11276 .vitem &$regex_match_string$&
11277 .vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
11278 This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
11279 &%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
11282 .vitem &$reply_address$&
11283 .vindex "&$reply_address$&"
11284 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
11285 &'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
11286 contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
11287 white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
11288 decoding or character code translation takes place.
11290 .vitem &$return_path$&
11291 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
11292 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
11293 the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
11294 in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
11295 same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
11296 mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
11297 for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
11298 address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
11299 that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
11300 the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
11303 .vitem &$return_size_limit$&
11304 .vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
11305 This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
11308 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
11309 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
11310 This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
11311 &%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
11312 assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
11313 preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
11314 reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
11317 .vitem &$self_hostname$&
11318 .oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
11319 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
11320 When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
11321 local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
11322 One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
11323 happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
11324 original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
11326 .vitem &$sender_address$&
11327 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
11328 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
11329 that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
11330 is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
11331 value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
11333 .vitem &$sender_address_data$&
11334 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
11335 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
11336 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
11337 sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
11338 distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
11339 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
11340 longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
11342 .vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
11343 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
11344 The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
11346 .vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
11347 .vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
11348 The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
11350 .vitem &$sender_data$&
11351 .vindex "&$sender_data$&"
11352 This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
11353 in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
11354 value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
11357 &`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
11358 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
11360 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
11361 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
11362 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
11363 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
11365 .vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
11366 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
11367 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
11368 name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
11369 brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
11370 enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
11371 issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
11372 looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
11373 &%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
11374 start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
11375 verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
11376 the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
11377 the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
11379 .vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
11380 .vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
11381 When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
11382 command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
11383 set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
11384 the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
11386 .vitem &$sender_host_address$&
11387 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
11388 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains that
11389 host's IP address. For locally submitted messages, it is empty.
11391 .vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
11392 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
11393 This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
11394 driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
11395 received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
11396 &$authenticated_id$&.
11398 .vitem &$sender_host_name$&
11399 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
11400 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
11401 host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
11402 other means, this variable is empty.
11404 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
11405 If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
11406 &$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
11407 A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
11408 via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
11409 any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
11410 &$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
11412 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
11413 However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
11414 DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
11415 &$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
11417 Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
11418 host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
11419 in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
11422 Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
11423 maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
11424 these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
11425 following are true:
11428 A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
11430 The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
11431 configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
11432 to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
11434 Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
11435 that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
11436 &<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
11438 The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
11439 In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
11440 EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
11442 The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
11443 domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
11444 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
11445 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
11447 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
11449 which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
11450 IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
11454 .vitem &$sender_host_port$&
11455 .vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
11456 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
11457 number that was used on the remote host.
11459 .vitem &$sender_ident$&
11460 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
11461 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
11462 identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
11463 been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
11466 .vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
11467 A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
11468 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
11469 &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
11471 .vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
11472 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
11473 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
11474 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
11475 This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
11476 either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
11477 there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
11478 there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
11479 the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
11480 followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
11481 first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
11484 There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
11485 was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
11486 address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
11487 all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
11488 into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
11490 .vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
11491 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
11492 In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
11493 about the failure. The details are the same as for
11494 &$recipient_verify_failure$&.
11496 .vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
11497 .vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
11498 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
11499 been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
11500 used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
11501 on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
11502 connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
11504 .vitem &$sending_port$&
11505 .vindex "&$sending_port$&"
11506 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
11507 been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
11508 connections, see &$received_port$&.
11510 .vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
11511 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
11512 During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
11513 host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
11514 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
11515 value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
11517 .vitem &$smtp_command$&
11518 .vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
11519 During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
11520 entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
11521 the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
11526 For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
11527 command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
11528 rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
11529 the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
11531 .vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
11532 .cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
11533 .vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
11534 While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
11535 argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
11536 space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
11537 somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
11539 .vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
11540 .vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
11541 This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
11542 daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
11543 in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
11544 connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
11545 the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
11546 never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
11547 there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
11548 single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
11549 daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
11551 .vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
11552 These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
11553 that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
11554 filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
11555 example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
11556 message is junk mail.
11558 .vitem &$spam_$&&'xxx'&
11559 A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
11560 is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
11561 &<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
11564 .vitem &$spool_directory$&
11565 .vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
11566 The name of Exim's spool directory.
11568 .vitem &$spool_inodes$&
11569 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
11570 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
11571 being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
11572 If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
11573 is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
11575 .vitem &$spool_space$&
11576 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
11577 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
11578 Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
11579 variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
11580 find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
11581 value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
11582 megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
11584 condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
11586 See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
11589 .vitem &$thisaddress$&
11590 .vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
11591 This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
11592 command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
11593 command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
11594 interfaces to mail filtering'&.
11596 .vitem &$tls_certificate_verified$&
11597 .vindex "&$tls_certificate_verified$&"
11598 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
11599 message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
11601 .vitem &$tls_cipher$&
11602 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
11603 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
11604 connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
11605 example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
11606 received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
11607 &$tls_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
11608 non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
11610 The &$tls_cipher$& variable retains its value during message delivery, except
11611 when an outward SMTP delivery takes place via the &(smtp)& transport. In this
11612 case, &$tls_cipher$& is cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
11613 and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
11614 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
11615 details of the &(smtp)& transport.
11617 .vitem &$tls_peerdn$&
11618 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
11619 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
11620 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
11621 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
11622 &$tls_peerdn$& during subsequent processing. Like &$tls_cipher$&, the
11623 value is retained during message delivery, except during outbound SMTP
11626 .vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
11627 .vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
11628 The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
11629 files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
11631 .vitem &$tod_epoch$&
11632 .vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
11633 The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
11635 .vitem &$tod_full$&
11636 .vindex "&$tod_full$&"
11637 A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
11638 +0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
11639 positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
11640 values for those that are behind (west).
11643 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
11644 The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
11645 1995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
11647 .vitem &$tod_logfile$&
11648 .vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
11649 This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
11650 is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
11653 .vitem &$tod_zone$&
11654 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
11655 This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
11658 .vitem &$tod_zulu$&
11659 .vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
11660 This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
11661 by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
11664 .vindex "&$value$&"
11665 This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
11666 or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
11667 &*reduce*& expansion.
11669 .vitem &$version_number$&
11670 .vindex "&$version_number$&"
11671 The version number of Exim.
11673 .vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
11674 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
11675 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
11676 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
11678 .vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
11679 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
11680 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
11681 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
11687 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11688 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11690 .chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
11691 .scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
11692 Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
11693 Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
11694 use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
11695 your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
11700 in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
11703 .section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
11704 .oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
11705 Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
11706 &%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
11707 no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
11708 interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
11709 the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
11710 option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
11711 a newly created Perl interpreter.
11713 The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
11714 need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
11715 should usually be something like
11717 perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
11719 where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
11720 use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
11721 soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
11722 the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
11723 its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
11724 fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
11725 necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
11726 the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
11730 .oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
11731 Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
11732 a startup when Exim is entered.
11734 The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
11735 overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
11738 There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
11739 initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
11742 .section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
11743 When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
11744 of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
11745 by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
11749 ${perl{foo}{argument}}
11750 ${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
11752 which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
11753 arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
11754 with an error message of the form
11756 Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
11758 The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
11759 it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
11760 return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
11761 an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
11762 by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
11763 that was passed to &%die%&.
11766 .section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
11767 Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
11768 is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
11771 my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
11773 makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
11774 Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
11775 &$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
11777 If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
11778 &'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
11779 expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
11780 an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
11782 .cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
11783 .cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
11784 Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
11785 &'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
11786 debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
11787 &'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
11788 timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
11791 .section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
11792 .cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
11793 You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
11794 Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
11795 before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
11796 SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
11797 is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
11798 error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
11799 avoided, but the output is lost.
11801 .cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
11802 The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
11803 Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
11804 you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
11805 output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
11806 change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
11807 For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
11809 $SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
11811 Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
11812 example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
11813 include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
11814 as the first subroutine argument.
11818 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11819 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11821 .chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
11822 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
11823 "Starting the daemon"
11824 .cindex "daemon" "starting"
11825 .cindex "interface" "listening"
11826 .cindex "network interface"
11827 .cindex "interface" "network"
11828 .cindex "IP address" "for listening"
11829 .cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
11830 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
11831 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
11832 A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
11833 hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
11834 or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
11835 works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
11836 In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
11837 IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
11838 knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
11841 When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
11842 and ports to listen on.
11844 When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
11845 are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
11846 processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
11847 same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
11848 when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
11849 local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
11850 option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
11851 as an error situation.
11853 When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
11854 for the outgoing connection.
11858 Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
11859 of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
11860 addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
11861 standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
11862 rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
11864 In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
11865 interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
11866 options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
11867 chapter describes how they operate.
11869 When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
11870 actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
11874 .section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
11875 When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
11876 option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
11880 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports. (For backward
11881 compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
11883 &%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
11884 listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
11887 The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
11888 described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
11889 it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
11890 colons. For example:
11892 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
11895 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
11897 There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
11898 in &%local_interfaces%&:
11901 The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
11902 on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
11904 local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
11905 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
11908 The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
11909 with a colon separator, for example:
11911 local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
11912 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
11916 When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
11917 default setting contains just one port:
11919 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
11921 If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
11922 specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
11923 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
11924 &_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
11925 IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
11929 .section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
11930 The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
11931 as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
11932 case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
11933 instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
11934 default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
11936 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
11938 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
11940 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
11942 Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
11946 .section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
11947 The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
11948 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
11949 instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
11950 option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
11951 the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
11954 The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
11955 changed in the usual way if required. If there are any items that do not
11956 contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
11957 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
11958 items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
11959 replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
11963 overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
11966 -oX 192.168.34.5.1125
11968 overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
11969 (However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
11970 value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
11974 .section "Support for the obsolete SSMTP (or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
11975 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
11976 .cindex "smtps protocol"
11977 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
11978 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
11979 Exim supports the obsolete SSMTP protocol (also known as SMTPS) that was used
11980 before the STARTTLS command was standardized for SMTP. Some legacy clients
11981 still use this protocol. If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a
11982 list of port numbers, connections to those ports must use SSMTP. The most
11983 common use of this option is expected to be
11985 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
11987 because 465 is the usual port number used by the legacy clients. There is also
11988 a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports to behave in
11989 this way when a daemon is started.
11991 &*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
11992 daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
11993 &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
11994 because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
11995 connections via the daemon.)
12000 .section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
12001 .cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
12002 IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
12003 can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
12004 interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
12005 address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
12006 percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
12007 adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
12009 fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
12011 To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
12012 allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
12013 to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
12014 percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
12015 address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
12016 &[getaddrinfo()]&. If
12018 IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
12020 is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
12021 Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
12022 instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
12023 function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
12024 &[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
12026 .section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
12027 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
12028 Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
12029 run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
12030 using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
12031 connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
12032 .oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
12033 &%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
12034 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
12035 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
12036 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
12037 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
12039 On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
12040 disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
12041 option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
12042 and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
12043 IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
12047 .section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
12048 The default case in an IPv6 environment is
12050 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
12051 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
12053 This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
12054 Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
12055 the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
12056 read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
12058 To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
12060 daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
12062 (leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
12064 local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
12065 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
12067 To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
12068 IPv4 loopback address only:
12070 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
12072 To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
12074 local_interfaces = 192.168.34.67 : 192.168.34.67
12076 &*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
12080 .section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
12081 The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
12082 whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
12083 addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
12086 For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
12087 the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
12088 available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
12089 (that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
12091 Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
12092 many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
12093 email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
12094 interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
12095 &%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
12096 &"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
12097 used for listening. Consider this example:
12099 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
12101 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
12103 extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
12105 The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
12106 address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
12109 In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
12110 address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
12111 desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
12112 these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
12113 This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
12114 during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
12115 host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
12116 addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
12120 .section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
12121 Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
12122 allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
12123 there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
12124 &%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
12125 description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
12131 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12132 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12134 .chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
12135 .scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
12136 .scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
12137 The first part of the run time configuration file contains three types of item:
12140 Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
12141 &<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
12143 Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
12144 &"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
12145 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
12147 Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
12148 (with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
12149 &"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
12150 only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
12154 This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
12155 types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
12156 in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
12157 are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
12158 an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
12159 listed in more than one group.
12161 .section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
12163 .row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
12164 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
12165 .row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
12166 .row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
12167 .row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
12168 .row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
12169 .row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
12170 .row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
12171 .row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
12175 .section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
12177 .row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
12178 .row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
12179 .row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
12180 .row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
12181 .row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
12182 .row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
12187 .section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
12189 .row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
12190 .row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
12191 .row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
12192 .row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
12193 .row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
12194 .row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
12195 .row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
12196 .row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
12197 .row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
12198 .row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
12199 .row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
12204 .section "Logging" "SECID99"
12206 .row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
12207 .row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
12208 .row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
12209 .row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
12210 .row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
12211 .row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
12212 .row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
12213 .row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
12214 .row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
12215 .row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
12216 .row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
12217 .row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
12222 .section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
12224 .row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
12225 .row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
12226 .row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
12227 .row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
12232 .section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
12234 .row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
12235 .row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
12236 .row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
12237 .row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
12238 .row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
12239 .row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
12240 .row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
12241 .row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
12246 .section "Message ids" "SECID102"
12248 .row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
12249 .row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
12254 .section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
12256 .row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
12257 .row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
12262 .section "Daemon" "SECID104"
12264 .row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
12265 .row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
12266 .row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
12267 .row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
12268 .row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
12269 .row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
12270 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
12275 .section "Resource control" "SECID105"
12277 .row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
12278 .row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
12279 .row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
12280 .row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
12281 .row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
12282 .row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
12283 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
12284 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
12285 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
12286 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
12287 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
12288 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
12289 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
12290 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
12291 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
12292 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
12294 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
12295 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
12296 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
12297 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
12298 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
12303 .section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
12305 .row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
12306 .row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
12307 .row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
12308 .row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
12309 .row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
12310 .row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
12311 .row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
12312 .row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
12313 .row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
12314 .row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
12315 .row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
12316 .row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
12317 .row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
12318 .row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
12319 .row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
12320 .row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
12321 .row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
12322 .row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
12323 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
12325 .row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
12326 .row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
12327 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
12328 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
12329 .row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
12330 .row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
12331 .row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
12332 .row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
12333 .row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
12334 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
12335 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
12336 .row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
12337 .row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
12338 .row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
12339 .row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
12340 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
12341 .row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
12342 .row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
12347 .section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
12349 .row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
12351 .row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
12353 .row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
12354 .row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
12355 .row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
12360 .section "TLS" "SECID108"
12362 .row &%gnutls_require_kx%& "control GnuTLS key exchanges"
12363 .row &%gnutls_require_mac%& "control GnuTLS MAC algorithms"
12364 .row &%gnutls_require_protocols%& "control GnuTLS protocols"
12365 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
12366 .row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
12367 .row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
12368 .row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
12369 .row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
12370 .row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
12371 .row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
12372 .row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
12373 .row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
12374 .row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
12375 .row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
12380 .section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
12382 .row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
12383 .row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
12384 .row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
12385 .row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
12386 .row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
12387 .row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
12388 .row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
12389 .row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
12394 .section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
12396 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
12397 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
12398 .row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
12399 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
12400 .row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
12401 .row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
12402 .row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
12403 .row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
12409 .section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
12411 .row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
12418 .section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
12419 See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
12422 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
12423 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
12424 .row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
12425 .row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
12426 .row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
12427 .row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
12428 .row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
12429 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
12430 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
12431 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
12432 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
12433 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
12434 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
12435 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
12437 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
12438 .row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
12439 .row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
12440 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
12441 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
12442 .row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
12443 .row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
12444 .row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
12445 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
12446 .row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
12447 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
12448 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
12449 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
12450 .row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
12451 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
12452 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
12457 .section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
12459 .row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
12460 .row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
12461 .row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
12462 .row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
12463 .row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
12464 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
12469 .section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
12471 .row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
12472 .row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
12473 .row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
12474 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
12476 .row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
12477 .row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
12478 .row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
12479 .row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
12480 .row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
12481 .row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
12482 .row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
12483 .row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
12484 .row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
12485 .row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
12490 .section "System filter" "SECID115"
12492 .row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
12493 .row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
12495 .row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
12496 .row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
12497 .row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
12498 .row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
12499 .row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
12504 .section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
12506 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
12507 .row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
12508 .row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
12509 .row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
12510 .row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
12511 .row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
12512 .row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
12513 .row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
12514 .row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
12515 .row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
12516 .row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
12517 .row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
12518 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
12519 .row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
12520 .row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
12521 .row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
12522 .row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
12523 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
12524 .row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
12525 .row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
12526 .row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
12531 .section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
12533 .row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
12534 .row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
12535 .row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
12536 .row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
12537 .row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
12538 .row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
12539 .row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
12540 .row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
12541 .row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
12542 .row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
12543 .row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
12544 .row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
12545 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
12546 .row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
12551 .section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
12552 Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
12555 .option accept_8bitmime main boolean false
12557 .cindex "8-bit characters"
12558 This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
12559 EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
12560 However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
12561 takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
12562 Consequently, this option is turned off by default.
12564 .option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
12565 .cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
12566 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
12567 This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
12568 read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
12571 .option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
12572 This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
12573 messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
12576 .option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
12577 .cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
12578 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
12579 This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
12580 non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12582 .option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
12583 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
12584 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
12585 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
12586 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12588 .option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
12589 .cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
12590 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
12591 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12593 .option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
12594 .cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
12595 This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
12596 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
12597 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12599 .option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
12600 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
12601 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
12602 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12604 .option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
12605 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
12606 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
12607 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12609 .option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
12610 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
12611 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
12612 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
12613 command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12616 .option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
12617 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
12618 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
12619 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12621 .option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
12622 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
12623 This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
12624 a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
12625 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
12627 .option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
12628 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
12629 This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
12630 extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
12631 section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
12633 .option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
12634 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
12635 received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
12638 .option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
12639 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
12640 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
12641 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12643 .option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
12644 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
12645 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
12646 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12648 .option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
12649 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
12650 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
12651 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12653 .option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
12654 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
12655 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
12656 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12658 .option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
12659 .cindex "admin user"
12660 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
12661 current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
12662 colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
12663 programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
12664 admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
12665 not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
12666 To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
12668 .option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
12669 .cindex "domain literal"
12670 If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
12671 email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
12672 format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
12673 has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
12675 Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
12676 format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
12677 addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
12678 &%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
12679 domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
12680 configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
12681 the local host's IP addresses.
12684 .option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
12685 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
12686 It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
12687 and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
12688 MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
12689 that explains the mis-configuration. However, some other MTAs support this
12690 practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
12691 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
12692 recommended, except when you have no other choice.
12694 .option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
12695 .cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
12696 .cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
12697 Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
12698 camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
12699 that at least two other MTAs permit this. This option allows Exim users to
12700 experiment if they wish.
12702 If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
12703 UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
12704 letters, digits, and hyphens. However, just setting this option is not
12705 enough; if you want to look up these domain names in the DNS, you must also
12706 adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
12707 suitable setting is:
12709 dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
12710 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
12712 Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
12714 dns_check_names_pattern =
12716 That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
12719 .option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
12720 .cindex "authentication" "advertising"
12721 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
12722 If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
12723 response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
12724 Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
12725 Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
12726 advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
12727 authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
12728 &%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
12729 authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
12731 Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
12732 and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
12733 not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
12734 authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
12735 to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
12736 which Exim advertises AUTH.
12738 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
12739 If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
12740 is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
12741 option is expanded, with a setting like this:
12743 auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_cipher}{}{}{*}}
12745 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
12746 If &$tls_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
12747 the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
12748 expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
12751 .option auto_thaw main time 0s
12752 .cindex "thawing messages"
12753 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
12754 If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
12755 new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
12756 this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
12757 being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
12758 saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
12760 &*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
12761 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
12762 thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
12764 .option av_scanner main string "see below"
12765 This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
12766 It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
12768 sophie:/var/run/sophie
12770 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with dollar character, it is expanded
12771 before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
12775 .option bi_command main string unset
12777 This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
12778 the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
12779 just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
12780 required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
12783 .option bounce_message_file main string unset
12784 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
12785 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
12786 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
12787 for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
12788 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%warn_message_file%&.
12791 .option bounce_message_text main string unset
12792 When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
12793 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
12794 delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
12796 .option bounce_return_body main boolean true
12797 .cindex "bounce message" "including body"
12798 This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
12799 bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
12800 causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
12801 value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
12802 message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
12803 error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
12804 point at which the error was detected are returned.
12805 .cindex "bounce message" "including original"
12807 .option bounce_return_message main boolean true
12808 If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
12809 bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
12810 &%bounce_return_body%&.
12813 .option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
12814 .cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
12815 .cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
12816 .cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
12817 This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
12818 senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
12819 limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
12820 any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
12821 that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
12823 When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
12824 greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
12825 added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
12826 to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
12827 size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
12830 .option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
12831 .cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
12832 .cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
12833 .cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
12834 This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
12835 bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
12836 connection. A typical setting might be:
12838 bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
12840 which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
12842 MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
12844 The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
12847 .option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
12848 .cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
12849 .cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
12850 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
12851 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
12852 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
12855 .option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
12856 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
12857 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
12858 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
12861 .option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
12862 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
12863 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
12864 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
12867 .option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
12868 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
12869 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
12870 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
12873 .option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
12874 This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
12875 callout verification. The default value is
12877 $primary_host_name-$tod_epoch-testing
12879 See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
12882 .option check_log_inodes main integer 0
12883 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
12886 .option check_log_space main integer 0
12887 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
12889 .oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
12890 .cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
12891 .option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
12892 RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
12893 system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
12894 word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
12895 multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
12896 exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
12897 of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
12898 set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
12901 .option check_spool_inodes main integer 0
12902 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
12905 .option check_spool_space main integer 0
12906 .cindex "checking disk space"
12907 .cindex "disk space, checking"
12908 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
12909 The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
12910 message is accepted.
12912 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
12913 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
12914 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
12915 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
12916 When any of these options are set, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
12917 want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
12918 testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
12919 &$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
12922 &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
12923 either value is greater than zero, for example:
12925 check_spool_space = 10M
12926 check_spool_inodes = 100
12928 The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
12929 SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
12932 &%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
12933 files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
12934 &%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
12936 If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
12937 incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
12938 error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
12939 SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
12940 &%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
12941 &%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
12943 The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
12944 number of kilobytes. If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
12946 For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
12947 failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
12948 it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
12950 .option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
12951 .cindex "port" "for daemon"
12952 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
12953 This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
12954 listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
12955 backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
12957 .option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
12958 .cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
12959 This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
12960 the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
12961 (typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
12962 defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
12963 &%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
12965 .option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
12966 See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
12968 .option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
12969 .cindex "warning of delay"
12970 .cindex "delay warning, specifying"
12971 When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
12972 intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
12973 after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
12974 string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
12975 message has been on the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
12976 between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
12979 delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
12981 the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
12982 the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
12983 because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
12984 just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
12988 messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
12989 a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
12991 delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
12994 .option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
12995 .vindex "&$domain$&"
12996 The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
12997 deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
12998 expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
12999 forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
13000 &"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
13001 not sent. The default is:
13003 delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
13004 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
13005 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
13006 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
13009 This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
13010 &'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
13011 &"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
13012 &"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
13014 .option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
13015 .cindex "unprivileged delivery"
13016 .cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
13017 If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
13018 delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
13019 the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
13020 of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
13021 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
13023 .option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
13024 .cindex "load average"
13025 .cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
13026 When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
13027 becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
13028 ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
13029 See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
13032 .option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
13033 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
13034 Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
13035 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
13036 handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
13037 should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
13038 removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
13039 occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
13041 .option disable_fsync main boolean false
13042 .cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
13043 This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
13044 ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
13045 a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
13046 build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
13047 really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
13048 distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
13050 When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
13051 updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
13052 such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
13053 Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
13056 .option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
13057 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
13058 If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
13059 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
13060 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
13061 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
13062 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
13065 .option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
13066 .cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
13067 DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
13068 &"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
13069 keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
13070 incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
13071 may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
13072 anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
13073 This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
13074 by a setting such as this:
13076 dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
13078 This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
13079 &[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
13080 since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
13081 &(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
13082 when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
13083 options are applied after this global option.
13085 .option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
13086 .cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
13087 When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
13088 names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
13089 the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
13090 contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
13091 a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
13092 done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
13093 value of this option. The default pattern is
13095 dns_check_names_pattern = \
13096 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
13098 which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
13099 they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
13100 permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
13101 accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
13102 &%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
13105 .option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
13106 This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
13107 DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
13109 .option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
13110 This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
13111 reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
13112 section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
13114 .option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
13115 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
13116 .cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
13117 When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
13118 looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
13119 (A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
13120 domain matches this list.
13122 This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
13123 not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
13124 servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
13127 .option dns_retrans main time 0s
13128 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
13129 The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
13130 retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
13131 defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
13132 time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
13133 totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
13134 take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
13135 parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
13136 but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
13140 .option dns_retry main integer 0
13141 See &%dns_retrans%& above.
13144 .option drop_cr main boolean false
13145 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
13146 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
13147 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
13149 .option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
13150 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
13151 .cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
13152 This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
13153 bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
13154 Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
13156 dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
13158 The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
13159 panic is logged, and the default value is used.
13161 .option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
13162 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
13163 Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
13164 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
13165 handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
13166 messages's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
13167 be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
13168 the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
13169 delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
13172 .option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
13173 .cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
13174 .cindex "copy of bounce message"
13175 Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
13176 generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
13177 coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
13178 items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
13179 a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
13180 must be enclosed in double quotes.
13182 Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
13183 (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
13184 the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
13185 items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
13186 are examined. For example:
13188 errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
13189 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
13190 postmaster@mydomain.example
13192 .vindex "&$domain$&"
13193 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
13194 The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
13195 and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
13196 there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
13197 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
13198 variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
13201 .option errors_reply_to main string unset
13202 .cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
13203 By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
13205 &`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
13207 .oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
13208 where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
13209 A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
13210 &(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
13211 overrides the default.
13213 Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
13214 &%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
13215 and warning messages. For example:
13217 errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
13219 The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
13220 address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
13221 &%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
13222 own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
13226 .option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
13227 .cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
13228 .cindex "Exim group"
13229 This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
13230 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
13231 option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
13232 of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
13233 configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
13237 .option exim_path main string "see below"
13238 .cindex "Exim binary, path name"
13239 This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
13240 needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
13241 the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
13242 is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
13244 &*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
13245 you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
13246 where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
13247 settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
13250 .option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
13251 .cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
13252 .cindex "Exim user"
13253 This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
13254 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
13255 time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
13256 options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
13258 Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
13259 &[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
13260 not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
13261 used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
13264 .option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
13265 This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
13266 routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
13267 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
13270 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
13271 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
13273 .option "extract_addresses_remove_ &~&~arguments" main boolean true &&&
13274 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
13276 .cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
13277 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
13278 According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
13279 are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
13280 envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
13281 line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
13282 behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
13283 command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
13284 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
13285 argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
13289 .option finduser_retries main integer 0
13290 .cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
13291 On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
13292 distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
13293 related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
13294 Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
13295 errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
13296 many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
13299 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
13300 You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
13301 a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
13302 search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
13306 .option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
13307 .cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
13308 On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
13309 ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
13310 delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
13311 &%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
13312 feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
13313 warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
13314 freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
13315 is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
13316 supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
13317 message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
13318 freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
13319 log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
13320 logging that you require.
13323 .option gecos_name main string&!! unset
13325 .cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
13326 Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
13327 password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
13328 looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
13329 headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
13330 of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
13331 it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
13332 upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
13334 When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
13335 expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
13336 login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
13339 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
13340 Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
13341 pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
13342 name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
13344 gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
13348 .option gecos_pattern main string unset
13349 See &%gecos_name%& above.
13352 .option gnutls_require_kx main string unset
13353 This option controls the key exchange mechanisms when GnuTLS is used in an Exim
13354 server. For details, see section &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
13356 .option gnutls_require_mac main string unset
13357 This option controls the MAC algorithms when GnuTLS is used in an Exim
13358 server. For details, see section &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
13360 .option gnutls_require_protocols main string unset
13361 This option controls the protocols when GnuTLS is used in an Exim
13362 server. For details, see section &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
13365 .option headers_charset main string "see below"
13366 This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
13367 &"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
13368 default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
13369 ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
13370 insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
13374 .option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
13375 .cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
13376 .cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
13377 This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
13378 section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
13379 &_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
13380 sections are rejected.
13383 .option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
13384 .cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
13385 .cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
13386 This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
13387 all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
13388 header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
13389 zero means &"no limit"&.
13394 .option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
13395 .cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
13396 .cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
13397 Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
13398 mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
13399 some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
13400 this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
13401 if you want to do semantic checking.
13402 See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
13406 .option helo_allow_chars main string unset
13407 .cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
13408 .cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
13409 .cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
13410 This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
13411 all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
13412 hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
13414 helo_allow_chars = _
13416 Note that the value is one string, not a list.
13419 .option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
13420 .cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
13421 .cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
13422 If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
13423 list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
13424 default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
13425 its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
13429 .option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
13430 .cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
13431 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
13432 By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
13433 &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
13434 to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
13435 condition &`verify`& &`=`& &`helo`& is provided to make this possible.
13436 Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
13437 to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
13438 necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify`& &`=`& &`helo`& is
13439 encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
13440 Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
13442 When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
13443 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
13444 EHLO command either:
13447 is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
13449 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
13450 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
13451 matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
13452 calling host address, or
13454 when looked up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when
13455 available) yields the calling host address.
13458 However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
13459 fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
13460 be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify`& &`=`& &`helo`& condition.
13462 .option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
13463 .cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
13464 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
13465 Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
13466 backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
13467 name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
13468 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
13469 rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
13470 If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
13473 .option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
13474 .cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
13475 .cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
13476 This option allows mail for particular domains to be held on the queue
13477 manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
13478 &%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
13479 verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
13480 item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
13481 it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
13483 This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
13484 delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
13485 configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
13486 domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
13487 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
13489 A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
13490 messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
13491 time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
13492 retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
13495 .option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
13496 .cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
13497 Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
13498 is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
13499 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
13500 option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
13501 default configuration file contains
13505 which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
13506 is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
13508 After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
13509 has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
13510 this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
13512 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
13513 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
13514 After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
13515 unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
13516 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and &`verify`& &`=`&
13517 &`reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
13520 .option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
13521 This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
13522 to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
13523 first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
13524 if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
13527 &*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
13528 multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
13529 &_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
13530 case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
13534 .option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
13535 .cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
13536 If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
13537 as soon as the connection is made.
13538 This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
13539 nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
13540 connections immediately.
13542 The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
13543 ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
13544 sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
13545 incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
13546 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
13549 .option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
13550 .cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
13551 This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
13552 happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
13553 you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
13554 127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
13555 the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
13556 list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
13557 local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
13559 hosts_connection_nolog = :
13561 If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
13565 .option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
13566 .cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
13567 .cindex "host" "treated as local"
13568 If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
13569 if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
13571 or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
13572 host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
13574 This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
13575 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
13576 section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
13577 &(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
13578 that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
13579 chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
13580 interfaces and recognizing the local host.
13583 .option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
13584 .cindex "InterBase" "server list"
13585 This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
13586 to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
13587 The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
13591 .option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
13592 .cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
13593 .cindex "discarding bounce message"
13594 This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
13595 that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
13596 suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
13598 After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
13599 because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
13600 message has been on the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
13601 the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
13602 again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
13603 bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
13604 for frozen messages. For example,
13606 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
13608 retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
13609 failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
13610 failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
13611 value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
13612 dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
13613 &%timeout_frozen_after%&.
13616 .option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
13617 .cindex "&""From""& line"
13618 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
13619 Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
13620 the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
13621 message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
13622 such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
13623 match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
13624 process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
13625 &%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
13628 .option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
13629 See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
13632 .option keep_malformed main time 4d
13633 This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
13634 have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
13635 next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
13639 .option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
13640 .cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
13641 This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
13642 LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
13643 details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
13647 .option ldap_version main integer unset
13648 .cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
13649 This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
13650 LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
13651 -1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
13652 the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
13653 has been built with LDAP support.
13657 .option local_from_check main boolean true
13658 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
13659 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
13660 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
13661 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
13662 checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
13663 the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
13665 &*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
13666 locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
13667 &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
13669 You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
13670 on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
13671 &'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
13672 and the default qualify domain.
13674 If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
13675 and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
13676 &'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
13677 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
13679 .cindex "envelope sender"
13680 These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
13681 is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
13682 &%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
13684 For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
13685 request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
13686 has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
13691 .option local_from_prefix main string unset
13692 When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
13693 matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
13694 ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
13695 done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
13696 appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
13697 &%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
13700 local_from_prefix = *-
13702 is set, a &'From:'& line containing
13704 From: anything-user@your.domain.example
13706 will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
13707 matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
13711 .option local_from_suffix main string unset
13712 See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
13715 .option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
13716 This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
13717 listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
13718 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
13719 options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
13720 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
13721 &%local_interfaces%& is
13723 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
13725 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
13727 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13730 .option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
13731 .cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
13732 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
13733 This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
13734 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
13735 the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
13736 message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
13737 non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
13741 .option local_sender_retain main boolean false
13742 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
13743 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
13744 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
13745 do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
13746 also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
13747 See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
13748 &<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
13753 .option localhost_number main string&!! unset
13754 .cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
13755 .cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
13756 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
13757 Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
13758 uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
13759 value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
13760 after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
13761 host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
13762 range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
13763 systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
13764 &$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
13765 characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
13766 time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
13767 section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
13771 .option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
13772 .cindex "log" "file path for"
13773 This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
13774 files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
13775 when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
13776 name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or run time, they
13777 are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
13778 Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
13779 section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
13780 used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
13781 variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
13782 configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
13783 &_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
13784 early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
13787 .option log_selector main string unset
13788 .cindex "log" "selectors"
13789 This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
13790 writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
13791 minus characters. For example:
13793 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
13795 A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
13796 logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
13799 .option log_timezone main boolean false
13800 .cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
13801 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
13802 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
13803 By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
13804 timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
13805 in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
13806 avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
13807 &%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
13808 timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
13809 of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
13810 &$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
13811 another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
13814 .option lookup_open_max main integer 25
13815 .cindex "too many open files"
13816 .cindex "open files, too many"
13817 .cindex "file" "too many open"
13818 .cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
13819 .cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
13820 This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
13821 lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
13822 Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
13823 file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
13824 recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
13825 actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
13826 as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
13827 open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
13828 &%lookup_open_max%&.
13831 .option max_username_length main integer 0
13832 .cindex "length of login name"
13833 .cindex "user name" "maximum length"
13834 .cindex "limit" "user name length"
13835 Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
13836 &[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
13837 this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
13838 an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
13841 .option message_body_newlines main bool false
13842 .cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
13843 .cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
13844 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
13845 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
13846 By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
13847 the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
13848 option is set true, this no longer happens.
13851 .option message_body_visible main integer 500
13852 .cindex "body of message" "visible size"
13853 .cindex "message body" "visible size"
13854 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
13855 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
13856 This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
13857 &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
13860 .option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
13861 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
13862 If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
13863 (domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
13864 locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
13865 means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
13866 Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
13867 Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
13868 replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
13869 empty string, the option is ignored.
13872 .option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
13873 If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
13874 the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
13875 message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
13876 take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
13877 the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
13878 it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
13879 yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
13880 before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
13881 that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
13882 means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
13883 colons will become hyphens.
13886 .option message_logs main boolean true
13887 .cindex "message logs" "disabling"
13888 .cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
13889 If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
13890 &_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
13891 Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
13892 minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
13893 per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
13894 which is not affected by this option.
13897 .option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
13898 .cindex "message" "size limit"
13899 .cindex "limit" "message size"
13900 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
13901 This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
13902 value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
13903 to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
13904 TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
13905 optionally followed by K or M.
13907 &*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
13908 other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
13909 the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
13910 error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
13911 &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
13913 Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
13914 exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
13915 failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
13916 an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
13917 the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
13918 message that an individual transport can process.
13921 .option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
13922 .cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
13923 This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
13925 SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
13927 in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
13928 moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
13929 and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
13930 standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
13931 lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
13934 .option mua_wrapper main boolean false
13935 Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
13936 it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
13937 contains a full description of this facility.
13941 .option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
13942 .cindex "MySQL" "server list"
13943 This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
13944 be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
13945 option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
13948 .option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
13949 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
13950 message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
13951 recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
13952 It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
13955 When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
13956 list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
13957 the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
13958 contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
13959 can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
13961 If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
13962 &%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
13965 never_users = root:daemon:bin
13967 Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
13968 harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
13972 .option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
13973 .cindex "Oracle" "server list"
13974 This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
13975 to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
13976 The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
13979 .option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
13980 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
13981 .cindex "source routing" "in email address"
13982 .cindex "address" "source-routed"
13983 The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
13984 percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
13985 replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
13986 also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
13987 option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
13988 but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
13991 &*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
13992 trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
13993 if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
13994 implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
13995 routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
13996 a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
13997 local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
14000 .option perl_at_start main boolean false
14001 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
14002 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
14005 .option perl_startup main string unset
14006 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
14007 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
14010 .option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
14011 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
14012 This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
14013 data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
14014 &<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
14015 PostgreSQL support.
14018 .option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
14019 .cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
14020 .cindex "pid file, path for"
14021 This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
14022 process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
14025 pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
14027 If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
14029 The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
14030 option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
14031 of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
14034 .option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14035 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
14036 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
14037 PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
14038 control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
14039 &%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
14040 for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
14041 that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
14042 not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
14045 .option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
14046 .cindex "message logs" "preserving"
14047 If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
14048 completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
14049 called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
14050 purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
14051 volume of mail. Use with care!
14054 .option primary_hostname main string "see below"
14055 .cindex "name" "of local host"
14056 .cindex "host" "name of local"
14057 .cindex "local host" "name of"
14058 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
14059 This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
14060 HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
14061 option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
14062 The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
14063 server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
14065 If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
14066 name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
14067 contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
14068 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
14069 version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
14070 explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
14073 .option print_topbitchars main boolean false
14074 .cindex "printing characters"
14075 .cindex "8-bit characters"
14076 By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
14077 32&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
14078 when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
14079 sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
14080 is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
14083 This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
14084 &(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
14085 the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
14086 described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
14087 Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
14091 .option process_log_path main string unset
14092 .cindex "process log path"
14093 .cindex "log" "process log"
14094 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
14095 This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
14096 &"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
14097 utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
14098 in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
14099 can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
14100 different spool directories.
14103 .option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
14107 The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
14108 admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
14109 &%queue_list_requires_admin%&.
14112 .option qualify_domain main string "see below"
14113 .cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
14114 .cindex "address" "qualification"
14115 This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
14116 addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
14117 recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
14118 are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
14119 also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
14120 locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
14122 Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
14123 unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
14124 &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
14125 addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
14126 necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
14127 addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
14128 &%primary_hostname%& value.
14131 .option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
14132 This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
14133 addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
14137 .option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14138 .cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
14139 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14140 .cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
14141 This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
14142 A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
14143 domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
14144 next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
14147 .option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
14149 The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
14150 queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
14151 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false. See also &%prod_requires_admin%&.
14154 .option queue_only main boolean false
14155 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14156 .cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
14157 If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
14158 whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits on the queue for the
14159 next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
14160 delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
14162 The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
14163 and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
14164 &%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
14165 &%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
14168 .option queue_only_file main string unset
14169 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14170 .cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
14171 This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
14172 one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
14173 it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
14174 each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
14175 For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
14176 &"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
14178 queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
14180 causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
14181 &_/some/file_& exists.
14184 .option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
14185 .cindex "load average"
14186 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14187 .cindex "message" "queueing by load"
14188 If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
14189 all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
14190 happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
14191 the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
14192 the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
14195 Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
14196 option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
14197 determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
14198 &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
14201 .option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
14202 .cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
14203 When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
14204 because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
14205 all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
14206 This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
14207 threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
14208 connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
14209 circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
14210 where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
14211 should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
14212 re-evaluated for each message.
14215 .option queue_only_override main boolean true
14216 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14217 When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
14218 setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
14219 &%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
14220 to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
14223 .option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
14224 .cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
14225 If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
14226 in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
14227 must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
14228 single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
14229 and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
14230 single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
14231 the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
14232 avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
14233 &%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
14234 when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
14235 large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
14239 .option queue_run_max main integer 5
14240 .cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
14241 This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
14242 can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
14243 but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
14244 start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
14245 very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
14246 however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
14247 started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
14249 Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
14250 the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
14251 run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
14252 the daemon's command line.
14254 .option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14255 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14256 .cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
14257 When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
14258 received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
14259 However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
14260 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
14261 message waits on the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
14262 has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
14263 when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
14264 over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
14265 SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
14266 &%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
14270 .option receive_timeout main time 0s
14271 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
14272 This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
14273 maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
14274 the value is zero, it will wait for ever. This setting is overridden by the
14275 &%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
14276 controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
14278 .option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
14279 .cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
14280 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
14281 This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
14282 added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
14283 on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
14284 used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
14285 added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
14286 &"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
14287 header lines. The default setting is:
14290 received_header_text = Received: \
14291 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
14292 {${if def:sender_ident \
14293 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
14294 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
14295 by $primary_hostname \
14296 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol}} \
14297 ${if def:tls_cipher {($tls_cipher)\n\t}}\
14298 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
14299 ${if def:sender_address \
14300 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
14301 id $message_exim_id\
14302 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
14305 The reference to the TLS cipher is omitted when Exim is built without TLS
14306 support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
14307 locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
14308 header lines such as the following:
14310 Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
14311 by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
14312 (envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
14313 id 16IOWa-00019l-00
14314 for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
14315 Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
14316 id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
14318 Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
14319 the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
14320 checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
14321 message was accepted.
14324 .option received_headers_max main integer 30
14325 .cindex "loop" "prevention"
14326 .cindex "mail loop prevention"
14327 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
14328 When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
14329 counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
14330 have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
14331 This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
14334 .option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14335 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
14336 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
14337 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
14338 recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
14339 qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
14340 affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
14341 addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
14342 host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
14343 or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
14344 option was not set.
14347 .option recipients_max main integer 0
14348 .cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
14349 .cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
14350 If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
14351 original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
14352 by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
14353 all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
14354 Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
14357 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
14358 &*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
14359 RCPT commands in a single message.
14362 .option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
14363 If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
14364 recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
14365 error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
14366 error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
14367 initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
14368 for the remaining recipients at a later time.
14371 .option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
14372 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
14373 This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
14374 hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
14375 does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
14376 message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
14377 have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
14378 deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
14379 deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
14380 each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
14381 same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
14382 &%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
14383 with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
14384 tagged with its process id.
14386 This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
14387 message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
14388 manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
14389 deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
14392 .cindex "number of deliveries"
14393 .cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
14394 If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
14395 need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
14396 are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
14397 daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
14398 fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
14399 runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
14400 delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
14401 then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
14402 &%remote_max_parallel%&.
14404 If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
14405 &%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
14406 doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
14407 host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
14410 .option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14411 .cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
14412 .cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
14413 When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
14414 domain into the order given by this list. For example,
14416 remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
14418 would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
14419 then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
14422 .option retry_data_expire main time 7d
14423 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
14424 This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
14425 database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
14426 host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
14430 .option retry_interval_max main time 24h
14431 .cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
14432 .cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
14433 Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
14434 intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
14435 straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
14436 retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
14440 .option return_path_remove main boolean true
14441 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
14442 RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
14443 &'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
14444 The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
14445 MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
14446 in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
14447 &'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
14448 received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
14449 the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
14452 .option return_size_limit main integer 100K
14453 This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
14456 .option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14458 .cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
14459 RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches an item
14462 .option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 5s
14463 .cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
14464 .cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
14465 This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
14466 no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
14469 .option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14470 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
14471 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
14472 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
14473 sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
14474 &%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
14475 not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
14476 it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
14477 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
14478 using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
14481 .option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
14482 .cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
14483 This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
14484 TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
14485 connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
14486 other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
14487 still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
14488 this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
14489 connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
14490 tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
14491 hours to detect unreachable hosts.
14495 .option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
14496 .cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
14497 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
14499 This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
14500 that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
14501 control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
14502 value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
14503 non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
14504 set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
14506 A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
14507 has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
14508 that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
14509 and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
14512 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
14513 .cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
14514 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
14515 Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
14516 the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
14517 check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
14518 client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
14519 client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
14521 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
14522 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
14523 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
14524 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
14525 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
14526 counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
14527 following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
14528 MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
14531 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14532 You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
14533 check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
14534 changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
14538 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
14539 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
14541 .option "smtp_accept_max_per_ &~&~connection" main integer 1000 &&&
14542 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
14543 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
14544 .cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
14545 The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
14546 prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
14547 results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
14548 response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
14549 precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
14553 .option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
14554 .cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
14555 .cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
14556 This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
14557 host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
14558 expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
14559 reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
14560 connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
14561 is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
14562 of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
14563 required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
14565 &*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
14566 constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
14567 happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
14568 without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
14569 could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
14570 doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
14574 .option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
14575 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
14576 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14577 .cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
14578 If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
14579 listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
14580 on the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
14581 fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
14582 subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
14583 to all messages received in the same connection.
14585 A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
14586 if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
14587 also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
14588 various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
14591 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
14592 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
14594 .option "smtp_accept_queue_per_ &~&~connection" main integer 10 &&&
14595 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
14596 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14597 .cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
14598 This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
14599 automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
14600 the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
14601 and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
14602 number, subsequent messages are placed on the queue, but no delivery processes
14603 are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
14604 restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
14605 systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
14606 dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
14609 .option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
14610 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
14611 .cindex "host" "reserved"
14612 When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
14613 number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
14614 that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
14615 &%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
14616 restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
14617 of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
14618 of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
14619 the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
14622 For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
14623 set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
14624 connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
14625 provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
14628 .option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
14629 .cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
14630 .cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
14631 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
14632 This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
14633 several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
14634 is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
14635 responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
14636 incoming HELO or EHLO command.
14638 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
14639 The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
14640 is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
14641 in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
14643 If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
14644 expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
14645 used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
14646 panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
14647 value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
14650 smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
14651 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
14654 Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
14655 messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
14656 verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
14657 &%helo_data%& value.
14659 .option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
14660 .cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
14661 .cindex "banner for SMTP"
14662 .cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
14663 .cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
14664 This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
14665 positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
14667 smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
14668 $version_number $tod_full
14670 Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
14671 multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
14672 appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
14673 in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
14674 multiline response).
14677 .option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
14678 .cindex "checking disk space"
14679 .cindex "disk space, checking"
14680 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
14681 When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
14682 option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
14683 spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
14684 leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
14685 is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
14688 .option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
14689 .cindex "connection backlog"
14690 .cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
14691 .cindex "backlog of connections"
14692 This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
14693 this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
14694 of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
14695 attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
14696 say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
14697 out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
14698 value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
14699 attacks by SYN flooding.
14702 .option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
14703 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
14704 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
14705 The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
14706 the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
14707 synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
14708 fewer, but they still exist.
14710 Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
14711 for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
14712 client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
14713 SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
14714 for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
14715 input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
14716 does detect many instances.
14718 The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
14719 If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
14720 hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
14721 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
14725 .option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
14726 .cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
14727 .vindex "&$domain$&"
14728 If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
14729 command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
14730 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
14731 are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
14732 argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
14735 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
14736 $sender_host_address
14738 A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
14739 complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
14740 run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
14741 a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
14742 receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
14746 .option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
14747 .cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
14748 When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
14749 one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
14750 section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
14753 .option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
14754 .cindex "load average"
14755 If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
14756 accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
14757 If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
14758 the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
14759 systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
14760 &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
14764 .option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
14765 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
14766 .cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
14767 Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
14768 particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
14770 RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
14772 causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
14773 (The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
14774 example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
14775 too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
14776 dropped. The limit is set by this option.
14778 .cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
14779 When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
14780 &"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
14781 Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
14782 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
14783 not count towards the limit.
14787 .option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
14788 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
14789 .cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
14790 If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
14791 Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
14794 into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
14795 non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
14799 .option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14800 .cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
14801 .cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
14802 .cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
14803 Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
14804 can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
14807 Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
14808 facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
14809 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
14810 &<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
14812 When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
14813 &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
14814 rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
14815 respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
14819 A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
14821 An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
14822 fractional parts are allowed here.
14824 A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
14826 A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
14827 because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
14830 For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
14831 first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
14833 smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
14834 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
14836 The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
14837 two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
14838 seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
14839 delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
14842 .option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
14843 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
14846 .option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
14847 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
14850 .option smtp_receive_timeout main time 5m
14851 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
14852 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
14853 This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
14854 input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
14855 data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
14856 the message is abandoned.
14857 A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
14859 SMTP command timeout on connection from...
14860 SMTP data timeout on connection from...
14862 The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
14863 means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
14867 The value set by this option can be overridden by the
14868 &%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
14869 this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
14870 of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
14871 timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
14874 .option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14875 This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
14876 &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
14879 .option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
14880 .cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
14881 .cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
14882 In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
14883 &"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
14884 reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
14885 to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
14886 policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
14887 &%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
14888 example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
14890 550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
14891 550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
14894 .option spamd_address main string "see below"
14895 This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
14896 extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
14897 The default value is
14901 See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
14905 .option split_spool_directory main boolean false
14906 .cindex "multiple spool directories"
14907 .cindex "spool directory" "split"
14908 .cindex "directories, multiple"
14909 If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
14910 subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
14911 sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
14912 subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
14913 arrival of the message.
14915 Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
14916 where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
14917 directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
14918 directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
14919 are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
14921 It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
14922 changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
14923 &"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
14924 after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
14925 automatically deleted.
14927 When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
14928 changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
14929 trying to deliver each one in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
14930 sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
14931 sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
14932 spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
14933 particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages on the queue. However,
14934 if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
14935 entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
14938 .option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
14939 .cindex "spool directory" "path to"
14940 This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
14941 it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
14942 configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
14943 string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
14944 &$primary_hostname$&.
14946 If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
14947 that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
14948 log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
14949 Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
14950 as failures in the configuration file.
14952 By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
14953 tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
14955 .option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
14956 .cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
14957 This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
14958 access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
14960 .option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
14961 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
14962 This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
14963 variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
14964 is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
14965 &<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
14967 .option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
14968 .cindex "angle brackets, excess"
14969 If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
14970 items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
14971 treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
14972 passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
14973 option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
14976 .option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
14977 .cindex "trailing dot on domain"
14978 .cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
14979 If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
14980 ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
14981 MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
14982 domain causes a syntax error.
14983 However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
14987 .option syslog_duplication main boolean true
14988 .cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
14989 When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
14990 separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
14991 be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
14992 separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
14993 nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
14994 particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
14995 both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
14996 containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
14997 Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
14998 the LOG_ALERT priority.
15001 .option syslog_facility main string unset
15002 .cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
15003 This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
15004 syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
15005 &"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
15006 If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
15007 details of Exim's logging.
15011 .option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
15012 .cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
15013 This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
15014 syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
15015 &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
15019 .option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
15020 .cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
15021 If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
15022 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
15023 details of Exim's logging.
15026 .option system_filter main string&!! unset
15027 .cindex "filter" "system filter"
15028 .cindex "system filter" "specifying"
15029 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
15030 This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
15031 the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
15032 must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
15033 generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
15034 appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
15035 which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
15036 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
15039 .option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
15040 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
15041 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
15042 &%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
15043 implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
15044 During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
15047 .option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
15048 .cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
15049 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
15050 command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
15051 the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
15053 .option system_filter_group main string unset
15054 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
15055 This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
15056 gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
15057 with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
15059 .option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
15060 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
15061 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
15062 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
15063 is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
15064 contains the pipe command.
15067 .option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
15068 .cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
15069 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
15070 is used in a system filter.
15072 .option system_filter_user main string unset
15073 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
15074 If this option is not set, the system filter is run in the main Exim delivery
15075 process, as root. When the option is set, the system filter runs in a separate
15076 process, as the given user. Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
15077 is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
15078 configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
15079 specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
15080 &%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
15082 If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
15083 under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
15084 transport option overrides. Normally you should set &%system_filter_user%& if
15085 your system filter generates these kinds of delivery.
15088 .option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
15089 .cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
15090 .cindex "Nagle algorithm"
15091 .cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
15092 If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
15093 TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
15094 turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
15095 performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
15096 should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
15097 However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
15098 this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
15099 daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
15103 .option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
15104 .cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
15105 .cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
15106 If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
15107 message of any kind that has been on the queue for longer than the given time
15108 is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
15109 bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
15110 sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
15111 If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
15112 frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
15114 &*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
15115 frozen messages remain on the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
15116 messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
15119 .option timezone main string unset
15120 .cindex "timezone, setting"
15121 The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
15122 running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
15123 created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
15124 to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
15128 The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
15129 or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
15130 is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
15131 time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
15132 runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
15133 unfortunately not all, operating systems.
15136 .option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15137 .cindex "TLS" "advertising"
15138 .cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
15139 .cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
15140 When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
15141 of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
15142 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
15143 chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
15146 .option tls_certificate main string&!! unset
15147 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
15148 .cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
15149 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
15150 file which contains the server's certificates. The server's private key is also
15151 assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
15152 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
15154 &*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
15155 receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
15156 use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
15157 option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
15160 .option tls_crl main string&!! unset
15161 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
15162 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
15163 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
15164 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
15167 .option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
15168 .cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
15169 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to
15170 a file which contains the server's DH parameter values.
15171 This is used only for OpenSSL. When Exim is linked with GnuTLS, this option is
15172 ignored. See section &<<SECTopenvsgnu>>& for further details.
15175 .option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
15176 This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
15177 operate the obsolete SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
15178 set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
15179 further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
15183 .option tls_privatekey main string&!! unset
15184 .cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
15185 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
15186 file which contains the server's private key. If this option is unset, or if
15187 the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
15188 key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
15189 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
15192 .option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
15193 .cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
15194 .cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
15195 If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
15196 &"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
15197 support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
15201 .option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
15202 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
15203 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
15204 This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
15205 The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
15206 connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
15207 different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
15208 permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
15209 in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
15210 preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
15211 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
15214 .option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15215 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
15216 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
15217 See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
15220 .option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! unset
15221 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
15222 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
15223 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to
15224 a file containing permitted certificates for clients that
15225 match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. Alternatively, if you
15226 are using OpenSSL, you can set &%tls_verify_certificates%& to the name of a
15227 directory containing certificate files. This does not work with GnuTLS; the
15228 option must be set to the name of a single file if you are using GnuTLS.
15231 .option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15232 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
15233 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
15234 This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
15235 certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
15236 &%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
15237 either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
15238 &%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
15240 Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
15241 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
15242 present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
15243 aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
15244 the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
15245 connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
15246 ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
15248 A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
15249 matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
15250 certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
15251 abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
15252 state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
15253 such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
15254 but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
15257 Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
15261 .option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
15262 .cindex "trusted groups"
15263 .cindex "groups" "trusted"
15264 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
15265 option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
15266 which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
15267 specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
15268 details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
15269 &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
15272 .option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
15273 .cindex "trusted users"
15274 .cindex "user" "trusted"
15275 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
15276 option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
15277 trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
15278 &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
15279 If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
15280 Exim user are trusted.
15282 .option unknown_login main string&!! unset
15283 .cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
15284 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
15285 This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
15286 the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
15287 gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
15288 used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
15289 can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
15290 is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
15293 .option unknown_username main string unset
15294 See &%unknown_login%&.
15296 .option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
15297 .cindex "trusted users"
15298 .cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
15299 .cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
15300 .cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
15301 .cindex "envelope sender"
15302 When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
15303 normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
15304 default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
15305 senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
15306 is used) is ignored.
15308 However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
15309 to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
15311 exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
15313 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
15314 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
15315 other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
15316 users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
15317 patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
15318 identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
15319 users to setting senders that start with their login ids
15320 followed by a hyphen
15321 by a setting like this:
15323 untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
15325 If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
15326 restriction, you can use
15328 untrusted_set_sender = *
15330 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
15331 only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
15332 to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
15333 parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
15334 &'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
15335 necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
15336 overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
15337 described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
15339 The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
15340 &"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
15341 &%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
15342 envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
15346 .option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
15347 .cindex "&""From""& line"
15348 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
15349 Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
15350 an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
15351 particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
15352 of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
15353 matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
15354 &%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
15355 default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
15357 From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
15358 From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
15360 The pattern can be seen by running
15362 exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
15364 It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
15365 year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
15366 regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
15367 &%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
15368 (&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
15369 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
15372 .option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
15373 See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
15376 .option warn_message_file main string unset
15377 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
15378 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
15379 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
15380 for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
15381 been on the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
15382 &%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
15383 &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
15386 .option write_rejectlog main boolean true
15387 .cindex "reject log" "disabling"
15388 If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
15389 See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
15390 .ecindex IIDconfima
15391 .ecindex IIDmaiconf
15396 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
15397 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
15399 .chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
15400 .scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
15401 .scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
15402 This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
15403 Those that are preconditions are marked with ‡ in the &"use"& field.
15405 For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
15406 &<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
15407 which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
15408 provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
15409 &%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
15413 .option address_data routers string&!! unset
15414 .cindex "router" "data attached to address"
15415 The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
15416 precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
15417 router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
15418 &%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
15419 delivery of the address to be deferred.
15421 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
15422 When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
15423 accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
15424 routers, and the eventual transport.
15426 &*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
15427 that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
15428 in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
15429 either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
15430 put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
15432 Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
15433 with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
15434 on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
15435 &$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
15436 &"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
15438 The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
15439 for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
15440 you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
15442 uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
15444 In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
15446 file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
15448 This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
15449 lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
15451 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
15452 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
15453 The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
15454 from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
15455 &$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
15456 ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
15457 verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
15461 .option address_test routers&!? boolean true
15463 .cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
15464 If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
15465 by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
15466 your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
15467 having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
15472 .option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
15473 .cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
15474 .cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
15475 This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
15476 routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
15477 &"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
15478 &%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
15479 value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
15480 includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
15481 well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
15484 cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
15486 on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
15489 cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
15491 on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
15492 this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
15493 explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
15494 logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
15497 .option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
15498 .cindex "case of local parts"
15499 .cindex "router" "case of local parts"
15500 By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
15501 manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
15502 If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
15503 this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
15504 part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
15505 turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
15508 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
15509 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
15510 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
15511 The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
15512 router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
15513 an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
15514 is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
15515 addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
15516 and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
15518 This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
15519 recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
15520 modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
15521 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
15525 .option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
15526 .cindex "local user, checking in router"
15527 .cindex "router" "checking for local user"
15528 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
15530 When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
15531 address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
15532 local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
15533 than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
15534 holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
15535 user, &$home$& is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
15536 preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
15537 given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
15538 overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
15539 the router is skipped.
15541 If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
15542 or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
15543 setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
15544 two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
15545 setting to achieve this. For example:
15547 local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
15549 Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
15550 up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
15551 &%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
15555 .option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
15556 .cindex "router" "customized precondition"
15557 This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
15558 router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
15559 evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
15560 result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
15561 &"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
15562 router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
15564 If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
15565 precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
15567 The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
15568 running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
15569 the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
15571 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
15573 Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
15575 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
15577 If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
15578 of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
15579 be specified using &%condition%&.
15583 .option debug_print routers string&!! unset
15584 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
15585 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
15586 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
15587 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
15588 output, and Exim carries on processing.
15589 This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
15590 so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
15591 option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
15592 variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
15593 &%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
15594 are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
15598 .option disable_logging routers boolean false
15599 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
15600 or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
15601 unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
15602 transport option of the same name.
15605 .option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
15606 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
15607 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
15608 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
15609 the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
15610 lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
15611 expansions of the driver's private options. See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
15612 a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
15616 .option driver routers string unset
15617 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
15622 .option errors_to routers string&!! unset
15623 .cindex "envelope sender"
15624 .cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
15625 If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
15626 transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
15627 there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
15628 message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
15629 provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
15630 expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
15632 The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
15633 subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
15634 settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
15637 If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
15638 the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
15639 address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
15640 expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
15642 If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
15643 SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
15644 any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
15645 sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
15651 An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
15652 this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
15653 no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
15654 address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
15655 overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
15657 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
15658 If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
15659 MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
15660 path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
15661 setting &%return_path%&.
15663 The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
15664 manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
15665 implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
15669 .option expn routers&!? boolean true
15670 .cindex "address" "testing"
15671 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
15672 .cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
15673 .cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
15674 If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
15675 as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
15676 want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
15677 on for the system alias file.
15678 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
15681 The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
15682 &<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
15683 an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
15687 .option fail_verify routers boolean false
15688 .cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
15689 Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
15690 &%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
15694 .option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
15695 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
15696 verifying a recipient, verification fails.
15700 .option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
15701 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
15702 verifying a sender, verification fails.
15706 .option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
15707 .cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
15708 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
15709 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
15710 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
15711 changed (see section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&), and a port can be specified with
15712 each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
15713 defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
15714 &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
15716 If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
15717 associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
15718 list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
15719 randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
15720 transport for further details.
15723 .option group routers string&!! "see below"
15724 .cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
15725 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
15726 .cindex "transport" "local"
15727 .cindex "router" "setting group"
15728 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
15729 specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
15731 The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
15732 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
15733 The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
15734 is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
15735 and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
15739 .option headers_add routers string&!! unset
15740 .cindex "header lines" "adding"
15741 .cindex "router" "adding header lines"
15742 This option specifies a string of text that is expanded at routing time, and
15743 associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router. However, this
15744 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
15745 the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
15746 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
15747 message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
15748 header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
15749 &"see"& the added header lines.
15751 The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
15752 &%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If the expanded string is empty, or if
15753 the expansion is forced to fail, the option has no effect. Other expansion
15754 failures are treated as configuration errors.
15756 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
15757 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
15759 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
15760 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
15761 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
15762 additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
15763 For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
15764 address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
15765 modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
15766 circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
15767 which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
15768 avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
15772 .option headers_remove routers string&!! unset
15773 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
15774 .cindex "router" "removing header lines"
15775 This option specifies a string of text that is expanded at routing time, and
15776 associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router. However, this
15777 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
15778 the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
15779 section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
15780 the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
15781 to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
15782 &"see"& the original header lines.
15784 The &%headers_remove%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%& and
15785 &%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If the expansion is forced to fail,
15786 the option has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
15789 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
15790 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
15792 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
15793 removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
15794 routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
15795 warning for &%headers_add%& above.
15798 .option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
15799 .cindex "IP address" "discarding"
15800 .cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
15801 Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
15802 entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
15803 IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
15804 address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
15807 remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
15811 ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
15813 on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
15814 discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
15815 attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
15816 domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
15817 Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
15818 router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
15820 You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
15821 means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
15823 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
15824 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
15826 The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
15827 in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
15829 This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
15830 addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
15831 is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
15832 domain that is being routed.
15834 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
15835 During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
15838 .option initgroups routers boolean false
15839 .cindex "additional groups"
15840 .cindex "groups" "additional"
15841 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
15842 .cindex "transport" "local"
15843 If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
15844 the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
15845 &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
15846 any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
15847 and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
15851 .option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
15852 .cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
15853 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
15854 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
15855 one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
15856 section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
15859 The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
15860 used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
15861 asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
15862 the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
15863 some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
15864 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
15865 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
15866 Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
15867 section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
15869 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
15870 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
15871 During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
15872 running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
15873 expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
15874 the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
15875 a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
15876 command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
15877 This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
15878 the relevant transport.
15880 When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
15881 behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
15882 means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
15885 The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
15886 &%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
15887 &%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
15888 to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
15889 immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
15893 local_part_prefix = real-
15895 transport = local_delivery
15897 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
15898 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
15900 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
15901 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
15904 If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
15905 both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
15906 are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
15907 separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
15910 .option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
15911 See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
15915 .option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
15916 .cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
15917 .cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
15918 This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
15919 local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
15920 &%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
15921 mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
15922 character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
15923 parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
15927 .option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
15928 See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
15932 .option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
15933 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
15934 .cindex "local part" "checking in router"
15935 The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
15936 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
15938 section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
15939 string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
15942 local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
15944 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
15945 If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
15946 for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
15947 expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
15948 example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
15949 send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
15950 each virtual domain:
15954 local_parts = postmaster
15955 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
15959 .option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
15960 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
15961 .cindex "delivery" "log line format"
15962 Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
15963 deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
15964 recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
15965 this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
15966 router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
15967 router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
15968 redirect addresses.
15972 .option more routers boolean&!! true
15973 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
15974 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
15975 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
15976 fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
15977 delivery to be deferred.
15979 If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
15980 further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
15982 However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
15983 means of the setting
15987 or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
15988 does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
15989 case, the address is always passed to the next router.
15991 Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
15992 expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
15993 controls what happens next.
15996 .option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
15997 .cindex "timeout" "of router"
15998 .cindex "router" "timeout"
15999 If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
16000 address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
16001 router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
16002 intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
16003 host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
16005 There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
16006 lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
16007 applies to all of them.
16011 .option pass_router routers string unset
16012 .cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
16013 Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
16014 &(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
16015 routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
16016 these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
16017 router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
16018 of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
16019 be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
16020 to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
16021 &"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
16025 .option redirect_router routers string unset
16026 .cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
16027 Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
16028 generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
16029 example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
16030 point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
16032 The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
16033 It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
16034 instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
16035 which it is set does not generate new addresses.
16039 .option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
16040 .cindex "file" "requiring for router"
16041 .cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
16042 This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
16043 router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
16044 Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
16045 through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
16047 Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
16048 be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used.
16049 If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
16050 failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
16052 If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
16053 below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
16054 &"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
16055 existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
16056 preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
16059 If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
16060 the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
16063 This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
16064 options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
16065 look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
16066 full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
16067 these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
16068 to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
16069 that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
16070 transport (for example &_.procmailrc_&).
16072 During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
16073 facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
16074 This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
16075 operates as follows:
16077 If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
16078 characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
16079 comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
16080 but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
16083 require_files = mail:/some/file
16084 require_files = $local_part:$home/.procmailrc
16086 If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
16087 &%require_files%& condition fails.
16089 Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
16090 checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
16091 directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
16092 access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
16094 &*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
16095 incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
16096 may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
16097 may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
16098 user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
16100 &*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
16101 &[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
16102 without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
16103 is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
16104 check again in that process.
16106 The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
16107 be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
16108 existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
16109 circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
16110 not exist. If the file name (or the exclamation mark that precedes the file
16111 name for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
16112 as if the file did not exist. For example:
16114 require_files = +/some/file
16116 If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
16117 handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
16118 option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
16122 .option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
16123 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
16124 .cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
16125 When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
16126 in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
16127 domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
16128 other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
16129 Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
16132 This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
16133 hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
16134 router. The default value is true for any router that has &%check_local_user%&
16135 set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
16136 for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
16139 The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
16140 appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
16141 independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
16145 .option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
16146 .cindex "router" "home directory for"
16147 .cindex "home directory" "for router"
16149 This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
16150 &%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
16151 transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
16152 sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
16153 forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
16154 cause the router to defer.
16156 Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
16157 &%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
16159 (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16161 While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
16162 &$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
16164 When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
16165 the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
16166 delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
16167 of these values that is set:
16170 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
16172 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
16174 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
16176 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
16179 In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
16180 router, but not for the transport.
16184 .option self routers string freeze
16185 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
16186 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
16187 This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
16188 list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
16189 and &(manualroute)& routers.
16190 Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
16192 Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
16193 &(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
16194 host on the list turns out to be the local host.
16195 The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
16196 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
16198 Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
16199 example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
16200 error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
16201 reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
16202 freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
16207 Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
16209 .vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
16210 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
16211 be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
16212 behaviour is essentially a redirection.
16214 .vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
16215 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
16216 reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
16221 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
16222 The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
16223 &%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
16224 subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
16225 name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
16226 distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
16232 ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
16233 Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
16234 be passed to the next router.
16237 Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
16240 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
16241 The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
16242 setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
16243 makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
16244 is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
16245 different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
16250 .option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
16251 .cindex "router" "checking senders"
16252 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
16253 address matches something on the list.
16254 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16257 There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
16258 dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
16259 setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
16260 to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
16261 set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
16262 verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
16263 SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
16267 .option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
16268 .cindex "IP address" "translating"
16269 .cindex "packet radio"
16270 .cindex "router" "IP address translation"
16271 There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
16272 it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
16273 mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
16274 routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
16275 is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
16276 code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
16277 SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
16279 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
16280 The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
16281 by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
16282 expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
16283 For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
16284 If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
16285 address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
16286 up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
16287 produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
16288 addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
16290 translate_ip_address = \
16291 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
16294 The file would contain lines like
16296 10.2.3.128/26 some.host
16297 10.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
16299 You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
16304 .option transport routers string&!! unset
16305 This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
16306 and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
16307 only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
16308 after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
16309 and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
16310 delivery is deferred.
16312 The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
16313 have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
16314 (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
16318 .option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
16319 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
16320 This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
16321 to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
16322 explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
16323 file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
16324 option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
16325 overridden by a setting on the transport.
16326 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
16327 logged, and delivery is deferred.
16328 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
16334 .option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
16335 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
16336 This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
16337 local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
16338 configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
16339 pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
16340 string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
16341 setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
16342 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
16343 logged, and delivery is deferred.
16345 If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
16346 &%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
16347 the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
16348 the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
16349 is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
16351 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
16357 .option unseen routers boolean&!! false
16358 .cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
16359 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
16360 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
16361 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
16362 fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
16363 delivery to be deferred.
16365 When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
16366 address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
16367 overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
16368 &%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
16369 the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
16370 sometimes true and sometimes false).
16372 .cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
16373 Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
16374 qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
16375 delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
16376 In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
16377 &-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
16378 to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
16379 &%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
16381 &*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
16382 this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
16383 only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
16384 no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
16385 a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
16386 duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
16387 duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
16388 &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
16389 so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
16390 &%redirect%& router may be of help.
16392 Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
16393 &%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
16394 subsequent routers.
16397 .option user routers string&!! "see below"
16398 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
16399 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
16400 .cindex "transport" "local"
16401 .cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
16402 .cindex "filter" "user for processing"
16403 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
16404 specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
16405 The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
16406 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
16407 This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
16408 The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
16409 the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
16410 a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
16411 See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
16412 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
16416 .option verify routers&!? boolean true
16417 Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
16418 &%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
16421 .option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
16422 .cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
16424 .cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
16425 If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address or
16426 testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
16427 with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
16428 restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
16429 &%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
16431 &*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
16432 SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
16433 accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
16437 .option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
16438 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
16440 or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
16441 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16445 .option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
16446 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
16447 or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
16448 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16450 .ecindex IIDgenoprou1
16451 .ecindex IIDgenoprou2
16458 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16459 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16461 .chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
16462 .cindex "&(accept)& router"
16463 .cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
16464 The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
16465 used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
16466 be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
16467 specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
16468 it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
16469 up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
16473 domains = mydomain.example
16475 transport = local_delivery
16477 The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
16478 &%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
16479 When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
16480 address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
16487 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16488 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16490 .chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
16491 .scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
16492 .scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
16493 The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
16494 recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
16495 unless &%verify_only%& is set.
16497 If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
16498 SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
16499 MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
16500 However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
16503 MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
16504 looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
16505 When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
16506 except that IPv6 addresses are always sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
16507 IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
16508 generic option, the router declines.
16510 Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
16511 to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
16512 are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
16514 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
16515 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
16516 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
16517 If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
16518 address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
16519 happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
16522 .section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
16523 There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
16524 Some mis-behaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
16525 SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
16526 MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
16527 problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
16529 For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
16530 &%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
16531 &(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
16532 an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
16533 domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
16534 such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
16535 proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
16536 look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
16537 case routing fails.
16542 .section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
16543 .cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
16544 The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
16546 .option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
16547 .cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
16548 If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
16549 (and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
16550 process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
16551 differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
16552 the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
16555 .option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
16556 .cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
16557 The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
16558 addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
16559 enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
16560 required. For example,
16564 looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
16565 expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
16566 to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
16567 submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
16568 option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
16571 When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
16572 the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
16573 host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
16574 this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
16575 SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
16576 according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
16578 When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
16579 the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
16580 records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
16581 this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
16582 defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
16583 and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
16584 have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
16585 trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
16587 See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
16588 when there is a DNS lookup error.
16592 .option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
16593 .cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
16594 .cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
16595 A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
16596 record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
16597 For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
16598 records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
16601 mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
16603 This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
16604 has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
16605 the address record.
16608 .option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
16609 If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
16610 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
16611 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
16616 .option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
16617 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
16618 .cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
16619 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
16620 lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
16621 single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
16622 called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
16623 &'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
16624 resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
16629 .option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
16630 .cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
16631 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
16632 If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
16633 qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
16634 an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
16635 expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
16636 occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
16637 &%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
16638 any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
16639 header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
16641 This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
16642 ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
16645 When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
16646 servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
16647 making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
16648 some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
16649 name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
16653 .option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
16654 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
16655 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
16656 to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
16657 options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
16658 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
16659 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
16660 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
16662 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
16663 domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
16664 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
16665 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
16666 routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
16667 message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
16668 without processing them independently,
16669 provided the following conditions are met:
16672 No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
16673 &%headers_remove%&.
16675 The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
16682 .option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
16683 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
16684 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
16685 lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
16686 applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
16687 the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
16688 domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
16689 up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
16690 &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
16691 actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
16693 Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
16694 record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
16699 .option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
16700 If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
16701 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
16702 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
16707 .option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
16708 .cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
16709 If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
16710 added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
16713 widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
16715 is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
16716 &'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
16717 &'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
16718 and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
16719 the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
16720 when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
16723 .section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
16724 When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
16725 of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
16726 corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
16727 is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
16729 These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
16730 for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
16731 such as that implied by
16735 that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
16736 entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
16737 .ecindex IIDdnsrou1
16738 .ecindex IIDdnsrou2
16748 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16749 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16751 .chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
16752 .cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
16753 .cindex "domain literal" "routing"
16754 .cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
16755 This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
16756 verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
16757 generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
16758 takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
16759 router handles the address
16763 by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
16764 consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
16765 are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
16767 postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
16769 Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
16770 grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
16772 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
16773 If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
16774 declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
16775 &%self%& option determines what happens.
16777 The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
16778 controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
16779 also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
16780 Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
16784 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16785 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16787 .chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
16788 .cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
16789 .cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
16790 The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
16791 Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
16792 not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
16795 ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
16797 in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
16799 The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
16800 connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
16801 a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
16802 message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
16803 this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
16804 can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
16805 must not be specified for it.
16807 .cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
16808 .option hosts iplookup string unset
16809 This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
16810 names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
16811 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
16812 and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
16813 happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
16816 .option optional iplookup boolean false
16817 If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
16818 is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
16819 delivery to the address is deferred.
16822 .option port iplookup integer 0
16823 .cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
16824 This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
16828 .option protocol iplookup string udp
16829 This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
16830 protocols is to be used.
16833 .option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
16834 This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
16837 $local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
16839 The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
16840 query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
16843 .option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
16844 If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
16845 returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
16846 string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
16847 in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
16848 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
16849 whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
16850 up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
16853 .option response_pattern iplookup string unset
16854 This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
16855 returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
16856 router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
16857 response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
16858 check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
16859 address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
16860 the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
16861 following could be used:
16863 response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
16864 reroute = $local_part@$1
16867 .option timeout iplookup time 5s
16868 This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
16869 machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
16870 call. It does not apply to UDP.
16875 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16876 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16878 .chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
16879 .scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
16880 .scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
16881 .cindex "domain" "manually routing"
16882 The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
16883 routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
16884 route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
16885 normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
16886 route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
16887 messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
16889 The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
16890 it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
16891 has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
16892 include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
16893 &"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
16894 generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
16895 being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
16898 In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
16899 router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
16900 an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
16901 transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
16902 with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
16903 passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
16904 host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
16907 The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
16908 &%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
16909 or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
16910 any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
16911 below, following the list of private options.
16914 .section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
16916 .cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
16917 The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
16919 .option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
16920 See &%host_find_failed%&.
16922 .option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
16923 This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
16924 address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
16925 of the following values:
16934 The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
16935 error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
16936 forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
16939 overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
16940 router only if &%more%& is true.
16942 The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
16943 cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
16944 controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
16945 as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
16947 The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
16948 state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
16949 generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
16952 .option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
16953 .cindex "randomized host list"
16954 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
16955 If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
16956 is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
16957 overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
16958 crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
16959 same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
16960 (even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
16961 deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
16963 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
16964 into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
16965 set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
16966 item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
16968 route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
16970 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
16971 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
16972 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
16973 randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
16974 &%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
16977 .option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
16978 If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
16979 Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
16982 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
16984 If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
16985 router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
16989 .option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
16990 This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
16991 unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
16992 that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
16995 .option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
16996 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
16997 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
16998 router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
16999 router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
17000 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
17001 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
17002 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
17004 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
17005 domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
17006 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
17007 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
17008 &(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
17009 addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
17010 same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
17011 if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
17016 .section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
17017 The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
17018 rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
17019 entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
17020 described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
17021 Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
17023 <&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
17025 The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
17029 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
17030 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
17032 The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
17033 list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
17034 usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
17035 single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
17036 pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
17037 &<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
17038 except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
17039 That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
17040 lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
17041 in a &%route_list%&).
17043 The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
17044 matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
17045 then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
17046 &%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
17050 .section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
17051 The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
17052 routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
17053 hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
17054 The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
17055 Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
17056 expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
17059 dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
17060 thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
17062 This data can be accessed by setting
17064 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
17066 Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
17067 decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
17068 requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
17069 possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
17070 be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
17075 .section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
17076 A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
17077 always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
17078 declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
17079 and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports. The format of each item
17080 in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
17081 as described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
17083 If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
17084 variables are set during its expansion:
17087 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
17088 If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
17089 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
17091 route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
17094 &$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
17096 &$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
17099 .vindex "&$value$&"
17100 If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
17101 looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
17103 route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
17107 Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
17108 semicolon is the default route list separator.
17112 .section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
17113 Each item in the list of hosts is either a host name or an IP address,
17114 optionally with an attached port number. When no port is given, an IP address
17115 is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
17116 specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
17117 by a colon. This leads to some complications:
17120 Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
17121 the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
17122 be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
17124 route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
17125 route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
17128 When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
17129 colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
17130 enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
17131 number follows. For example:
17133 route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
17137 .section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
17138 When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
17139 the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
17140 delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
17141 option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
17144 Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
17145 hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
17146 interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
17147 records in the DNS. For example:
17149 route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
17151 If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
17154 route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
17156 If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
17157 randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
17158 that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
17159 be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
17160 Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
17161 happens is controlled by the
17162 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
17163 &%self%& option of the router.
17165 A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
17166 hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
17167 lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
17168 below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
17169 preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
17170 randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
17171 defined by MX preferences.
17173 If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
17174 not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
17175 preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
17177 If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
17178 depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
17179 is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
17180 Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
17182 If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
17183 most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
17186 DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
17187 failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
17188 &%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
17190 The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
17191 whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
17195 .section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
17196 The options are a sequence of words; in practice no more than three are ever
17197 present. One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
17198 &%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
17199 other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
17200 per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
17201 routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
17204 &%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
17205 setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
17207 &%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
17208 overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
17210 &%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
17211 find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
17212 also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
17214 &%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
17215 no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
17216 timeout), delivery is deferred.
17221 route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
17222 domain2 host4:host5
17224 If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
17225 DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
17226 result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
17227 or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
17230 &*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
17231 called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
17232 instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
17233 lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
17238 If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
17239 &%host_find_failed%& option.
17242 When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
17243 The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
17247 .section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
17248 In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
17249 transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
17252 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
17253 The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
17254 &'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
17255 named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
17257 domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
17259 You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
17260 your first router something like this:
17263 driver = manualroute
17264 domains = !+local_domains
17265 transport = remote_smtp
17266 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
17268 This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
17269 &'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
17270 they are tried in order
17271 (but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
17272 Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
17275 driver = manualroute
17276 transport = remote_smtp
17277 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
17279 There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
17280 However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
17281 example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
17282 precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
17283 always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
17284 would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
17285 always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
17286 &%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
17289 .cindex "mail hub example"
17290 A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
17291 records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
17292 the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
17293 machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
17294 &(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
17295 to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
17296 using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
17297 lookup is easier to manage.
17299 If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
17300 to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
17304 driver = manualroute
17305 transport = remote_smtp
17306 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
17308 This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
17309 whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
17310 if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
17311 that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
17312 domain can be used to find the host:
17315 driver = manualroute
17316 transport = remote_smtp
17317 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
17319 The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
17320 hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
17321 data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
17325 .cindex "batched SMTP output example"
17326 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
17327 You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
17328 SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
17329 storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
17330 can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
17333 driver = manualroute
17334 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
17335 route_list = saved.domain.example
17337 though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
17338 several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
17339 different transports can be listed in the routing information:
17342 driver = manualroute
17344 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
17345 *.saved.domain2.example \
17346 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
17349 .vindex "&$domain$&"
17351 The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
17352 doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
17353 file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
17354 the address if the lookup fails.
17357 .cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
17358 Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
17359 &(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
17360 one way it can be done:
17366 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
17367 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
17368 return_fail_output = true
17373 driver = manualroute
17375 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
17377 The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
17379 darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
17381 It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
17382 makes clear the distinction between the domain name
17383 &'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
17385 .ecindex IIDmanrou1
17386 .ecindex IIDmanrou2
17395 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17396 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17398 .chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
17399 .scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
17400 .scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
17401 .cindex "routing" "by external program"
17402 The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
17403 and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
17404 mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
17405 However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
17406 &%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
17407 be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
17409 .cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
17411 .option command queryprogram string&!! unset
17412 This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
17413 command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
17414 expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
17415 &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
17418 .option command_group queryprogram string unset
17419 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
17420 This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
17421 address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
17422 uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
17423 gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
17426 .option command_user queryprogram string unset
17427 .cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
17428 This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
17429 command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
17430 it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
17431 using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
17432 not set, a value for the gid also.
17434 &*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
17435 root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
17436 However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
17437 usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
17438 is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
17439 the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
17443 .option current_directory queryprogram string /
17444 This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
17445 before running the command.
17448 .option timeout queryprogram time 1h
17449 If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
17450 is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
17454 The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
17455 the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
17456 containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
17457 the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
17458 field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
17461 &'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
17464 &'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
17465 &%no_more%& is set.
17467 &'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
17468 subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
17469 of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
17470 included in the SMTP response.
17472 &'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
17473 subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
17474 included in any SMTP response.
17476 &'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
17478 &'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
17479 &%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
17481 &'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
17482 new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
17483 or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
17486 When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
17487 number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
17490 ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
17491 LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
17493 The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
17494 is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
17495 used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
17496 an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
17498 The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
17499 As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
17500 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
17501 &`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
17502 (see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
17504 If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
17505 find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
17506 anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
17507 goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
17508 result of the lookup is the result of that call.
17510 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
17511 If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
17512 variable. For example, this return line
17514 accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
17516 routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
17517 the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
17518 .ecindex IIDquerou1
17519 .ecindex IIDquerou2
17524 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17525 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17527 .chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
17528 .scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
17529 .scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
17530 .cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
17531 .cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
17532 The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
17533 common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
17534 (usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
17535 files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
17536 redirected in several different ways:
17539 It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
17542 It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
17544 It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
17546 It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
17548 It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
17550 It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
17552 It can be discarded.
17555 The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
17556 However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
17557 files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
17558 &%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
17562 .section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
17563 The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
17564 expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
17565 contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
17566 options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
17567 aliases, in a configuration like this:
17571 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
17573 If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
17574 expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
17575 expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
17576 cause delivery to be deferred.
17578 A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
17579 &_.forward_& files, like this:
17584 file = $home/.forward
17587 If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
17588 empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
17589 is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
17590 yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
17595 .section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
17596 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
17597 It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
17598 &_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
17601 When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
17602 running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
17603 the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
17604 practice the router may not be able to operate.
17606 However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
17607 is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
17608 local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
17609 saves some resources.
17617 .section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
17618 .cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
17619 .cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
17620 The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
17621 can be interpreted in two different ways:
17624 If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
17625 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
17626 &'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
17627 respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
17628 in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
17629 document is intended for use by end users.
17631 Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
17632 described in the next section.
17635 When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the file name given
17636 in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
17637 generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
17638 configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
17639 for the &(appendfile)& transport.
17643 .section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
17644 .cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
17645 When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
17646 comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
17647 addresses, file names, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
17648 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
17649 disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
17650 depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
17651 commas or newlines.
17652 If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
17655 Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
17656 also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
17657 next newline character is ignored.
17659 If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
17660 double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
17661 (but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
17662 &"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
17665 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
17666 &*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
17667 and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
17668 of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
17669 special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
17670 &'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
17673 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
17677 .section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
17678 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
17679 .cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
17680 .cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
17681 A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
17682 consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
17683 automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
17684 is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
17685 Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
17686 as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
17687 complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
17689 .cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
17690 Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
17691 filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
17692 mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
17693 &'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
17695 cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
17697 .cindex "backslash in alias file"
17698 .cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
17699 For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
17700 preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
17701 it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
17704 If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
17705 2822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
17706 domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
17707 addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
17708 force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
17710 Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
17711 Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
17716 Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
17717 messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
17720 Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
17722 With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
17723 &(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
17724 second time round, because it has previously routed it,
17725 and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
17726 should really contain
17728 spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
17730 but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
17731 below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
17732 &(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
17736 .section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
17737 In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
17738 lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
17741 .cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
17742 .cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
17743 An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
17744 as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
17745 command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
17746 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
17747 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
17749 Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
17750 the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
17751 the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
17752 in double quotes, for example:
17754 "|/some/command ready,steady,go"
17756 since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
17757 quote just the command. An item such as
17759 |"/some/command ready,steady,go"
17761 is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
17764 .cindex "file" "in redirection list"
17765 .cindex "address redirection" "to file"
17766 An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
17767 parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
17769 /home/world/minbari
17771 is treated as a file name, but
17773 /s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
17775 is treated as an address. For a file name, a transport must be specified using
17776 the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
17777 forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
17778 file name, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
17780 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
17781 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
17783 .cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
17784 However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
17785 bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
17786 instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
17789 .cindex "included address list"
17790 .cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
17791 If an item is of the form
17793 :include:<path name>
17795 a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
17796 point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
17797 out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
17798 by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
17799 item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
17800 the alias name. This example is incorrect:
17802 list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
17804 It must be given as
17806 list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
17809 .cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
17810 Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
17811 &%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
17812 the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
17813 .cindex "black hole"
17814 .cindex "abandoning mail"
17815 &':blackhole:'& can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
17816 done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifing
17817 &_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
17819 &*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
17820 delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
17821 are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
17822 database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
17826 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
17827 .cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
17828 .cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
17829 .cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
17830 .cindex "customizing" "failure message"
17831 An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
17832 redirection items of the form
17837 respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies to the
17838 entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored (&':blackhole:'& is
17839 different). Any text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error
17840 text associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
17842 X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
17844 In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
17846 .cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
17847 VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
17849 .cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
17850 The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
17851 the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
17853 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
17854 By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
17855 &':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
17856 space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
17857 followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
17858 code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
17859 incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
17860 suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
17861 &%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
17864 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
17865 In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
17866 default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
17867 therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
17869 Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
17870 not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
17871 normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
17872 as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
17873 lookup and in &':include:'& files.
17875 During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
17876 containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
17877 whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain on the queue so that a
17878 subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
17879 deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
17883 .cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
17884 Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
17885 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
17886 for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
17887 &':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
17888 router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
17889 results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
17893 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
17894 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
17895 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
17896 .cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
17897 Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
17898 to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
17899 routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
17900 aliasing scheme of the type
17902 pipe: |/some/command $local_part
17906 does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
17907 when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
17908 discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
17911 localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
17912 localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
17914 does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
17915 the pipes are distinct.
17919 .section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
17920 .cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
17921 .cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
17922 When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
17923 leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
17924 afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
17925 delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
17926 members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
17927 can be used to avoid this.
17930 .section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
17931 .cindex "address redirection" "errors"
17932 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
17933 error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
17934 for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
17935 detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
17936 deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
17940 .section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
17942 .cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
17943 The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
17946 .option allow_defer redirect boolean false
17947 Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
17948 data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
17951 .option allow_fail redirect boolean false
17952 .cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
17953 If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
17954 and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
17957 .option allow_filter redirect boolean false
17958 .cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
17959 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
17960 Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
17961 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
17962 are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
17963 lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
17965 It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
17966 the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
17969 The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
17970 &%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
17971 &%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
17972 files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
17973 true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
17977 .option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
17978 .cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
17979 Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
17980 This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
17981 default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
17982 let ordinary users do.
17986 .option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
17987 This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
17988 as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
17989 Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
17990 configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
17991 for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
17993 When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
17994 is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
17995 the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
17996 and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
17997 domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
17998 &_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
18000 \Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
18002 Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
18003 &"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
18004 originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
18005 (having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
18006 &"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
18007 &%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
18008 file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
18009 original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
18012 .option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
18013 When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
18014 when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
18015 &%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
18016 &%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
18017 deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
18018 is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
18019 &%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
18023 .option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
18024 When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
18025 this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
18026 permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
18027 option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
18028 &%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
18031 .option data redirect string&!! unset
18032 This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
18033 set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
18034 list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
18035 expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
18036 has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
18038 When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
18039 filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
18040 terminated with newline characters. For example:
18042 data = #Exim filter\n\
18043 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
18045 If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
18046 you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
18047 choice into a newline.
18050 .option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
18051 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
18052 ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
18053 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
18054 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
18057 .option file redirect string&!! unset
18058 This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
18059 is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
18060 use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
18061 failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
18062 must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
18063 data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
18064 entirely of comments), the router declines.
18066 .cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
18067 If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
18068 runs a check on the containing directory,
18069 unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
18070 If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
18071 happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
18072 is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
18073 not, the router declines.
18076 .option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
18077 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
18078 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
18079 ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
18080 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
18081 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
18082 it is running, the file name is in &$address_file$&.
18085 .option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
18086 When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
18087 relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
18088 relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
18089 relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
18092 .option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
18093 If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
18097 .option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
18098 If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
18099 &%allow_filter%& is true.
18104 .option forbid_file redirect boolean false
18105 .cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
18106 .cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
18107 .cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
18108 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
18109 specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
18110 conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
18111 set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
18112 locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
18115 .option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
18116 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
18117 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
18118 make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
18121 .option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
18122 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
18123 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
18124 make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
18126 .option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
18127 If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
18128 permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
18129 under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
18130 &_.forward_& files).
18133 .option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
18134 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
18135 to make use of &%lookup%& items.
18138 .option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
18139 This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
18140 it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
18141 of the embedded Perl support.
18144 .option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
18145 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
18146 to make use of &%readfile%& items.
18149 .option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
18150 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
18151 to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
18154 .option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
18155 If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
18156 message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
18157 files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
18158 &%one_time%& is set.
18161 .option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
18162 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
18163 to make use of &%run%& items.
18166 .option forbid_include redirect boolean false
18167 If this option is true, items of the form
18169 :include:<path name>
18171 are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
18174 .option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
18175 .cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
18176 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
18177 specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
18178 forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
18181 .option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
18182 If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
18183 &%allow_filter%& is true.
18186 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
18187 .option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
18188 If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
18189 of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
18190 the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
18195 .option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
18196 .cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
18197 If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
18198 generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
18199 generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
18200 bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
18201 bounce may well quote the generated address.
18204 .option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
18206 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
18207 EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
18208 file did not exist.
18211 .option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
18213 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
18214 ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
18215 router behaves as if the file did not exist.
18217 Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
18218 router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
18219 (the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
18220 against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
18221 is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
18222 is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
18223 a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
18224 that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
18228 .option include_directory redirect string unset
18229 If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
18230 redirection list must start with this directory.
18233 .option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
18234 This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
18235 &%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
18238 .option one_time redirect boolean false
18239 .cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
18240 .cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
18241 .cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
18242 .cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
18243 .cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
18244 Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
18245 files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
18246 of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
18247 is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
18248 but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
18249 message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
18250 lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
18251 before they subscribed.
18253 If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
18254 deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
18255 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
18256 &"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
18259 &*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
18260 router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
18261 reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
18262 permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
18264 &*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
18265 to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
18266 and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
18268 &*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
18271 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
18272 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
18273 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
18274 &%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
18275 typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
18279 .option owners redirect "string list" unset
18280 .cindex "ownership" "alias file"
18281 .cindex "ownership" "forward file"
18282 .cindex "alias file" "ownership"
18283 .cindex "forward file" "ownership"
18284 This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
18285 This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
18286 See &%check_owner%& above.
18289 .option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
18290 This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
18291 The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
18292 &%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
18295 .option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
18296 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
18297 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
18298 starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
18299 transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
18300 name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
18301 When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
18304 .option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
18305 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
18306 If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
18307 generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
18308 in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
18309 expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
18310 to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
18311 &$qualify_recipient$&.
18313 This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
18314 but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
18315 not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
18318 .option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
18319 .cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
18320 .cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
18321 .cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
18322 If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
18323 set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
18324 without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
18325 address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
18326 &%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
18327 this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
18330 .option repeat_use redirect boolean true
18331 If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
18332 any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
18333 the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
18334 only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
18335 &%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
18338 .option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
18339 A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
18340 &%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
18341 by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
18342 transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
18343 are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
18346 .option rewrite redirect boolean true
18347 .cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
18348 If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
18349 subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
18350 and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
18353 .option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
18354 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
18355 :subaddress part of an address.
18357 .option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
18358 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
18359 of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
18360 (including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
18363 .option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
18364 .cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
18365 To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
18366 &%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
18367 (do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
18368 &%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
18369 needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
18373 .option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
18374 .cindex "forward file" "broken"
18375 .cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
18376 .cindex "alias file" "broken"
18377 .cindex "broken alias or forward files"
18378 .cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
18379 .cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
18380 .cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
18381 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
18382 non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
18383 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
18384 giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
18385 are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
18386 &%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
18387 be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
18388 &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
18390 If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
18391 errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
18392 the following routers.
18394 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
18395 error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
18396 taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
18397 so it is passed to the following routers.
18399 .cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
18400 Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
18401 action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
18402 &%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
18404 &%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
18405 lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
18406 option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
18407 notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
18413 file = $home/.forward
18414 file_transport = address_file
18415 pipe_transport = address_pipe
18416 reply_transport = address_reply
18419 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
18420 syntax_errors_text = \
18421 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
18422 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
18423 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
18424 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
18425 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
18426 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
18427 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
18428 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
18429 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
18430 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
18432 You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
18433 &`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
18434 put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
18439 local_part_prefix = real-
18440 transport = local_delivery
18442 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
18443 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
18445 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
18446 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
18450 .option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
18451 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
18454 .option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
18455 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
18456 .ecindex IIDredrou1
18457 .ecindex IIDredrou2
18464 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18465 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18467 .chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
18468 "Environment for local transports"
18469 .scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
18470 .scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment for local transports"
18471 .scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
18472 Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
18473 transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
18474 in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
18475 mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
18477 Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
18478 some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
18479 transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
18480 &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
18482 The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
18483 different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
18484 settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
18485 or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
18486 configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
18490 .section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
18491 .cindex "concurrent deliveries"
18492 .cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
18493 If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
18494 simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
18495 the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
18496 rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
18499 However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
18500 locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
18504 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
18506 This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
18507 messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
18508 &%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
18509 file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
18514 .section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
18515 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18516 .cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
18517 All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
18518 overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
18519 set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
18520 delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
18521 group (set by the transport). For example:
18524 # User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
18528 transport = group_delivery
18531 # This transport overrides the group
18533 driver = appendfile
18534 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
18537 If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
18538 address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
18539 gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
18542 .oindex "&%initgroups%&"
18543 When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
18544 function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
18545 &%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
18546 by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
18547 for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
18549 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
18550 The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
18551 is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
18552 receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
18553 original gid is also used.
18555 This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
18556 following that is set is used:
18559 A &%group%& setting of the transport;
18561 A &%group%& setting of the router;
18563 A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
18564 &%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
18566 The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
18568 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
18569 the uid is the creator's uid;
18571 The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
18574 If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
18575 no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
18576 This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
18577 The first of the following that is set is used:
18580 A &%user%& setting of the transport;
18582 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
18584 A &%user%& setting of the router;
18586 A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
18591 Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
18592 &%never_users%& list.
18598 .section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
18599 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
18600 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
18601 .cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
18602 .cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
18603 Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
18604 the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
18605 However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
18606 are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
18607 for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
18610 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
18612 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
18614 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
18616 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
18619 The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
18622 The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
18624 The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
18628 If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
18629 value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
18630 directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
18634 .section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
18635 .vindex "&$domain$&"
18636 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
18637 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
18638 Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
18639 variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
18640 deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
18641 at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
18642 other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
18643 never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
18644 and &$original_domain$& is never set.
18645 .ecindex IIDenvlotra1
18646 .ecindex IIDenvlotra2
18647 .ecindex IIDenvlotra3
18655 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18656 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18658 .chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
18659 .scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
18660 .scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
18661 .scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
18662 The following generic options apply to all transports:
18665 .option body_only transports boolean false
18666 .cindex "transport" "body only"
18667 .cindex "message" "transporting body only"
18668 .cindex "body of message" "transporting"
18669 If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
18670 mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
18671 or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
18672 &%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
18673 automatically suppress them.
18676 .option current_directory transports string&!! unset
18677 .cindex "transport" "current directory for"
18678 This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
18679 transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
18680 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
18681 logged, and delivery is deferred.
18684 .option disable_logging transports boolean false
18685 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
18686 deliveries by the transport or for any
18687 transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
18688 what you are doing.
18691 .option debug_print transports string&!! unset
18692 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
18693 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
18694 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
18696 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
18697 output, and Exim carries on processing.
18698 This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
18699 so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
18700 option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
18701 variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
18705 .option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
18706 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
18707 If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
18708 This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
18709 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
18710 requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
18711 safely be resent to other recipients.
18714 .option driver transports string unset
18715 This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
18716 There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
18719 .option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
18720 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
18721 If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
18722 This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
18723 delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
18724 configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
18725 address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
18726 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
18727 its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
18728 resent to other recipients.
18731 .option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
18732 .cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
18733 This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
18734 value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
18735 &%user%& (see below).
18738 .option headers_add transports string&!! unset
18739 .cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
18740 .cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
18741 This option specifies a string of text that is expanded and added to the header
18742 portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
18743 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
18744 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
18745 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
18746 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
18750 .option headers_only transports boolean false
18751 .cindex "transport" "header lines only"
18752 .cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
18753 .cindex "header lines" "transporting"
18754 If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
18755 exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
18756 transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
18757 checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
18760 .option headers_remove transports string&!! unset
18761 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
18762 .cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
18763 This option specifies a string that is expanded into a list of header names;
18764 these headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
18765 in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
18766 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
18767 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
18768 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
18772 .option headers_rewrite transports string unset
18773 .cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
18774 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
18775 This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
18776 that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
18777 option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
18778 the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
18779 message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
18782 headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
18785 changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
18786 &'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
18787 header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
18788 only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
18789 the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
18790 filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
18791 affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
18792 envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
18793 change envelope recipients at this time.
18796 .option home_directory transports string&!! unset
18797 .cindex "transport" "home directory for"
18799 This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
18800 overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
18801 placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
18802 used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
18803 &%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
18804 &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
18805 for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
18809 .option initgroups transports boolean false
18810 .cindex "additional groups"
18811 .cindex "groups" "additional"
18812 .cindex "transport" "group; additional"
18813 If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
18814 transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
18815 to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
18818 .option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
18819 .cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
18820 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
18821 .cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
18822 This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
18823 expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
18824 digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
18825 including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
18826 delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
18827 message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
18828 the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
18829 ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
18830 &%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
18835 .option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
18836 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
18837 .cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
18838 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
18839 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
18840 When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
18841 affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
18842 form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
18845 local_part_prefix = *-
18847 routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
18850 RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
18852 This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
18853 recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
18854 whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
18855 deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
18856 &(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
18859 .option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
18860 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
18861 When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
18862 in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
18863 is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
18864 deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
18865 part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
18866 temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
18867 deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
18869 However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
18870 as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
18871 (For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
18872 this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
18874 For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
18875 the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
18876 on a remote transport in the current implementation.
18879 .option return_path transports string&!! unset
18880 .cindex "envelope sender"
18881 .cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
18882 .cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
18883 If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
18884 the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
18885 that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
18886 designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
18887 SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
18888 only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
18889 header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
18891 &*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
18892 &%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
18894 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
18895 The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
18896 either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
18897 &%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
18898 replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
18899 option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
18900 section &<<SECTverp>>&.
18902 &*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
18903 remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
18904 the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
18905 This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
18906 &%errors_to%& in a router.
18910 .option return_path_add transports boolean false
18911 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
18912 If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
18913 Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
18914 mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
18915 have easy access to it.
18917 RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
18918 the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
18919 header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
18920 option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
18921 incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
18925 .option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
18926 See &%shadow_transport%& below.
18929 .option shadow_transport transports string unset
18930 .cindex "shadow transport"
18931 .cindex "transport" "shadow"
18932 A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
18933 another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
18935 Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
18936 &%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
18937 string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
18938 passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
18939 expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
18940 cause a log line to be written.
18942 The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
18943 subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
18944 provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
18945 is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
18946 ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
18949 ST=<shadow transport name>
18951 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
18952 parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
18953 purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
18954 provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
18955 headers that some sites insist on.
18958 .option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
18959 .cindex "transport" "filter"
18960 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
18961 This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
18962 at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
18963 individual users or via a system filter.
18965 When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
18966 &%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
18967 the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
18968 input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
18969 command must be specified as an absolute path.
18971 The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
18972 terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
18973 SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
18974 lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
18975 settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
18976 &(pipe)& transports.
18978 The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
18979 standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
18980 destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
18981 filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
18982 are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
18984 The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
18985 care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
18986 test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
18987 SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
18989 .cindex "content scanning" "per user"
18990 A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
18991 at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
18992 message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
18993 a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
18994 not possible to discard a message at this stage.
18996 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
18997 A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
18998 being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
18999 support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
19000 at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
19001 more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
19002 the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
19003 additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
19005 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
19006 The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
19007 the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
19008 parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
19009 Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
19010 section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
19011 to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
19012 of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
19013 an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
19014 &(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
19017 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
19018 The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
19019 transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
19020 which the message is being sent. For example:
19022 transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
19023 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
19026 Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
19027 generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
19028 command is split up &'before'& expansion.
19030 If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
19031 part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
19032 expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
19035 transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
19037 This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
19038 &(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
19039 stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
19040 the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
19041 &`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
19042 Exim tried to expand the first one.
19044 Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
19045 expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
19046 arguments. Consider this example:
19048 transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
19049 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
19051 The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
19052 if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
19054 transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
19055 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
19059 The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
19060 For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
19061 normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
19062 A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
19063 serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
19064 the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
19065 bounced from a transport filter.
19067 If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
19068 passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
19069 message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
19072 .option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
19073 .cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
19074 When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it a applies a timeout
19075 that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
19076 temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
19077 &(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
19078 way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
19079 error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
19080 becomes a temporary error.
19083 .option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
19084 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
19085 .cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
19086 This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
19087 run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
19088 given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
19089 associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
19092 For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
19093 specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
19094 &%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
19096 .cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
19097 For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
19098 sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
19099 to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
19101 .ecindex IIDgenoptra1
19102 .ecindex IIDgenoptra2
19103 .ecindex IIDgenoptra3
19110 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19111 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19113 .chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
19115 .cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
19116 The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
19117 one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
19118 remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
19119 normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
19120 transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
19121 copy of the message is delivered each time.
19123 .cindex "batched local delivery"
19124 .oindex "&%batch_max%&"
19125 .oindex "&%batch_id%&"
19126 In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
19127 local transport, for example:
19130 In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
19131 delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
19132 recipients saves space.
19134 In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
19135 a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
19137 In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
19138 to a scanner program or
19139 to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
19143 These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
19144 (&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
19145 repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
19147 The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
19148 delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
19149 (no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
19150 &%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
19151 (that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
19152 to certain conditions:
19155 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
19156 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
19157 batching is possible.
19159 .vindex "&$domain$&"
19160 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
19161 addresses with the same domain are batched.
19163 .cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
19164 If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
19165 addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
19166 customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
19167 including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
19170 Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
19171 delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
19172 group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
19176 In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
19177 both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
19178 is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
19179 course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
19180 option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
19181 &"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
19182 &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
19185 escape_string = ".."
19187 when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
19188 given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
19189 &%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
19191 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
19192 If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
19193 &'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
19194 that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
19195 transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
19196 addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
19198 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
19199 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
19200 If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
19201 transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
19202 the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
19203 of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
19204 argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
19205 delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
19206 are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
19211 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19212 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19214 .chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
19215 .scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
19216 .scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
19217 .cindex "directory creation"
19218 .cindex "creating directories"
19219 The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
19220 file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
19221 files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
19222 format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
19223 University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
19224 being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
19225 to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
19226 delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
19227 supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
19228 directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
19230 The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
19231 default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
19232 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
19235 .cindex "quota" "system"
19236 Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
19237 also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
19238 system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
19240 If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
19241 partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
19242 modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
19243 creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
19245 Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
19246 file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
19249 The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
19250 users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
19251 putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
19252 &"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
19257 .section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
19258 The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
19259 the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
19260 the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
19261 normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
19263 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
19264 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
19265 However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
19266 directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
19267 forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
19268 user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
19269 the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
19270 name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
19271 operation. There are two cases:
19274 If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
19275 must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
19276 common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
19277 different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
19278 default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
19279 name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
19280 &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
19282 If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
19283 used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
19284 contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
19288 .cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
19289 .cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
19290 As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
19291 have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
19296 or Sieve filter commands of the form:
19298 require "fileinto";
19299 fileinto "folder23";
19301 In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
19302 must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute file name. In the
19303 case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
19304 is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
19305 way of handling this requirement:
19307 file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
19308 {/var/mail/$local_part} \
19309 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
19311 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
19315 With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
19316 location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
19317 &_mail_& directory within the home directory.
19319 &*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
19320 &_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
19321 the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
19322 you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
19323 &%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
19324 path to the transport.
19326 &*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
19327 the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
19332 .section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
19333 .cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
19337 .option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
19338 .cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
19339 .cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
19340 .cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
19341 Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
19342 regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
19343 delivery is deferred.
19346 .option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
19347 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
19348 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
19349 By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
19350 that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
19351 are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
19352 what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
19353 are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
19356 .option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
19357 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
19358 However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
19359 happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
19363 .option batch_max appendfile integer 1
19364 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
19367 .option check_group appendfile boolean false
19368 When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
19369 option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
19370 delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
19371 file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
19374 .option check_owner appendfile boolean true
19375 When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
19376 is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
19377 process is running.
19380 .option check_string appendfile string "see below"
19381 .cindex "&""From""& line"
19382 As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
19383 matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
19384 replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
19385 a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
19386 contains is significant.
19388 If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
19389 are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
19390 configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
19391 &">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
19392 &%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
19394 The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
19395 suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
19396 &"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
19397 if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
19398 .cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
19399 .cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
19401 check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
19402 escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
19403 message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
19404 message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
19406 .option create_directory appendfile boolean true
19407 .cindex "directory creation"
19408 When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
19409 directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
19410 is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
19412 The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
19413 operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
19414 example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
19415 is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
19416 in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
19420 .option create_file appendfile string anywhere
19421 This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
19422 by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
19423 directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
19424 delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
19427 The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
19428 &"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
19429 set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit file name is
19430 given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when file
19431 names are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
19432 by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
19433 &%file_must_exist%&.
19436 .option directory appendfile string&!! unset
19437 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
19438 or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
19439 redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
19441 When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
19442 into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
19443 appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
19444 (see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
19445 &<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
19448 .option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
19450 .vindex "&$inode$&"
19451 When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
19452 &%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
19453 whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
19455 q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
19457 This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
19458 inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
19462 .option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
19463 If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
19464 &%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
19467 .option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
19468 See &%check_string%& above.
19471 .option file appendfile string&!! unset
19472 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
19473 &%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
19474 of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
19475 specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
19476 &%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
19479 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
19480 .cindex "locking files"
19481 .cindex "lock files"
19482 If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
19483 mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
19485 The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
19486 path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
19489 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
19490 file = /home/$local_part/inbox
19493 .cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
19494 In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
19495 is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
19496 create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
19497 deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
19498 run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
19502 .option file_format appendfile string unset
19503 .cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
19504 This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
19505 before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
19506 start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
19507 colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
19508 second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
19509 string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
19510 transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
19513 file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
19514 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
19516 Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
19517 a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
19518 to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
19519 to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
19520 is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
19521 match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
19522 delivery is deferred.
19525 .option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
19526 If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
19527 A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
19528 If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
19531 .option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
19532 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
19533 .cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
19534 .cindex "locking files"
19535 By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
19536 when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
19537 sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
19538 Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
19539 for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
19540 deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
19541 mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
19542 misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
19544 On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
19545 not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
19546 is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
19547 and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
19549 If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
19550 timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
19553 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
19555 rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
19556 which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
19557 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
19559 You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
19560 local deliveries because of errors of the form
19562 failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
19565 .option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
19566 This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
19567 &%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
19568 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
19571 .option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
19572 This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
19573 for details of locking.
19576 .option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
19577 This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
19578 is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
19581 .option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
19582 This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
19583 used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
19586 .option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
19587 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
19588 When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
19589 exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
19590 accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
19593 .option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
19594 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
19595 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
19596 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
19597 number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
19598 followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
19599 external source that maintains the data.
19602 .option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
19603 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
19604 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
19605 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
19606 size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
19607 This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
19608 maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
19609 it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
19613 .option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
19614 .cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
19615 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
19616 file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
19617 transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
19618 &(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
19619 &%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
19620 directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
19621 SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
19622 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
19625 .option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
19626 .cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
19627 .cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
19628 This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
19629 a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
19630 directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
19631 calculation. The default value is:
19633 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
19635 This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
19636 (directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
19638 folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
19640 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
19642 This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
19643 directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
19644 calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
19645 directly into that directory.
19648 .option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
19649 This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
19650 &"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
19653 .option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
19654 This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
19655 section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
19658 .option maildir_use_size_file appendfile boolean false
19659 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
19660 Setting this option true enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
19661 creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
19662 quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
19663 value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
19664 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
19666 .option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
19667 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
19668 .cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
19669 The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
19670 effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
19671 matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
19672 containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
19673 delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
19674 &_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
19675 See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
19678 .option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
19679 .cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
19680 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
19681 new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
19682 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
19683 below for further details.
19686 .option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
19687 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
19688 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
19691 .option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
19692 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
19693 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
19696 .option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
19697 .cindex "locking files"
19698 .cindex "file" "locking"
19699 .cindex "file" "MBX format"
19700 .cindex "MBX format, specifying"
19701 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
19702 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
19703 the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
19704 traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
19705 IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
19707 &*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
19708 automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
19709 empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
19716 If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
19717 &%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
19718 is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
19719 &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
19720 interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
19721 should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
19722 going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
19723 mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
19725 If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
19726 the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
19727 (this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
19728 append messages to it.
19731 .option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
19732 .cindex "&""From""& line"
19733 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
19734 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
19735 in which case it is:
19737 message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
19738 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
19740 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
19741 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
19743 .option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
19744 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
19745 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
19746 in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
19751 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
19752 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
19754 .option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
19755 If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
19756 has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
19757 permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
19758 if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
19759 a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
19760 value, and this option is ignored.
19763 .option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
19764 This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
19765 mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
19766 true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
19767 continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
19770 .option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
19771 If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
19772 successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
19773 on users about incoming mail.
19776 .option quota appendfile string&!! unset
19777 .cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
19778 This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
19779 or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
19780 is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
19781 all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
19782 individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
19783 &%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
19784 have no shell access to their mailboxes).
19786 As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
19787 multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
19788 For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
19790 A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
19791 may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
19792 If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
19793 become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
19794 Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
19795 the obvious value which users understand most easily.
19797 The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
19798 (decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
19799 for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes. If Exim is running on a system with
19800 large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
19803 &*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
19805 The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
19806 the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
19807 be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
19808 fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
19809 system quota failures.
19811 By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
19812 mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
19813 last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
19814 during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
19815 refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
19816 message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
19817 changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
19818 for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
19819 continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
19820 delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
19823 .option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
19824 This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
19825 into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
19826 called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
19827 delivery directory.
19830 .option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
19831 This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
19832 number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
19833 can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
19834 failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
19838 .option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
19839 See &%quota%& above.
19842 .option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
19843 This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
19844 for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
19845 these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
19846 If this is set to a regular expression that matches the file name, and it
19847 captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
19848 file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
19850 This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
19851 &-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
19852 facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
19853 the file length to the file name. For example:
19855 maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
19856 quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
19858 An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
19859 number of lines in the message.
19861 The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
19862 file name (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
19863 sometimes add other information onto the ends of message file names.
19867 .option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
19868 See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
19869 &%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
19871 quota_warn_message = "\
19872 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
19873 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
19874 This message is automatically created \
19875 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
19876 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
19877 a warning threshold that is\n\
19878 set by the system administrator.\n"
19882 .option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
19883 .cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
19884 .cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
19885 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
19886 This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
19887 resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
19888 size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
19889 threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
19890 may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
19894 quota_warn_threshold = 75%
19896 If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
19897 percent sign is ignored.
19899 The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
19900 and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
19901 warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
19902 the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
19903 can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
19904 &'From:'& line, the default is:
19906 From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
19908 .oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
19909 If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
19912 The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
19913 are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
19917 .option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
19918 .cindex "envelope sender"
19919 If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
19920 format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
19921 you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
19922 so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
19923 for details of batch SMTP.
19926 .option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
19927 .cindex "carriage return"
19929 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
19930 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
19931 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
19932 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
19934 &*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
19935 (which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
19936 in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
19937 carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
19938 have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
19939 changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
19942 .option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
19943 This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
19944 exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
19945 &%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
19946 that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
19947 &%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
19950 .option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
19951 This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
19952 the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
19953 &[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
19954 each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
19956 This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
19957 &[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
19958 where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
19959 both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
19961 .cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
19962 Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
19963 have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
19964 &[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
19965 the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
19968 &*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
19969 is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
19972 .option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
19973 If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
19974 appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
19975 &[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
19976 sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
19977 &[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
19978 delivering over NFS from more than one host.
19980 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
19981 In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
19982 necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
19983 achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
19986 The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
19987 It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
19988 except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
19991 .option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
19992 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
19993 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
19994 locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
19995 of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
19996 are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
19997 the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
19998 rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
19999 does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
20001 You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
20002 &%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
20003 MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
20004 without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
20009 .section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
20010 .cindex "appending to a file"
20011 .cindex "file" "appending"
20012 Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
20015 If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
20019 .cindex "directory creation"
20020 If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
20021 &%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
20022 &%directory_mode%& option.
20025 If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
20026 indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
20030 .cindex "file" "locking"
20031 .cindex "locking files"
20032 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
20033 If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
20034 reliably over NFS, as follows:
20037 Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
20038 current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
20039 as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
20041 Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock file name.
20043 If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
20044 Unlink the hitching post name.
20046 Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
20047 then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
20048 of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
20049 restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
20051 If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
20052 up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
20053 mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
20054 lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
20055 existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
20056 it before trying again.
20060 A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
20061 so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
20062 than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
20065 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
20066 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
20067 If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
20068 &%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
20069 checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
20070 is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
20071 ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
20072 directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
20073 idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
20077 If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
20078 and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
20079 different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
20080 delivery is deferred.
20083 If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
20084 If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
20085 is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
20089 The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
20090 If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
20091 hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
20094 If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
20095 changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
20096 have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
20099 If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
20100 option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
20101 directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
20102 open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
20103 except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
20104 set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
20105 the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
20106 that prevents link following.
20109 .cindex "loop" "while file testing"
20110 If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
20111 existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
20112 being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
20113 after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
20116 If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
20119 .cindex "file" "locking"
20120 .cindex "locking files"
20121 Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
20122 are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
20123 &%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
20124 However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
20125 file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
20127 /tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
20129 using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
20130 the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
20131 the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
20133 If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
20134 depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
20135 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
20137 If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
20138 &%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
20139 to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
20140 delivery is deferred.
20142 If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
20143 &[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
20144 waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
20145 immediately. It retries up to
20147 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
20149 times (rounded up).
20152 At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
20153 and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
20156 .section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
20157 .cindex "delivery" "to single file"
20158 .cindex "&""From""& line"
20159 When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
20160 delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
20161 activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
20162 &%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
20163 router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
20164 configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
20165 ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
20167 No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
20168 locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
20169 separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
20170 of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
20171 newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
20172 &%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
20173 any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
20175 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
20176 the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
20177 different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
20178 deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
20181 .cindex "maildir format"
20182 .cindex "mailstore format"
20183 There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
20184 done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
20185 &%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
20186 formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
20187 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
20189 .cindex "directory creation"
20190 In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
20191 sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
20192 option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
20193 constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
20194 the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
20195 &%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
20200 .section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
20201 .cindex "maildir format" "description of"
20202 If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
20203 it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
20204 directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
20205 directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
20206 &_new_& subdirectory.
20208 In the file name, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
20209 <&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
20210 Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
20211 before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
20212 file name. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
20213 opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
20214 Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
20216 Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
20217 called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
20218 do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
20219 path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
20220 &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
20221 contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
20222 &_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
20223 &_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
20225 These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
20226 and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
20227 folders. Consider this example:
20229 maildir_format = true
20230 directory = /var/mail/$local_part\
20231 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
20232 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
20233 maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
20235 If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
20236 delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
20237 the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
20238 not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
20239 &_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
20240 &_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
20242 However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
20243 delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
20244 does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
20245 &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
20246 directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
20248 &*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
20249 not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
20250 &_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
20252 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
20253 .cindex "maildir++"
20254 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
20255 &%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
20256 the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
20257 Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
20258 down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
20259 the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
20260 amount of space used.
20262 One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
20263 computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
20264 checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
20265 needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
20266 use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
20267 of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
20272 .section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
20273 If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
20274 When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
20275 tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
20276 name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
20277 the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
20279 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
20280 Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
20281 &%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
20282 happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
20283 variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
20284 forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
20285 be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
20286 Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
20287 empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
20292 .section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
20293 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
20294 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
20295 If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
20296 storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
20297 within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
20298 creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
20299 the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
20300 to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
20302 The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
20303 messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
20304 in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
20305 value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
20306 is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
20307 need to know the quota.
20309 If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
20310 file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
20312 A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
20313 maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
20314 See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
20318 .section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
20319 .cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
20320 If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
20321 files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
20322 message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
20323 this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
20324 contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
20325 itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
20327 During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
20328 &_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
20329 &_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
20330 mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
20331 file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
20332 the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
20334 The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
20335 option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
20336 the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
20337 There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
20338 greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
20339 appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
20341 If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
20342 failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
20343 configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
20344 &$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
20347 .section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
20348 If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
20349 file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
20350 messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
20351 section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
20353 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
20355 might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
20356 then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
20357 expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
20358 .ecindex IIDapptra1
20359 .ecindex IIDapptra2
20366 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20367 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20369 .chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
20370 .scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
20371 .scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
20372 The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
20373 the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
20374 automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
20375 &'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
20376 to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
20378 If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
20379 &%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
20380 delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
20381 that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
20382 another router can set up a normal message delivery.
20385 The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
20386 &"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
20387 directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
20388 message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
20389 empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
20391 The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
20392 by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
20393 passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
20394 transport is run as a consequence of a
20396 or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
20397 supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
20398 that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
20399 case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
20400 is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
20401 &%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
20403 &(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
20404 command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
20405 gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
20406 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
20408 There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
20409 that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
20410 &(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
20411 address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
20412 separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
20413 the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
20414 message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
20416 Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
20417 message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
20418 immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
20419 the transport defers.
20420 Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
20421 controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
20423 If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
20424 &%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
20425 of the original message that is included in the generated message when
20426 &%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
20428 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
20429 If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
20430 the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
20431 as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
20432 is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
20433 problems. They are just discarded.
20437 .section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
20438 .cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
20440 .option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
20441 This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
20442 message when the message is specified by the transport.
20445 .option cc autoreply string&!! unset
20446 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
20447 when the message is specified by the transport.
20450 .option file autoreply string&!! unset
20451 The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
20452 is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
20453 string comes first.
20456 .option file_expand autoreply boolean false
20457 If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
20458 subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
20461 .option file_optional autoreply boolean false
20462 If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
20463 option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
20466 .option from autoreply string&!! unset
20467 This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
20468 specified by the transport.
20471 .option headers autoreply string&!! unset
20472 This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
20473 when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
20474 &"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
20477 .option log autoreply string&!! unset
20478 This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
20479 the message is specified by the transport.
20482 .option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
20483 If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
20487 .option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
20488 If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
20489 item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
20490 discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
20491 generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
20495 .option once autoreply string&!! unset
20496 This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
20497 recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
20498 This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
20500 If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
20501 By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty file name, the message
20502 is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
20503 However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
20504 message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
20505 this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
20506 prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
20509 If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
20510 and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
20511 greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
20512 Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
20513 regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
20515 In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
20516 which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
20517 be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
20518 means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
20519 unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
20520 file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
20523 .option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
20524 See &%once%& above.
20527 .option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
20528 See &%once%& above.
20529 After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
20532 .option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
20533 This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
20534 specified by the transport.
20537 .option return_message autoreply boolean false
20538 If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
20539 message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
20540 configuration option.
20543 .option subject autoreply string&!! unset
20544 This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
20545 specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
20546 automatic responses. For example:
20548 subject = Re: $h_subject:
20550 There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
20551 subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
20552 bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
20553 non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
20558 .option text autoreply string&!! unset
20559 This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
20560 message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
20561 the text comes first.
20564 .option to autoreply string&!! unset
20565 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
20566 when the message is specified by the transport.
20567 .ecindex IIDauttra1
20568 .ecindex IIDauttra2
20573 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20574 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20576 .chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
20577 .cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
20578 .cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
20579 .cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
20580 .cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
20581 The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
20583 or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
20584 This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
20585 transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
20586 implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
20587 to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
20588 has it commented out. You need to ensure that
20592 .cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
20593 is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
20594 included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
20597 .option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
20598 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
20601 .option batch_max lmtp integer 1
20602 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
20603 Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
20604 good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
20605 batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
20608 .option command lmtp string&!! unset
20609 This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
20610 is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
20611 arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
20612 number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
20613 is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
20616 .option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
20617 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
20618 If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
20619 commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
20620 in its response to the LHLO command.
20622 .option socket lmtp string&!! unset
20623 This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
20624 be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
20625 delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
20628 .option timeout lmtp time 5m
20629 The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
20630 respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
20631 is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
20636 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
20640 This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
20641 necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
20645 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20646 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20648 .chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
20649 .scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
20650 .scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
20651 The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
20652 running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
20653 pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
20654 (such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
20655 their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
20659 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
20660 A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
20661 transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
20662 contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
20663 is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
20665 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
20666 If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
20667 transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
20668 more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
20669 (because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
20670 (described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
20671 that are routed to the transport.
20673 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
20674 A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
20675 alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
20676 pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If only
20677 one address is being transported (&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or
20678 only one address was redirected to this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains
20679 the local part that was redirected.
20683 The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
20684 deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
20685 implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
20687 In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
20688 &_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
20689 other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
20690 transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
20691 directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
20692 details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
20693 for a discussion of local delivery batching.
20696 .section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
20697 If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
20698 delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
20699 any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
20700 write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
20705 .section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
20706 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
20707 If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
20708 have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
20709 the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
20710 in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
20711 later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
20712 logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
20713 &"local delivery failed"&.
20715 If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
20716 script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
20717 value is the return code minus 128.
20719 If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
20720 return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
20721 asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
20722 a non-existent command may be the problem.
20724 The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
20725 set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
20726 error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
20727 return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
20728 included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
20729 similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
20730 failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
20735 .section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
20736 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
20737 The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
20738 by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
20739 &%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
20742 .cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
20743 Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
20744 double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
20745 way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
20747 String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
20748 traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
20749 expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
20750 For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
20751 quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
20753 command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
20755 will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
20756 arguments. You have to write
20758 command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
20760 to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
20761 argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
20762 result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
20763 interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
20764 generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
20765 expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
20768 command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
20771 .cindex "transport" "filter"
20772 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
20773 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
20774 Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
20775 &`$pipe_addresses`&. This is not a general expansion variable; the only
20776 place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
20777 transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
20778 inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
20779 avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
20780 &(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
20782 After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
20783 in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
20784 message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
20785 standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
20786 read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
20787 may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
20788 control what is done with it.
20790 Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
20791 in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
20792 taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
20793 explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
20794 where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
20795 under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
20796 an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
20797 works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
20798 as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
20799 &%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
20800 with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
20804 .section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
20805 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
20806 .cindex "environment for pipe transport"
20807 The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
20808 This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
20809 the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
20812 &`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
20813 &`HOME `& the home directory, if set
20814 &`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
20815 &`LOCAL_PART `& see below
20816 &`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
20817 &`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
20818 &`LOGNAME `& see below
20819 &`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
20820 &`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
20821 &`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
20822 &`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
20823 &`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
20824 &`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
20825 &`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
20826 &`USER `& see below
20828 When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
20829 router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
20830 called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
20831 the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
20832 removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
20833 LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
20834 same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
20837 HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
20838 associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
20839 pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
20843 If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
20844 for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
20845 by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
20846 user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
20849 .section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
20850 .cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
20854 .option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
20855 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
20856 The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
20857 permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
20858 permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
20859 paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
20860 &%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
20861 in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
20862 the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
20863 &%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
20864 otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
20867 allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
20869 and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
20870 &_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
20871 &%use_shell%& is set.
20874 .option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
20875 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
20878 .option batch_max pipe integer 1
20879 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
20880 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
20883 .option check_string pipe string unset
20884 As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
20885 &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
20886 by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
20887 &%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
20888 any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
20889 of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
20890 the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
20894 .option command pipe string&!! unset
20895 This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
20896 obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
20897 set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
20898 the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
20899 Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
20900 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
20903 .option environment pipe string&!! unset
20904 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
20905 .cindex "environment for &(pipe)& transport"
20906 This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
20907 command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
20908 a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
20909 environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
20912 .option escape_string pipe string unset
20913 See &%check_string%& above.
20916 .option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
20917 .cindex "exec failure"
20918 .cindex "failure of exec"
20919 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
20920 Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
20921 any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
20922 is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
20923 frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
20926 .option ignore_status pipe boolean false
20927 If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
20928 run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
20929 Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
20930 from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
20931 &%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
20933 &*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
20934 See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
20936 .option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
20937 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
20938 If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
20939 one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
20940 and any output was produced, the first line of it is written to the main log.
20943 .option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
20944 If this option is set, and the command returns any output, and also ends with a
20945 return code that is neither zero nor one of the return codes listed in
20946 &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery failed), the first line of output is
20947 written to the main log. This option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive.
20948 Only one of them may be set.
20952 .option log_output pipe boolean false
20953 If this option is set and the command returns any output, the first line of
20954 output is written to the main log, whatever the return code. This option and
20955 &%log_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
20959 .option max_output pipe integer 20K
20960 This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
20961 standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
20962 process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
20963 catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
20964 the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
20965 &%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
20966 exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
20969 .option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
20970 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
20971 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
20974 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
20978 .cindex "&%tmail%&"
20979 .cindex "&""From""& line"
20980 This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
20981 However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
20982 or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
20987 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
20988 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
20991 .option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
20992 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
20993 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
20994 The suffix can be suppressed by setting
20998 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
20999 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
21002 .option path pipe string "see below"
21003 This option specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
21004 variable of the subprocess. The default is:
21008 If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
21009 sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
21010 apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
21013 .option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
21014 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
21015 If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
21016 process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
21017 to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
21018 &%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
21019 accept the message is used.
21022 .option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
21023 When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
21024 contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
21025 in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
21026 command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
21027 handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
21030 .option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
21031 If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
21032 return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
21033 is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
21034 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
21035 message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
21036 &%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
21040 .option return_output pipe boolean false
21041 If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
21042 deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
21043 is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
21044 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
21045 output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
21046 option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
21047 of them may be set.
21051 .option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
21052 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
21053 This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
21054 asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
21055 and &%return_output%& is not set,
21056 and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
21057 temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
21058 numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
21059 codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
21060 defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
21061 compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
21062 and 73, respectively.
21065 .option timeout pipe time 1h
21066 If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
21067 causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
21068 specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
21069 command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
21070 and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
21071 if one of the processes starts a new process group.
21073 .option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
21074 A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
21075 runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
21076 treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
21077 is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
21078 delivery to be deferred.
21080 .option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
21081 This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
21084 .option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
21085 .cindex "envelope sender"
21086 If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
21087 SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
21088 commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
21089 you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
21090 &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
21092 .option use_classresources pipe boolean false
21093 .cindex "class resources (BSD)"
21094 This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
21095 BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
21096 resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
21097 limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
21101 .option use_crlf pipe boolean false
21102 .cindex "carriage return"
21104 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
21105 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
21106 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
21107 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
21109 The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
21110 written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
21111 are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
21112 &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
21113 values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
21116 .option use_shell pipe boolean false
21117 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21118 If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
21119 instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
21120 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
21121 where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
21122 modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
21123 &`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
21124 command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
21129 .section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
21130 .cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
21131 .cindex "&'procmail'&"
21132 .cindex "external local delivery"
21133 .cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
21134 .cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
21135 The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
21136 delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
21137 this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
21138 uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
21139 by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
21140 necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
21141 appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
21142 configuration for &%procmail%&:
21147 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
21151 check_string = "From "
21152 escape_string = ">From "
21160 transport = procmail_pipe
21162 In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
21163 &'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
21164 or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
21165 user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
21166 &%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
21167 home directory is the user's home directory by default.
21169 &*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
21173 as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
21174 use a shell to run pipe commands.
21177 The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
21178 deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
21181 local_delivery_cyrus:
21183 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
21184 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
21196 local_part_suffix = .*
21197 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
21199 Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
21200 &%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
21202 .ecindex IIDpiptra1
21203 .ecindex IIDpiptra2
21206 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21207 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21209 .chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
21210 .scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
21211 .scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
21212 The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
21213 or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
21214 that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
21215 explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
21216 &<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
21219 .section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
21220 The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
21224 If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
21225 routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
21226 that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
21227 the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
21228 does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
21229 value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
21230 section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
21232 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
21233 When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
21234 looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
21235 connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
21236 for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
21237 process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
21242 For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
21243 incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
21244 no further messages are sent over that connection.
21248 .section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
21250 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
21251 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
21252 &$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
21253 passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
21254 specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
21255 &$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
21256 that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
21257 &%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
21260 .section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
21261 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
21262 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
21263 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_cipher$&
21264 and &$tls_peerdn$& are the values that were set when the message was received.
21265 These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
21266 SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these two
21267 variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
21268 appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
21269 are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
21270 &%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
21273 .section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
21274 .cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
21275 The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
21278 .option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
21279 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
21280 When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
21281 is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
21282 runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
21283 reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
21284 setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
21285 problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
21287 .option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
21288 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
21289 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
21290 When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
21291 to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
21292 deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
21293 the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
21294 configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
21295 configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
21298 .option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
21300 When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
21301 is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
21302 overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
21303 forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
21304 to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
21307 The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
21308 started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
21309 &$tls_cipher$&, and &$tls_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
21310 particular connection.
21312 If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
21313 &%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
21314 deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
21315 unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
21317 This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
21318 deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
21319 &"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
21321 authenticated_sender = $local_part
21323 This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
21324 allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
21326 Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
21327 domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
21331 .option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
21332 If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
21333 is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
21334 authenticated as a client.
21337 .option command_timeout smtp time 5m
21338 This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
21339 sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
21340 remote host. Its value must not be zero.
21343 .option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
21344 This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
21345 to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
21346 several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
21347 less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
21348 systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
21349 option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
21352 .option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
21353 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
21354 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
21355 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
21356 This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
21357 over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
21358 For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
21362 .option data_timeout smtp time 5m
21363 This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
21364 the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
21365 of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
21368 .option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
21369 This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
21370 domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
21373 In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
21374 them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
21375 Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
21376 retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
21377 a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
21378 unhappy at this prospect, so...
21380 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
21381 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
21382 IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
21383 none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
21384 delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
21385 addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
21386 continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
21387 &%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
21391 .option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
21392 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
21393 and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
21394 the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
21395 in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
21398 .option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
21399 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
21400 &%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
21401 See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
21406 .option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
21407 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
21408 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
21409 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
21410 port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
21411 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
21412 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
21413 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
21415 Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
21416 addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
21417 &%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
21418 not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
21419 &%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
21420 However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
21422 If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
21423 the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
21424 transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
21425 address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
21426 list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
21428 Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
21429 re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
21430 addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
21431 copy of the message is sent.
21433 The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
21434 &%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
21435 both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
21436 from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
21440 .option final_timeout smtp time 10m
21441 This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
21442 line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
21445 .option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
21446 If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
21447 being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
21448 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
21449 instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
21450 it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
21452 .option gnutls_require_kx main string unset
21453 This option controls the key exchange mechanisms when GnuTLS is used in an Exim
21454 client. For details, see section &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
21456 .option gnutls_require_mac main string unset
21457 This option controls the MAC algorithms when GnuTLS is used in an Exim
21458 client. For details, see section &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
21460 .option gnutls_require_protocols main string unset
21461 This option controls the protocols when GnuTLS is used in an Exim
21462 client. For details, see section &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
21464 .option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
21465 .cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
21466 .cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
21467 .cindex "LHLO argument setting"
21468 The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
21469 been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
21470 command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
21475 During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
21476 the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
21477 &$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
21478 used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
21479 servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
21480 that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
21481 interface address, you could use this:
21483 helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
21484 {$primary_hostname}}
21486 The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
21489 .option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
21490 Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
21491 finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
21492 &(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
21493 email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
21494 all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
21496 The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
21497 processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
21498 &%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
21499 &%hosts_override%& is set.
21501 The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
21502 list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
21503 separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
21504 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
21505 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
21506 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
21507 of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
21509 If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
21510 the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
21511 well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
21512 address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
21513 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
21514 &%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
21515 that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
21518 During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
21519 unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
21522 .option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
21523 .cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
21524 .cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
21525 .cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
21526 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
21527 This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
21528 example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
21529 matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
21530 start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
21531 facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
21534 .option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
21535 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
21536 Exim will not use the SMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
21537 that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
21540 .option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
21541 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
21542 Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
21543 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
21546 .option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
21547 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
21548 .cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
21549 .cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
21550 .cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
21551 This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
21552 delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
21553 &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
21556 .option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
21557 This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
21558 tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
21563 .option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
21564 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
21565 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
21566 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
21567 For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
21568 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
21569 message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
21570 explanation of when this might be needed.
21573 .option hosts_override smtp boolean false
21574 If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
21575 attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
21576 &%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
21577 &%fallback_hosts%&.
21580 .option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
21581 .cindex "randomized host list"
21582 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
21583 .cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
21584 If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
21585 &%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
21586 were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
21587 router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
21588 is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
21589 list can be used to do crude load sharing.
21591 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
21592 order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
21593 behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
21594 &`+`& in the host list. For example:
21596 hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
21598 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
21599 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
21600 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
21602 .option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
21603 .cindex "authentication" "required by client"
21604 This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
21605 before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
21606 servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
21607 authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
21608 temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
21609 hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
21610 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
21613 .option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
21614 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
21615 Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
21616 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
21617 &*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
21618 incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
21620 .option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
21621 .cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
21622 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
21623 authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
21624 connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
21625 unauthenticated. See also &%hosts_require_auth%&, and chapter
21626 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
21628 .option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
21629 .cindex "bind IP address"
21630 .cindex "IP address" "binding"
21632 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
21633 This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
21634 call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
21635 &`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
21636 message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
21637 &$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
21638 outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
21639 interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
21642 During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
21643 &$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
21644 during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
21645 string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
21646 string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
21647 separator can be changed in the usual way. For example:
21649 interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
21651 The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
21652 connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
21653 &%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
21654 interface to use if the host has more than one.
21657 .option keepalive smtp boolean true
21658 .cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
21659 This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
21660 connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
21661 periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
21662 of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
21663 or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
21664 that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
21665 that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
21666 TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
21670 .option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
21671 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
21672 If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
21673 string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
21674 has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
21676 .option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
21677 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
21678 This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
21679 SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
21680 so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
21684 .option multi_domain smtp boolean true
21685 .vindex "&$domain$&"
21686 When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
21687 addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
21688 to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
21689 handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
21690 &$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
21691 is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
21694 .option port smtp string&!! "see below"
21695 .cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
21696 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
21697 This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
21698 &*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
21699 received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
21700 The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
21701 variable that contains an outgoing port.
21703 If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
21704 otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
21705 normally &"smtp"&, but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"&, the default is
21706 &"lmtp"&. If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
21711 .option protocol smtp string smtp
21712 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
21713 If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
21714 the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
21715 protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
21716 deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
21717 over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
21720 .option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean true
21721 Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
21722 constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
21723 means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
21724 tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
21725 addresses is not affected.
21727 However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
21728 each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
21729 the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
21730 Exim to use only the host name. This should normally be done on a separate
21731 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, set up specially to handle the dialup
21735 .option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
21736 .cindex "serializing connections"
21737 .cindex "host" "serializing connections"
21738 Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
21739 host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
21740 the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
21741 slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
21742 Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
21743 &%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
21745 .cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
21746 Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
21747 written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
21748 is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
21749 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
21750 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
21752 If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
21753 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
21754 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
21755 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
21756 are used for ETRN serialization.
21759 .option size_addition smtp integer 1024
21760 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
21761 .cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
21762 .cindex "size" "of message"
21763 .cindex "transport" "filter"
21764 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
21765 If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
21766 MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
21767 an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
21768 sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
21769 configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
21770 this if a lot of text is added to messages.
21772 Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
21773 the use of the SIZE option altogether.
21776 .option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
21777 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
21778 .cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
21780 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
21781 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
21782 client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
21783 connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
21784 address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
21787 &*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
21788 certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
21789 name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
21790 assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
21794 .option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
21795 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
21796 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
21797 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
21798 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
21801 .option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
21802 .cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
21804 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
21805 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
21806 client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
21807 connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
21808 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
21809 expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
21810 result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
21811 the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
21814 .option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
21815 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
21816 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
21818 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
21819 The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
21820 when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
21821 the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
21822 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
21823 expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
21824 is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
21825 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
21826 ciphers is a preference order.
21830 .option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
21831 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
21832 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
21833 setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
21834 to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
21835 current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
21836 option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
21837 response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
21838 TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
21839 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
21843 .option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! unset
21844 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
21845 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
21847 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
21848 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file containing
21849 permitted server certificates, for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
21850 Alternatively, if you are using OpenSSL, you can set
21851 &%tls_verify_certificates%& to the name of a directory containing certificate
21852 files. This does not work with GnuTLS; the option must be set to the name of a
21853 single file if you are using GnuTLS. The values of &$host$& and
21854 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
21855 expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
21860 .section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
21862 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
21863 .cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
21864 There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
21865 tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
21866 &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
21869 The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
21870 for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
21871 option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
21872 multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
21875 Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
21876 multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
21877 created as a result of routing one of these domains.
21879 Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
21880 several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
21881 problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
21882 &%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
21883 delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
21885 Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
21886 arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
21887 limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
21888 some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
21889 &%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
21890 that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
21891 see below for an exception).
21893 Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
21894 list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
21895 If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
21896 but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
21897 that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
21899 Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
21900 higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
21901 hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
21902 which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
21903 tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
21904 reached their retry times.
21906 However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
21907 large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
21908 Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
21909 of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
21910 time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
21911 without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
21912 all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
21913 there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
21914 the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
21915 every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
21918 The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
21919 particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
21920 out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
21921 reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
21922 been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
21923 take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
21925 The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
21926 Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
21927 and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
21928 possible IP addresses have been tried.
21929 .ecindex IIDsmttra1
21930 .ecindex IIDsmttra2
21936 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21937 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21939 .chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
21940 .scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
21941 There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
21942 addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
21943 (referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
21944 abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
21946 Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
21947 messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
21948 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
21949 appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
21950 locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
21951 unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
21952 lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
21954 One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
21955 when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
21956 such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
21957 do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
21960 .section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
21961 This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
21962 main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
21963 &%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
21965 Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
21966 Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
21967 facility; you do not have to use it.
21969 The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
21970 configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
21971 addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
21972 address to which it applies.
21974 Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
21975 the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
21976 rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
21977 those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
21978 by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
21979 are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
21982 Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
21983 applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
21984 well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
21985 headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
21988 In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
21989 legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
21990 in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
21991 used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
21992 Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
21995 There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
21996 illustrated by these examples:
21999 The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
22000 exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
22001 gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
22002 &'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
22004 A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
22005 &'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
22010 .section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
22011 .cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
22012 .cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
22013 Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
22014 message's processing.
22016 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
22017 At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
22018 by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
22019 ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
22020 is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
22021 rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
22022 rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
22023 RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
22024 rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
22026 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22027 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22028 Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
22029 may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
22030 rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
22031 from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
22032 for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
22033 value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
22034 as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
22035 SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
22037 As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
22038 recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
22039 the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
22040 any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
22041 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
22042 before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
22044 When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
22045 rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
22046 redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
22048 .cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
22049 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
22050 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
22051 At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
22052 specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
22053 This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
22054 section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
22055 header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
22056 applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
22058 The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
22059 transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
22065 .section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
22066 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
22067 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
22068 Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the run time
22069 configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
22070 &%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
22071 2822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
22072 transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
22073 appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
22074 envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
22076 exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
22078 might produce the output
22080 sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
22081 from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
22082 to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
22083 cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
22084 bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
22085 reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
22086 env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
22087 env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
22089 which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
22090 the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
22091 present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
22092 set for a particular transport.
22095 .section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
22096 .cindex "rewriting" "rules"
22097 The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
22100 <&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
22102 Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
22103 transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
22104 takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
22105 any colons must be doubled, of course).
22107 The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
22108 Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
22109 case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
22110 characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
22113 For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
22114 order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
22115 replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
22117 The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
22118 releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
22119 received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
22120 lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
22121 address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
22122 (or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
22123 that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
22125 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22126 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22127 The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
22128 string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
22129 rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
22133 where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
22134 refer to the address that is being rewritten.
22137 .section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
22138 .cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
22139 .cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
22140 The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
22141 address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
22142 single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
22143 against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
22144 you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
22145 facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
22147 Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
22148 case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
22149 can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
22151 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
22152 After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
22153 depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
22154 replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
22155 refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
22156 numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
22157 of pattern they are set as follows:
22160 If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
22161 refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
22162 the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
22165 *queen@*.fict.example
22167 is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
22169 $0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
22173 Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
22174 does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
22177 If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
22178 of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
22179 for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
22180 rewriting rule of the form
22182 &`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
22184 and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
22190 If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
22191 wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
22192 &$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
22193 partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
22194 whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
22198 .section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
22199 .cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
22200 If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
22201 match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
22202 rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
22204 hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
22206 specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
22209 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22210 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22211 If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
22212 yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
22213 &$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
22214 Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
22215 cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
22216 matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
22217 the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
22218 current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
22219 expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
22220 entry written to the panic log.
22224 .section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
22225 There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
22228 Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
22231 A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
22233 Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
22236 For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
22237 E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
22241 .section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
22243 .cindex "rewriting" "flags"
22244 If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
22245 &<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
22246 and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
22247 transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
22248 rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
22250 &`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
22251 &`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
22252 &`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
22253 &`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
22254 &`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
22255 &`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
22256 &`h`& rewrite all headers
22257 &`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
22258 &`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
22259 &`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
22261 "All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
22262 individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
22263 other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
22265 You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
22266 restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
22269 .section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
22270 .cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
22271 .cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
22272 .cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
22273 The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
22274 SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
22275 before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
22276 required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
22277 data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
22279 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22280 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22281 This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
22282 compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
22283 input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
22284 the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
22285 expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
22286 original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
22289 .section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
22290 There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
22291 take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
22292 correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
22295 If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
22296 unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
22297 absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
22299 If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
22300 even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
22301 expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
22302 (does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
22304 The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
22305 address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
22306 rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
22308 .cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
22309 When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
22310 to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
22311 left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
22313 From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
22317 From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
22320 Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
22321 done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
22322 causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
22323 replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
22324 2822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
22325 brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
22326 (except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
22327 is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which defaults to ISO-8859-1.
22329 When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
22330 rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
22334 .section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
22335 Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
22337 *@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
22338 *@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
22339 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
22341 Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
22342 the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
22343 has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
22344 consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
22345 present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
22346 explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
22347 at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
22348 error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
22350 The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
22351 domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
22353 root@*.hitch.fict.example *
22355 were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
22356 local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
22358 Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
22359 &${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
22360 messages that originate outside the local host:
22362 *@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
22363 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
22365 The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
22368 .cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
22369 .cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
22370 Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
22371 an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
22372 the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
22373 remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
22374 sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
22375 components. For example, the rule
22377 \N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
22379 rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
22380 &'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
22381 a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
22382 method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
22383 to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
22384 use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
22385 can be done on the rewritten addresses.
22392 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22393 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22395 .chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
22396 .scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
22397 .scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
22398 The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
22399 retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
22400 be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
22401 empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
22402 errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
22403 general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
22404 line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
22405 address, domain and error.
22407 The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
22408 host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
22409 Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
22410 address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
22411 been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
22412 tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
22413 log selector is set, the message
22414 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
22415 &"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
22416 skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
22417 the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
22419 Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
22420 in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
22421 actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
22422 failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
22423 the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
22424 added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
22425 same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
22426 domain are maintained independently.
22428 When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
22429 receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
22430 always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
22431 behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
22432 quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
22433 suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
22434 subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
22435 the local address is reached.
22437 .section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
22438 If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
22439 whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
22440 files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
22441 always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
22443 The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
22444 rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
22445 record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
22446 timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
22447 and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
22448 messages that it should now be retaining.
22452 .section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
22453 .cindex "retry" "rules"
22454 Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
22455 separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
22456 addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
22457 enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
22458 in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
22459 present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
22460 message's sender, respectively.
22463 The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
22464 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
22465 which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
22466 has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
22467 list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
22468 which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
22471 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
22473 provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
22476 alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
22478 applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
22479 In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
22482 .cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
22483 &*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a routing rule pattern, it
22484 must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
22485 expressions work in address lists.
22487 &`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
22488 &`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
22492 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
22493 When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
22494 example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
22495 against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
22496 router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
22497 regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
22498 A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
22499 &"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
22500 &%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
22502 Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
22503 failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
22504 configuration is tested against the complete address only if
22505 &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
22508 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
22509 However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
22510 suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
22511 whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
22512 rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
22513 failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
22514 recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
22515 reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
22516 &%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
22517 lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
22522 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
22524 For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
22525 example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
22526 twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
22527 &"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
22528 the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
22529 suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
22531 a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
22535 and the retry rules are
22537 p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
22538 a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
22540 and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
22541 first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
22542 rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
22543 to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
22544 tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
22545 first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
22547 In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
22548 first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
22549 &'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
22550 routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
22552 &*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
22553 However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
22554 host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
22556 route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
22558 then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
22559 textual form of the IP address.
22561 .section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
22562 .cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
22563 The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
22564 asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
22567 .vitem &%auth_failed%&
22568 Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
22569 &%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
22571 .vitem &%data_4xx%&
22572 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
22573 after the command, or after sending the message's data.
22575 .vitem &%mail_4xx%&
22576 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
22578 .vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
22579 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
22582 For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
22583 as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
22584 recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
22585 and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
22586 retry rule of this form:
22588 the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
22590 These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
22591 LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
22594 .vitem &%lost_connection%&
22595 A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
22596 legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
22597 for the same host, it indicates something odd.
22599 .vitem &%refused_MX%&
22600 A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
22602 .vitem &%refused_A%&
22603 A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
22606 A connection was refused.
22608 .vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
22609 A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
22611 .vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
22612 A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
22614 .vitem &%timeout_connect%&
22615 A connection attempt timed out.
22617 .vitem &%timeout_MX%&
22618 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
22619 obtained from an MX record.
22621 .vitem &%timeout_A%&
22622 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
22623 obtained from an MX record.
22626 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
22628 .vitem &%tls_required%&
22629 The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
22630 &(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
22631 to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
22634 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
22637 .vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
22638 .cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
22639 .cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
22640 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
22641 transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
22642 &'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
22646 .cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
22647 The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
22648 timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
22649 it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
22650 However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
22654 If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
22655 used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
22656 quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
22658 .cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
22659 For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
22660 subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
22661 the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
22662 change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
22663 MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
22664 time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
22666 For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
22667 obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
22670 The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
22671 mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
22672 when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
22677 .section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
22678 .cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
22679 You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
22680 specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
22681 apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
22684 &`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
22686 The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
22688 * rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
22690 matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
22691 host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
22694 a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
22696 &*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
22697 (which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
22698 only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
22699 its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
22700 all messages, not just those with specific senders.
22702 When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
22703 &%-f%& command line option, like this:
22705 exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
22707 If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
22708 list is never matched.
22714 .section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
22715 .cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
22716 The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
22717 sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
22719 <&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
22721 The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
22722 time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
22723 arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
22724 time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
22725 relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
22727 .cindex "retry" "algorithms"
22728 .cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
22729 .cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
22730 .cindex "retry" "random intervals"
22731 The available algorithms are:
22734 &'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
22737 &'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
22738 specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
22739 is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
22741 &'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
22742 retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
22743 maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
22744 the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
22745 rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
22746 members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
22747 queue processing times.
22750 When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
22751 order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
22752 used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
22753 case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
22754 current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
22755 computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
22756 interval is found. The main configuration variable
22757 .cindex "limit" "retry interval"
22758 .cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
22759 .oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
22760 &%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
22761 cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
22763 A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
22764 host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
22765 basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
22766 for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
22767 generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
22768 time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
22771 .cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
22772 Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
22773 run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
22774 starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
22775 new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
22776 If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
22777 occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
22778 messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
22779 processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
22780 your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
22781 number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
22782 sending everything to a smart host, for example).
22784 The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
22785 &'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
22786 &<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
22787 &'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
22788 are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
22789 deliveries that have been deferred.
22792 .section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
22793 Here are some example retry rules:
22795 alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
22796 wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
22797 wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
22798 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
22799 * refused_A F,2h,20m;
22800 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
22802 The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
22803 &'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
22804 mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
22805 hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
22806 parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
22807 effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
22808 fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
22811 The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
22812 happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
22813 intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
22814 first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
22815 so on (this is a rather extreme example).
22817 The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
22818 They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
22819 all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
22820 were not obtained from an MX record.
22822 The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
22823 first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
22824 not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
22825 hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
22826 1.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
22830 .section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
22831 .cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
22832 .oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
22833 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
22834 .cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
22835 Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
22836 consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
22837 set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
22838 been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
22839 arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
22840 failing for the first time.
22842 This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
22843 backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
22844 Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
22845 down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
22847 If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
22848 every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
22849 message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
22854 .section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
22855 .cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
22856 .cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
22857 Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
22858 that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
22859 default retry rule:
22861 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
22863 the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
22864 long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
22865 failure for the recipient address that counts.
22867 When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
22868 addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
22869 causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
22870 In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
22871 time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
22873 For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
22874 messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
22875 post-cutoff retry time is not used.
22877 If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
22878 .oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
22879 &%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
22880 default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses is
22881 reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
22882 attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
22883 those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
22884 the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
22886 In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
22887 for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
22888 times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
22889 behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
22890 to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
22893 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
22894 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
22895 addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
22896 no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
22897 words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
22898 addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
22899 If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
22900 &%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
22901 deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
22904 .section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
22905 .cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
22906 Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
22907 intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
22908 its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
22909 because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
22910 host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
22911 failing messages remain on the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
22914 Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
22915 applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
22916 Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
22917 examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
22918 commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
22919 time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
22920 is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
22921 time out the address.
22923 The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
22924 the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
22925 given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
22926 time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
22927 not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
22928 considered immediately.
22929 .ecindex IIDretconf1
22930 .ecindex IIDregconf2
22937 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22938 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22940 .chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
22941 .scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
22942 .scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
22943 The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's run time configuration is concerned
22944 with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
22945 described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
22946 to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
22947 permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
22948 transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
22951 .cindex "AUTH" "description of"
22952 Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
22955 The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
22956 the client's EHLO command.
22958 The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
22959 may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
22961 The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
22962 appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
22963 just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
22964 any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
22965 with the AUTH command.
22967 The server either accepts or denies authentication.
22969 If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
22970 option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
22971 mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
22974 If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
22975 authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
22976 unauthenticated connection.
22979 If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
22980 mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
22981 SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
22982 includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
22984 &`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
22985 &`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
22986 &`Connected to server.example.`&
22987 &`Escape character is '^]'.`&
22988 &`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
22989 &*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
22990 &`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
22991 &`250-SIZE 52428800`&
22996 The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
22997 authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
22998 mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
22999 routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
23000 controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
23001 included by setting
23004 AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
23008 in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
23009 authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
23010 the Cyrus SASL authentication library. The third can be configured to support
23011 the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
23012 not formally documented, but used by several MUAs. The fourth authenticator
23013 supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
23015 The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
23016 section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
23017 authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
23018 authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
23019 is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
23020 messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
23021 options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
23023 To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
23024 &%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
23025 either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
23026 functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
23027 to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
23028 both sets of options, is required. For example:
23032 public_name = CRAM-MD5
23033 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
23035 client_secret = secret2
23037 The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
23038 &%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
23040 Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
23041 The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
23042 authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
23047 .section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
23048 .cindex "authentication" "generic options"
23049 .cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
23051 .option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
23052 When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
23053 &%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
23054 used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
23055 encrypted by a setting such as:
23057 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_cipher}{}}
23059 (Older documentation incorrectly states that &$tls_cipher$& contains the cipher
23060 used for incoming messages. In fact, during SMTP delivery, it contains the
23061 cipher used for the delivery.)
23064 .option driver authenticators string unset
23065 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
23066 authenticators is to be used.
23069 .option public_name authenticators string unset
23070 This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
23071 implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
23072 contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
23073 but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
23074 defaults to the driver's instance name.
23077 .option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
23078 When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
23079 is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
23080 mechanism is not advertised.
23081 If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
23082 forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
23083 See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
23086 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
23087 This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
23088 is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
23091 For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
23092 authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
23093 authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
23094 authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
23095 to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
23096 error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
23097 string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
23098 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
23099 other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
23103 .option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
23104 If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
23105 command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
23106 output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
23107 out the values of variables.
23108 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
23109 output, and Exim carries on processing.
23112 .option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
23113 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
23114 When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
23115 expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
23116 messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
23117 lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
23118 configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
23119 refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
23120 If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
23123 .option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
23124 This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
23125 as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
23126 driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
23127 as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
23128 remembered for later use.
23129 How it is used is described in the following section.
23135 .section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
23136 .cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
23137 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
23138 When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
23139 the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
23143 If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
23144 than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
23146 If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
23148 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
23149 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
23150 running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
23151 from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
23152 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
23153 return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
23154 given for the MAIL command.
23156 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
23157 is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
23160 If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
23161 the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
23162 &%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
23163 valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
23164 fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
23165 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
23166 the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
23171 When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
23172 hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
23173 &$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
23174 process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
23176 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
23177 Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
23178 MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
23179 therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
23180 value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
23185 .section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
23186 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
23187 When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
23188 authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
23192 The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
23194 It the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
23195 yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
23198 The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
23199 the mechanisms are advertised.
23201 Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
23202 provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
23203 even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
23204 set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
23205 You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
23206 For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
23207 that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
23209 auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
23211 so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
23213 The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
23214 authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
23215 advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
23218 server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
23220 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
23221 If the session is encrypted, &$tls_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
23222 yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
23224 When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
23225 immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
23226 command. This is the case if
23229 The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
23231 No authenticators are configured with server options; or
23233 Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
23234 server authenticators.
23238 Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
23239 to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
23240 AUTH is accepted from any client host.
23242 If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
23243 server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
23244 that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
23245 the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
23246 fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
23247 rejected with a 504 error.
23249 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
23250 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
23251 When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
23252 &$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
23253 or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
23254 public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
23255 client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
23256 no successful authentication.
23261 .section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
23262 .cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
23263 .cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
23264 .cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
23265 Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
23266 configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
23267 encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
23271 printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
23273 .cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
23274 This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
23275 interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
23276 some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
23277 command line to run this script on such data might be
23279 encode '\0user\0password'
23281 Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
23282 backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
23283 whose code value is zero.
23285 &*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
23286 digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
23287 you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
23288 interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
23290 &*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
23291 specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
23292 example, a command such as
23294 encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
23296 gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
23298 If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to do produce
23299 base64-encoded strings is to run the command
23301 echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
23303 The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
23304 in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
23305 output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
23306 should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
23310 .section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
23311 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
23312 The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
23313 &%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
23314 announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
23315 of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
23318 For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
23319 they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
23320 mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
23321 of the authenticator.
23324 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23325 When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
23326 variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
23327 that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
23328 any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
23329 Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
23330 delivery to be deferred.
23332 If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
23333 Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
23334 try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
23337 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
23338 carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
23339 possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
23340 no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
23341 what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
23342 &%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
23343 delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
23344 turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
23345 deliver the message unauthenticated.
23348 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
23349 When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
23350 parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
23351 the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
23352 is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
23353 incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
23354 allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
23355 to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
23356 &%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
23357 &%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
23358 the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
23359 .ecindex IIDauthconf1
23360 .ecindex IIDauthconf2
23367 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23368 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23370 .chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
23371 .scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
23372 .scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
23373 The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
23374 LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
23375 plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
23376 security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
23377 (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
23378 use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
23379 connections as you do for login accounts.
23381 .section "Plaintext options" "SECID171"
23382 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
23383 When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
23385 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
23386 This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
23387 configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
23389 .option server_prompts plaintext string&!! unset
23390 The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
23391 prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
23394 .section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
23395 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
23396 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
23397 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
23398 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
23399 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
23400 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
23402 When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
23403 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
23404 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
23405 values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
23406 a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
23407 are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
23408 (neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
23410 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
23411 the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
23412 variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
23413 string expansions that also use them for other things.
23415 If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
23416 supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
23417 data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
23419 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
23420 Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
23421 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
23422 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
23423 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
23424 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
23425 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
23426 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
23427 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
23428 string as the error text.
23430 &*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
23431 password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
23432 There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
23436 .section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
23437 .cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
23438 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN mechanism"
23439 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
23440 The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
23441 sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
23442 separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
23443 subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
23445 The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
23446 Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
23447 configured as follows:
23451 public_name = PLAIN
23453 server_condition = \
23454 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
23455 server_set_id = $auth2
23457 Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
23458 are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
23459 password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
23460 or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
23462 The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
23463 the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
23464 AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
23465 authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
23469 and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
23471 AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
23473 As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
23474 data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
23478 to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
23479 prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
23481 The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
23482 when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
23483 represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
23484 is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
23485 second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
23487 Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
23488 realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
23489 authenticating clients it could make sense.
23491 A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
23492 &$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
23493 comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
23494 this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
23495 This is an incorrect example:
23497 server_condition = \
23498 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
23500 The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
23501 which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
23502 incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
23503 non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
23504 strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
23505 the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
23506 name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
23508 server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
23509 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
23511 In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
23512 fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
23513 used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
23514 always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
23515 writing the test makes the logic clearer.
23518 .section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
23519 .cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
23520 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN mechanism"
23521 The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
23522 in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
23523 user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
23524 plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
23528 public_name = LOGIN
23529 server_prompts = User Name : Password
23530 server_condition = \
23531 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
23532 server_set_id = $auth1
23534 Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
23535 with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
23536 if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
23537 strings are used to obtain two data items.
23539 Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
23540 example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
23541 &"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
23542 strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
23543 name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
23547 public_name = LOGIN
23548 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
23549 server_condition = ${if and{{
23551 ldapauth{user="cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
23552 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
23553 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
23554 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
23556 We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
23557 does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
23558 operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
23559 &%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
23560 correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
23561 the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
23562 uninterpreted string.
23566 .section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
23567 A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
23568 interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
23569 traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
23570 Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
23576 .section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
23577 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
23578 The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
23580 .option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
23581 If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
23582 authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
23583 the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
23586 .option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
23587 The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
23588 string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
23589 string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
23590 to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
23591 most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
23592 with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
23593 way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
23594 (with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
23595 so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
23596 &%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
23597 &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
23599 &*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
23600 splitting takes priority and happens first.
23602 Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
23603 the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
23604 there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
23605 NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
23608 This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
23609 authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
23613 public_name = PLAIN
23614 client_send = ^username^mysecret
23616 The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
23617 command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
23618 that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
23622 public_name = LOGIN
23623 client_send = : username : mysecret
23625 The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
23626 the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
23628 .ecindex IIDplaiauth1
23629 .ecindex IIDplaiauth2
23634 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23635 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23637 .chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
23638 .scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
23639 .scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
23640 .cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
23641 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5 mechanism"
23642 The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
23643 sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
23644 name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
23645 string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
23646 is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
23647 secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
23648 available in plain text at either end.
23651 .section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
23652 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
23653 This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
23654 authenticator as a server:
23656 .option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
23657 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
23658 When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
23659 the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
23660 obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
23661 that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
23662 string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
23663 fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
23664 returned to the client.
23666 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
23667 in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
23668 deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
23669 numeric variables for other things.
23671 For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
23672 client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
23673 user name, authentication fails.
23677 public_name = CRAM-MD5
23678 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
23679 server_set_id = $auth1
23681 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
23682 If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
23683 name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
23684 secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
23688 public_name = CRAM-MD5
23689 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
23691 server_set_id = $auth1
23693 Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
23694 because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
23697 .section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
23698 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
23699 When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
23703 .option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
23704 This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
23705 computing the response to the server's challenge.
23708 .option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
23709 This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
23710 expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
23714 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23715 Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
23716 to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
23717 expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
23718 prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
23719 authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
23720 send the message to the current server.
23722 A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
23727 public_name = CRAM-MD5
23729 client_secret = secret
23731 .ecindex IIDcramauth1
23732 .ecindex IIDcramauth2
23736 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23737 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23739 .chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
23740 .scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
23741 .scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
23742 .cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
23744 The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick of A L
23745 Digital Ltd (&url(http://www.aldigital.co.uk)).
23747 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
23748 library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
23749 Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
23750 including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
23751 directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
23753 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
23754 the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
23755 then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
23756 name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
23758 Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example in GSSAPI
23759 or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
23760 user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
23761 by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
23762 depending on the driver you are using.
23764 The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
23765 be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
23766 Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
23767 changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
23768 layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
23769 implementation. For example, for Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
23770 may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
23771 variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
23772 Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
23775 .section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
23776 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
23777 (on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
23778 previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
23779 use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
23780 confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
23784 .option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
23785 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
23786 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
23787 SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
23790 .option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
23791 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
23792 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
23793 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
23797 driver = cyrus_sasl
23798 public_name = X-ANYTHING
23799 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
23800 server_set_id = $auth1
23803 .option server_realm cyrus_sasl string unset
23804 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
23807 .option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
23808 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
23811 For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
23812 private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
23813 the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
23814 PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
23817 driver = cyrus_sasl
23818 public_name = CRAM-MD5
23819 server_set_id = $auth1
23822 driver = cyrus_sasl
23823 public_name = PLAIN
23824 server_set_id = $auth2
23826 Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
23827 not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
23828 but it is present in many binary distributions.
23829 .ecindex IIDcyrauth1
23830 .ecindex IIDcyrauth2
23835 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23836 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23837 .chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
23838 .scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
23839 .scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
23840 This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
23841 Dovecot POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
23842 If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
23843 to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
23844 authenticator only. There is only one option:
23846 .option server_socket dovecot string unset
23848 This option must specify the socket that is the interface to Dovecot
23849 authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
23850 mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
23851 authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
23855 public_name = PLAIN
23856 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
23857 server_set_id = $auth2
23862 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
23863 server_set_id = $auth1
23865 If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
23866 &$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
23867 option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
23868 connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
23869 option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
23870 who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
23871 .ecindex IIDdcotauth1
23872 .ecindex IIDdcotauth2
23875 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23876 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23878 .chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
23879 .scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
23880 .scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
23881 .cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
23882 .cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
23883 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
23884 .cindex "NTLM authentication"
23885 The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
23886 Password Authentication'& mechanism,
23887 which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
23888 this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
23889 taken from the Samba project (&url(http://www.samba.org)). The code for the
23890 server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
23894 After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
23895 authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
23897 The server sends back a challenge.
23899 The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
23900 and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
23903 Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
23907 .section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
23908 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
23909 The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
23911 .option server_password spa string&!! unset
23912 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
23913 This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
23914 authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
23915 compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
23916 &$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
23917 it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
23918 for other things. For example:
23923 server_password = \
23924 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
23926 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
23927 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
23933 .section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
23934 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
23935 The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
23939 .option client_domain spa string&!! unset
23940 This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
23943 .option client_password spa string&!! unset
23944 This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
23947 .option client_username spa string&!! unset
23948 This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
23949 configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
23955 client_username = msn/msn_username
23956 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
23957 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
23959 .ecindex IIDspaauth1
23960 .ecindex IIDspaauth2
23966 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23967 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23969 .chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
23970 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
23971 .scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
23972 .scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
23973 .cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
23976 Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
23977 Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
23978 GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
23979 cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
23980 order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
23981 version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
23982 You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
23983 level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
23984 certificates are used.
23986 RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
23987 connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
23988 server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
23989 mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
23990 between them is encrypted.
23992 Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
23993 and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
23994 certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
23995 possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
23998 &*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
23999 disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
24000 in order to get TLS to work.
24004 .section "Support for the legacy &""ssmtp""& (aka &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
24006 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
24007 .cindex "smtps protocol"
24008 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
24009 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
24010 Early implementations of encrypted SMTP used a different TCP port from normal
24011 SMTP, and expected an encryption negotiation to start immediately, instead of
24012 waiting for a STARTTLS command from the client using the standard SMTP
24013 port. The protocol was called &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, and port 465 was
24014 allocated for this purpose.
24016 This approach was abandoned when encrypted SMTP was standardized, but there are
24017 still some legacy clients that use it. Exim supports these clients by means of
24018 the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& global option. Its value must be a list of port
24019 numbers; the most common use is expected to be:
24021 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
24023 The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
24024 via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
24025 the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
24026 the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
24027 an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
24030 There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
24031 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the legacy behaviour for all ports.
24038 .section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
24039 .cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
24040 The first TLS support in Exim was implemented using OpenSSL. Support for GnuTLS
24041 followed later, when the first versions of GnuTLS were released. To build Exim
24042 to use GnuTLS, you need to set
24046 in Local/Makefile, in addition to
24050 You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
24051 include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
24053 There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
24056 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must contain the name of a file, not the
24057 name of a directory (for OpenSSL it can be either).
24059 The &%tls_dhparam%& option is ignored, because early versions of GnuTLS had no
24060 facility for varying its Diffie-Hellman parameters. I understand that this has
24061 changed, but Exim has not been updated to provide this facility.
24063 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
24064 Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
24065 separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
24066 affects the value of the &$tls_peerdn$& variable.
24068 OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
24069 DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS uses underscores, for example: RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is
24070 more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present in a cipher list. To make
24071 life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens for OpenSSL and hyphens to
24072 underscores for GnuTLS when processing lists of cipher suites in the
24073 &%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
24076 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
24077 sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
24081 .section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECID181"
24082 GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
24083 to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
24084 Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
24085 &_gnutls-params_&. The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
24086 its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
24087 parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
24088 that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
24089 renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
24090 this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
24091 place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
24093 For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
24094 recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
24095 Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
24096 values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
24097 parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
24098 If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
24099 until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
24100 a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
24102 The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
24103 in &_gnutls-params_& in PEM format, which means that they can be generated
24104 externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
24106 To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
24107 and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
24108 &(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
24109 renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
24113 # chown exim:exim new-params
24114 # chmod 0400 new-params
24115 # certtool --generate-privkey --bits 512 >new-params
24116 # echo "" >>new-params
24117 # certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 1024 >> new-params
24118 # mv new-params gnutls-params
24120 If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
24121 stalling is removed.
24124 .section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
24125 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
24126 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
24127 There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
24128 suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
24129 are acceptable. The list is colon separated and may contain names like
24130 DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
24131 directly to this function call. The following quotation from the OpenSSL
24132 documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
24135 It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
24137 It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
24138 or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
24139 ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
24142 Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
24143 the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
24144 SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
24148 Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
24151 If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
24152 ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
24155 If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
24156 of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
24158 If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
24159 option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
24162 If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
24163 a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
24164 includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
24165 not be moved to the end of the list.
24170 .section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
24172 .cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
24173 .cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
24174 .cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
24175 .cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
24176 .cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
24177 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
24178 The GnuTLS library allows the caller to specify separate lists of permitted key
24179 exchange methods, main cipher algorithms, MAC algorithms, and protocols.
24180 Unfortunately, these lists are numerical, and the library does not have a
24181 function for turning names into numbers. Consequently, lists of recognized
24182 names have to be built into the application. The permitted key exchange
24183 methods, ciphers, and MAC algorithms may be used in any combination to form a
24184 cipher suite. This is unlike OpenSSL, where complete cipher suite names are
24185 passed to its control function.
24187 For compatibility with OpenSSL, the &%tls_require_ciphers%& option can be set
24188 to complete cipher suite names such as RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA, but for GnuTLS this
24189 option controls only the cipher algorithms. Exim searches each item in the
24190 list for the name of an available algorithm. For example, if the list
24191 contains RSA_AES_SHA, then AES is recognized, and the behaviour is exactly
24192 the same as if just AES were given.
24194 .oindex "&%gnutls_require_kx%&"
24195 .oindex "&%gnutls_require_mac%&"
24196 .oindex "&%gnutls_require_protocols%&"
24197 There are additional options called &%gnutls_require_kx%&,
24198 &%gnutls_require_mac%&, and &%gnutls_require_protocols%& that can be used to
24199 restrict the key exchange methods, MAC algorithms, and protocols, respectively.
24200 These options are ignored if OpenSSL is in use.
24202 All four options are available as global options, controlling how Exim
24203 behaves as a server, and also as options of the &(smtp)& transport, controlling
24204 how Exim behaves as a client. All the values are string expanded. After
24205 expansion, the values must be colon-separated lists, though the separator
24206 can be changed in the usual way.
24208 Each of the four lists starts out with a default set of algorithms. If the
24209 first item in a list does &'not'& start with an exclamation mark, all the
24210 default items are deleted. In this case, only those that are explicitly
24211 specified can be used. If the first item in a list &'does'& start with an
24212 exclamation mark, the defaults are left on the list.
24214 Then, any item that starts with an exclamation mark causes the relevant
24215 entry to be removed from the list, and any item that does not start with an
24216 exclamation mark causes a new entry to be added to the list. Unrecognized
24217 items in the list are ignored. Thus:
24219 tls_require_ciphers = !ARCFOUR
24221 allows all the defaults except ARCFOUR, whereas
24223 tls_require_ciphers = AES : 3DES
24225 allows only cipher suites that use AES or 3DES.
24227 For &%tls_require_ciphers%& the recognized names are AES_256, AES_128, AES
24228 (both of the preceding), 3DES, ARCFOUR_128, ARCFOUR_40, and ARCFOUR (both of
24229 the preceding). The default list does not contain all of these; it just has
24230 AES_256, AES_128, 3DES, and ARCFOUR_128.
24232 For &%gnutls_require_kx%&, the recognized names are DHE_RSA, RSA (which
24233 includes DHE_RSA), DHE_DSS, and DHE (which includes both DHE_RSA and
24234 DHE_DSS). The default list contains RSA, DHE_DSS, DHE_RSA.
24236 For &%gnutls_require_mac%&, the recognized names are SHA (synonym SHA1), and
24237 MD5. The default list contains SHA, MD5.
24239 For &%gnutls_require_protocols%&, the recognized names are TLS1 and SSL3.
24240 The default list contains TLS1, SSL3.
24242 In a server, the order of items in these lists is unimportant. The server
24243 advertises the availability of all the relevant cipher suites. However, in a
24244 client, the order in the &%tls_require_ciphers%& list specifies a preference
24245 order for the cipher algorithms. The first one in the client's list that is
24246 also advertised by the server is tried first. The default order is as listed
24251 .section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
24252 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
24253 When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
24254 the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
24255 but not to any others. The default value of this option is unset, which means
24256 that STARTTLS is not advertised at all. This default is chosen because you
24257 need to set some other options in order to make TLS available, and also it is
24258 sensible for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
24260 If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
24261 problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
24262 persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
24265 554 Security failure
24267 If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
24268 rejected with a 554 error code.
24270 To enable TLS operations on a server, you must set &%tls_advertise_hosts%& to
24271 match some hosts. You can, of course, set it to * to match all hosts.
24272 However, this is not all you need to do. TLS sessions to a server won't work
24273 without some further configuration at the server end.
24275 It is rumoured that all existing clients that support TLS/SSL use RSA
24276 encryption. To make this work you need to set, in the server,
24278 tls_certificate = /some/file/name
24279 tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
24281 These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
24282 the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
24283 contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
24284 that goes with it. These files need to be readable by the Exim user, and must
24285 always be given as full path names. They can be the same file if both the
24286 certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
24287 set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
24288 is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
24289 certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
24290 the server's certificate.
24292 If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
24293 source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
24294 few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
24296 &*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
24297 they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
24298 Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
24301 With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
24302 require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
24303 this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
24305 tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
24307 is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
24308 with the parameters contained in the file. This increases the set of cipher
24309 suites that the server supports. See the command
24313 for a way of generating this data. At present, &%tls_dhparam%& is used only
24314 when Exim is linked with OpenSSL. It is ignored if GnuTLS is being used.
24316 The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
24317 host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
24318 for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
24319 in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
24320 forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
24322 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
24323 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
24324 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
24325 The variable &$tls_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
24326 an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
24327 incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
24328 also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
24329 &"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
24330 condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
24331 (For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_cipher$& is reset &-- see section
24334 Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
24335 can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
24336 cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
24337 example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
24338 contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
24339 documentation for more details.
24342 .section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
24343 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
24344 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
24345 If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
24346 session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
24347 &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
24348 apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
24349 Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
24350 contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
24351 expected certificates. These must be available in a file or,
24352 for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory, identified by
24353 &%tls_verify_certificates%&.
24355 A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
24358 each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
24359 of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
24360 certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
24362 openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
24364 where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
24366 The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
24367 what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
24368 does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
24369 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
24370 attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
24371 dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
24372 session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
24373 fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
24374 example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
24375 relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
24377 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
24378 When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
24379 the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
24380 &$tls_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
24382 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
24383 Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
24384 &'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
24385 &"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
24386 &%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
24387 certificate is supplied, &$tls_peerdn$& is empty.
24390 .section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
24391 .cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
24392 .cindex "revocation list"
24393 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
24394 Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
24395 certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
24396 server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
24397 an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
24398 of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
24402 .section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECID185"
24403 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
24404 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
24405 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
24406 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
24407 The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
24408 deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
24409 server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
24410 within the &(smtp)& transport.
24412 It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
24413 transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
24414 server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
24415 this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
24416 transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
24418 If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
24419 to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
24420 &%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
24421 those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
24422 set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
24425 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
24426 the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
24427 a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
24428 session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
24429 &%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
24430 delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
24431 it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
24432 STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
24433 negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
24434 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
24437 The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
24438 transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
24439 if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
24440 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client. &*Note*&:
24441 These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
24442 is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
24443 by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
24446 If &%tls_verify_certificates%& is set, it must name a file or,
24447 for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory, that contains a collection of
24448 expected server certificates. The client verifies the server's certificate
24449 against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
24450 in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
24453 &%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
24454 list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
24455 the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
24456 alternative hosts, if any.
24459 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24460 All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
24461 &$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
24462 which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
24463 behave as if the relevant option were unset.
24465 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
24466 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
24467 Before an SMTP connection is established, the &$tls_cipher$& and &$tls_peerdn$&
24468 variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
24469 that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
24470 successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
24471 outgoing connection.
24475 .section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
24477 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
24478 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
24479 Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
24480 an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
24481 one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
24482 of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
24483 connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
24484 to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, Exim shuts down an existing TLS
24485 session before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
24486 try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
24487 if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
24489 The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
24490 after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
24491 just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
24492 reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
24493 successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
24494 SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
24495 should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
24496 subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
24497 and delay other deliveries to that host.
24499 To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
24500 closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
24501 closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
24502 information is recorded.
24504 There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
24505 &(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
24506 connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
24511 .section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
24512 .cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
24513 In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
24514 certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities. This is not the
24515 place to give a tutorial, especially as I do not know very much about it
24516 myself. Some helpful introduction can be found in the FAQ for the SSL addition
24517 to Apache, currently at
24519 &url(http://www.modssl.org/docs/2.7/ssl_faq.html#ToC24)
24521 Other parts of the &'modssl'& documentation are also helpful, and have
24522 links to further files.
24523 Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
24524 0-201-61598-3), contains both introductory and more in-depth descriptions.
24525 Some sample programs taken from the book are available from
24527 &url(http://www.rtfm.com/openssl-examples/)
24531 .section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
24532 The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
24533 certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
24534 sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
24535 not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
24536 First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
24537 certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
24538 intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
24539 certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
24540 The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
24541 validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
24542 root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
24543 install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
24546 .section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
24547 .cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
24548 You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
24549 with OpenSSL, like this:
24551 openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
24554 &_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
24555 delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
24556 specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
24557 important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
24558 that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
24559 prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
24560 this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
24562 A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
24563 may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
24564 encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
24566 However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
24567 user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
24568 certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
24569 must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
24570 authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
24571 signed with that self-signed certificate.
24573 For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
24574 user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
24575 Open-source PKI book, available online at
24576 &url(http://ospkibook.sourceforge.net/).
24577 .ecindex IIDencsmtp1
24578 .ecindex IIDencsmtp2
24582 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24583 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24585 .chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
24586 .scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
24587 .cindex "control of incoming mail"
24588 .cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
24589 .cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
24590 Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the run time
24591 configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
24592 name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
24593 one very small ACL:
24597 accept hosts = one.host.only
24599 You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
24600 which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
24602 The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
24603 certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
24604 when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
24605 option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
24606 in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
24607 local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
24608 a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
24609 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
24612 .section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
24613 The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
24614 configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
24615 The host &'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a service for checking your
24616 relaying configuration (see section &<<SECTcheralcon>>& for more details).
24620 .section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
24621 .cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
24622 In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
24623 options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
24624 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
24625 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
24626 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
24627 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
24628 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
24629 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
24630 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
24631 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
24632 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
24633 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
24634 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
24635 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
24636 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
24637 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
24640 .irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
24641 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
24642 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
24643 .irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
24644 .irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
24645 .irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
24646 .irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
24647 .irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
24648 .irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
24649 .irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
24650 .irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
24651 .irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
24652 .irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
24653 .irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
24654 .irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
24655 .irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
24656 .irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
24657 .irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
24660 For example, if you set
24662 acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
24664 the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
24665 in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
24666 done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
24667 sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
24668 command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
24669 trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
24670 testing as possible at RCPT time.
24673 .section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
24674 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
24675 The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
24676 apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
24677 really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
24678 the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
24679 relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
24680 are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
24681 &$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
24682 &$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
24683 in any of these ACLs.
24685 The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
24686 non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
24687 analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
24688 batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
24689 result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
24690 really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
24691 on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
24692 controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
24694 control = suppress_local_fixups
24696 This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
24697 run, it is too late.
24699 The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
24700 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
24702 The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
24703 kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
24704 temporary error for these kinds of message.
24707 .section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
24708 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
24709 .oindex &%smtp_banner%&
24710 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
24711 session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
24712 an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
24713 accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
24714 the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
24715 &%smtp_banner%& option.
24718 .section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
24719 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
24720 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
24721 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
24722 EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
24723 &%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
24724 Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
24725 session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
24726 setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
24728 If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
24729 modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
24730 at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
24731 affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
24735 .section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
24736 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
24737 Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
24738 command, with two responses being sent to the client.
24739 When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
24740 is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
24741 the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
24742 response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
24743 added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
24744 are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
24746 You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
24747 in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
24748 tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
24749 received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
24750 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
24751 associated with the DATA command.
24753 For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
24754 error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
24755 MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
24756 before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
24757 and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
24761 .section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
24762 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
24763 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
24766 .section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
24767 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
24768 The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
24769 does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
24770 does not in fact control any access. For this reason, the only verbs that are
24771 permitted are &%accept%& and &%warn%&.
24773 This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
24774 session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
24775 messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
24776 more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
24778 &*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
24779 the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
24781 You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
24782 &%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
24785 This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
24786 failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
24787 because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
24788 client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
24789 connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
24793 .section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
24794 .vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
24795 The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
24796 an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is is bad
24797 trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
24798 because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
24799 situation even worse.
24801 Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
24802 logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
24803 modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
24806 .vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
24807 When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
24808 to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
24809 connection. The possible values are:
24811 .irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
24812 .irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
24813 .irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
24814 .irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
24815 .irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
24816 .irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
24817 .irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
24818 .irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
24819 .irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
24820 .irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
24822 In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
24823 Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
24824 With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
24825 overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
24826 &%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
24830 .section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
24831 .cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
24832 The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
24833 you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
24835 acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
24836 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
24838 In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
24839 providing an RFC 4409 message submission service on port 587 and a
24840 non-standard &"smtps"& service on port 465. You can use a string
24841 expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
24842 more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
24844 The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
24845 configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
24846 string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
24849 If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a file name, and reads its
24850 contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
24851 Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
24852 lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
24853 If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
24854 causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
24856 acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
24857 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
24858 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
24860 This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
24861 back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
24862 file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
24863 can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
24865 If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
24866 Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
24867 matches the string.
24869 If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
24870 the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
24871 want to have something like
24873 acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
24875 in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
24876 newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
24882 .section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
24883 .cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
24884 Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
24885 section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
24886 &"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
24887 database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
24888 return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
24889 &"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
24890 This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
24892 For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
24893 &"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
24894 submitters of non-SMTP messages.
24897 ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
24898 has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
24899 individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
24900 blackholing facility. Use it with care.
24902 If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
24903 ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
24904 RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
24905 recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
24906 run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
24907 remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
24908 &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
24911 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
24912 The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
24913 recipients; it may create new recipients.
24917 .section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
24918 .cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
24919 The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
24920 all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
24921 not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
24922 reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
24924 For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
24925 these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
24926 used to accept or reject anything.
24928 For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
24929 &%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
24930 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
24931 when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
24933 For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
24934 &%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
24935 This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
24936 messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
24937 configuration file.
24942 .section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
24943 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
24945 .vindex &$local_part$&
24946 .vindex &$sender_address$&
24947 .vindex &$sender_host_address$&
24948 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
24949 When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
24950 that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
24951 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
24952 statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
24953 &$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
24954 is available in &$smtp_command$&.
24956 When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
24957 contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
24958 set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
24961 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
24962 The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
24963 the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
24964 that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
24965 the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
24968 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
24969 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
24970 The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
24971 The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
24972 accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
24973 of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
24974 &$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
24975 &$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
24981 .section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
24982 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
24983 .vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
24984 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
24985 When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
24986 the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
24987 and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
24988 These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
24989 here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
24990 encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
24991 does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
24992 unencrypted connections.
24995 accept encrypted = *
24996 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
24998 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
25000 (Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
25001 that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
25002 encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
25003 option to do this.)
25007 .section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
25008 .cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
25009 .cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
25010 An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
25011 with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
25012 Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
25013 set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
25015 If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
25016 used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
25017 provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
25020 deny dnslists = list1.example
25021 dnslists = list2.example
25023 If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
25024 the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
25025 happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
25026 all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
25027 test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
25030 .section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
25031 The ACL verbs are as follows:
25034 .cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
25035 &%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
25036 of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
25037 appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
25038 is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
25039 after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
25040 check a RCPT command:
25042 accept domains = +local_domains
25046 If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
25047 passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
25048 the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
25049 fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
25052 The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
25053 use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
25054 that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
25057 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
25058 If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
25059 depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
25060 (when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
25061 statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
25062 SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
25064 &`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
25065 &` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
25067 You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
25068 response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
25069 same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
25071 If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
25072 an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
25073 for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
25078 .cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
25079 &%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
25080 an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
25081 &%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
25082 temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
25083 &(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
25084 be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
25088 .cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
25089 &%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
25090 the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
25093 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
25095 rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
25099 .cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
25100 &%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
25101 &"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
25102 that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
25103 the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
25104 recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
25105 recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
25106 message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
25107 do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
25109 If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
25110 its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
25111 The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
25115 .cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
25116 &%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
25117 forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
25119 drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
25120 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
25122 There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
25123 The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
25126 .cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
25127 &%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
25128 statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
25129 example, when checking a RCPT command,
25131 require message = Sender did not verify
25134 passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
25135 verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
25136 &%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
25137 discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
25140 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
25141 &%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
25142 &%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
25143 to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
25144 written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
25145 message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
25146 duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
25148 If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
25149 and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
25150 &%logwrite%&, and &%add_header%&) that appear before the first failing
25151 condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
25152 &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
25154 If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
25155 some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
25156 This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
25157 is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
25158 conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
25159 is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
25163 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
25164 When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
25165 text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
25166 want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
25168 warn !verify = sender
25169 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
25173 At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
25175 As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
25176 written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
25177 subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
25178 continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
25179 mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
25183 .section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
25184 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
25185 There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
25186 can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
25187 of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
25188 transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
25189 variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
25190 an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
25191 alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
25192 the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
25194 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
25195 throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
25196 while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
25197 on the same SMTP connection.
25199 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
25200 while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
25201 reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
25204 When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
25205 preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
25206 time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
25208 accept hosts = whatever
25209 set acl_m4 = some value
25210 accept authenticated = *
25211 set acl_c_auth = yes
25213 &*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
25214 be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
25215 &%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
25217 .oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
25218 What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
25219 referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
25220 false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
25221 error is generated.
25223 Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
25224 their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
25227 .section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
25228 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
25229 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
25230 An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
25232 deny domains = *.dom.example
25233 !verify = recipient
25235 causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
25236 &'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
25237 negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
25238 two statements are equivalent:
25240 deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
25241 deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
25243 However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
25244 side negation of the whole condition is possible.
25246 The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
25247 of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
25248 condition is true. Consider these two statements:
25250 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
25251 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
25252 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
25253 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
25255 Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
25256 the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
25257 different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
25258 condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
25259 therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
25260 the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
25261 and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
25263 ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
25264 specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
25265 others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
25266 warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
25267 message is handled.
25269 The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement important, because the
25270 processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
25271 modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
25272 consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
25274 require message = Can't verify sender
25276 message = Can't verify recipient
25278 message = This message cannot be used
25280 If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
25281 &"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
25282 so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
25283 recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
25284 verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
25285 because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
25287 For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
25288 modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
25289 happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
25290 the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
25293 !senders = *@my.domain.example
25294 message = Invalid sender from client host
25296 The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
25297 by which time Exim has set up the message.
25301 .section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
25302 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
25303 The ACL modifiers are as follows:
25306 .vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
25307 This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
25308 incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
25309 accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
25311 .vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
25312 .cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
25313 .cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
25314 This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
25315 continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
25316 the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
25317 update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
25318 write rather ugly lines like this:
25320 &`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
25322 Instead, all you need is
25324 &`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
25327 .vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
25328 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
25329 This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
25330 incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
25331 lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
25332 lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
25333 controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
25334 even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
25336 As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
25337 separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
25338 in several different ways. For example:
25340 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
25341 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
25342 . ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
25346 It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
25348 accept ...some conditions
25349 control = queue_only
25351 In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
25352 other words, when the conditions are all true.
25355 It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
25357 accept ...some conditions...
25358 control = queue_only
25359 ...some more conditions...
25361 If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
25362 statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
25363 In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
25367 It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
25368 decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
25371 warn ...some conditions...
25375 This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
25376 &%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
25380 If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
25381 &%require%& verb. For example:
25383 require control = no_multiline_responses
25387 .vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
25388 .cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
25390 This modifier may appear in any ACL. It causes Exim to wait for the time
25391 interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the &%-bh%&
25392 option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is output
25393 instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay happens
25394 as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending output is
25395 flushed before the delay is imposed.
25397 Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
25400 deny ...some conditions...
25403 The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
25404 &"deny"&. Compare this with:
25407 ...some conditions...
25409 which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
25410 can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
25412 warn ...some conditions...
25418 If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
25419 responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
25420 they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
25421 delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
25422 appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
25423 unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
25424 using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
25428 .cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
25429 This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
25430 &%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
25431 failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
25432 failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
25433 confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
25434 &"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
25437 .vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
25438 .cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
25439 This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
25440 ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
25442 require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_cipher
25443 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
25445 &%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
25448 &`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
25449 &` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
25451 When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
25452 that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
25453 recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
25456 The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
25457 the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
25458 denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
25459 available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
25460 variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
25461 &%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
25464 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
25465 If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
25466 verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
25469 If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
25470 the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
25471 more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
25472 actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
25473 of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
25474 is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
25476 If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
25477 example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
25478 the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
25479 logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
25480 both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
25481 logging rejections.
25484 .vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
25485 .cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
25486 .cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
25487 This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
25488 about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
25489 be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
25490 may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
25491 ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
25493 &`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
25494 &` log_reject_target =`&
25496 This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
25497 permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
25501 .vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
25502 .cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
25503 .cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
25504 This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
25505 processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
25506 &%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
25507 access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
25510 &`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
25511 &` control = freeze`&
25512 &` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
25514 By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
25515 with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
25516 another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
25519 logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
25520 logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
25524 .vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
25525 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
25526 This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
25527 message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
25528 or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
25529 there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
25530 &%accept%& for details.)
25532 The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
25533 to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
25534 generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
25535 &%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
25536 the &%hosts%& condition fails:
25538 require message = Host not recognized
25541 (Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
25544 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
25545 .oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
25546 For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
25547 of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
25548 is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
25549 is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
25550 overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
25551 accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
25552 truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
25555 When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
25556 consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
25557 of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
25559 deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
25560 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
25562 The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
25563 by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
25564 access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
25567 Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
25568 the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
25570 The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
25571 literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
25572 anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
25575 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
25576 If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
25577 specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
25578 However, the original message is available in the variable
25579 &$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
25580 wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
25581 routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
25582 use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
25584 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
25585 is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
25586 modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
25587 all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
25588 &%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
25589 &%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
25593 .vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
25594 .cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
25595 This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
25596 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
25603 .section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
25604 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
25605 The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
25608 .vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
25609 This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
25610 has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
25611 apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
25612 HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
25613 really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
25614 not work without it. For example:
25616 warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
25617 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
25619 Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
25620 the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
25621 matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
25622 mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
25623 by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
25626 .vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
25627 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
25628 .cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
25629 .cindex "case of local parts"
25630 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
25631 These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
25632 (that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
25633 are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
25634 any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
25635 for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
25638 These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
25639 local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
25640 in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
25641 handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
25642 configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
25644 This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
25645 containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
25648 warn control = caseful_local_part
25649 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
25651 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
25653 control = caselower_local_part
25655 Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
25656 is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
25658 .vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
25659 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
25660 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
25661 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
25662 These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
25663 is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
25664 state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
25665 in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
25667 The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
25668 connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
25669 messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
25670 &%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
25671 before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
25672 synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
25676 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
25677 .cindex "fake defer"
25678 .cindex "defer, fake"
25679 This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
25680 except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
25681 550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
25682 messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
25683 use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
25685 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
25686 .cindex "fake rejection"
25687 .cindex "rejection, fake"
25688 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
25689 words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
25690 message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
25691 However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
25692 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
25693 the same SMTP connection.
25695 The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
25696 message is supplied, the following is used:
25698 550-Your message has been rejected but is being
25699 550-kept for evaluation.
25700 550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
25701 550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
25703 This facility should be used with extreme caution.
25705 .vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
25706 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
25707 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
25708 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
25709 it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
25710 current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
25713 This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
25714 &%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
25715 is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
25716 are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
25718 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
25719 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
25720 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
25721 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
25722 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
25723 disables such output flushing.
25725 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
25726 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
25727 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
25728 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
25729 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
25730 that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
25732 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
25733 This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
25734 extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
25735 of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
25736 or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
25737 needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
25738 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
25739 the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
25740 to be useful in production.
25742 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
25743 .cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
25744 This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
25745 It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
25746 SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
25748 If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
25749 suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
25750 one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
25751 (&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
25752 responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
25753 sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
25756 Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
25757 sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
25758 verification failed"&) is sent.
25760 If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
25764 The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
25765 calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
25767 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
25768 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
25769 This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
25770 the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
25771 response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
25772 controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
25773 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
25775 .vitem &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
25776 .oindex "&%queue_only%&"
25777 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
25778 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
25779 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
25780 it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
25781 runner. No immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
25782 effect as the &%queue_only%& global option. However, the control applies only
25783 to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the
25784 same SMTP connection.
25786 .vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
25787 .cindex "message" "submission"
25788 .cindex "submission mode"
25789 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
25790 latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
25791 the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
25792 operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
25793 necessary. For example, it add a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
25794 This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
25795 late (the message has already been created).
25797 Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
25798 messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
25799 submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
25800 The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
25801 that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
25803 .vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
25804 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
25805 This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
25806 complement of &`control`& &`=`& &`submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
25807 normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
25810 Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
25811 dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
25813 No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
25815 There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
25818 This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
25819 passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
25820 used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
25821 and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
25824 &*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
25825 that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
25829 .section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
25830 All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
25833 Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
25835 Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use &`control`& &`=`&
25836 &`suppress_local_fixups`&.
25838 Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
25840 Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control`& &`=`& &`submission`&.
25845 .section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
25846 .cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
25847 .cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
25848 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
25849 The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
25850 to an incoming message, as in this example:
25852 warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
25853 dialup.mail-abuse.org
25854 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
25856 The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
25857 MIME, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
25858 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
25859 &%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
25860 any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
25863 If the data for the &%add_header%& modifier contains one or more newlines that
25864 are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
25865 lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
25866 front of any line that is not a valid header line.
25868 Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
25869 They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
25870 However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
25871 is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
25872 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
25873 with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
25874 lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
25875 In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
25876 non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
25877 message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
25878 are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
25880 .cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
25881 Header lines are not visible in string expansions until they are added to the
25882 message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
25883 ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
25884 header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
25885 ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
25886 passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
25887 this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
25888 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
25890 The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately it is encountered during the
25891 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
25893 &`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
25894 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
25896 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
25897 &` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
25899 In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
25900 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
25901 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
25902 ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
25905 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
25906 For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
25907 &%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
25908 effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
25909 them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
25910 usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
25911 are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
25914 By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
25915 header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
25916 be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
25917 after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
25918 that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
25920 This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
25921 &":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
25922 header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
25923 to be a header name first.) For example:
25925 warn add_header = \
25926 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
25928 If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
25929 each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
25930 you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
25931 up in reverse order.
25933 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
25934 added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
25935 system filter or in a router or transport.
25940 .section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
25941 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
25942 Some of conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
25943 compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
25944 for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
25945 content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
25947 Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
25948 senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
25949 result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
25950 done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
25951 can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
25952 same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
25953 The conditions are as follows:
25957 .vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
25958 .cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
25959 .cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
25960 .cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
25961 The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
25962 &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
25963 &"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
25964 false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
25965 condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
25966 condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
25967 ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
25969 If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
25970 the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
25971 &%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
25972 conditions are tested.
25974 ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
25975 loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
25976 circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
25977 for different local users or different local domains.
25979 .vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
25980 .cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
25981 .cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
25982 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
25983 If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
25984 the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
25985 authentication by any authenticator, you can set
25990 .vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
25991 .cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
25992 .cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
25993 .cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
25994 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
25995 This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
25996 expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
25997 &"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
25998 number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
25999 any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
26000 &"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
26001 ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
26004 .vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
26005 .cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
26006 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26007 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
26008 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
26009 If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
26010 problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
26011 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26013 .vitem &*demime&~=&~*&<&'extension&~list'&>
26014 .cindex "&%demime%& ACL condition"
26015 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26016 content-scanning extension. Its use is described in section
26017 &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
26019 .vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
26020 .cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
26021 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
26022 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
26023 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
26024 This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
26025 &"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
26026 use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
26027 different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
26028 &<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
26030 .vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
26031 .cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
26032 .cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
26033 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
26034 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
26035 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
26036 of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
26037 enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
26038 lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
26041 &*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
26042 use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
26045 .vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
26046 .cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
26047 .cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
26048 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
26049 If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
26050 name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
26051 encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
26057 .vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'&~host&~list'&>
26058 .cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
26059 .cindex "host" "ACL checking"
26060 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
26061 This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
26062 name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
26063 you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
26065 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
26067 The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
26068 the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
26069 and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
26071 The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
26072 Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
26073 but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
26074 find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
26075 opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
26076 found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
26078 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
26079 address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
26081 accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
26082 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
26084 The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
26085 is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
26086 statement can then check the IP address.
26088 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
26089 If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
26090 of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
26091 allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
26093 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
26094 message = $host_data
26096 which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
26098 .vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
26099 .cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
26100 .cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
26101 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
26102 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
26103 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
26104 part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
26105 enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
26106 result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
26107 the next &%local_parts%& test.
26109 .vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
26110 .cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
26111 .cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
26112 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
26113 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26114 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
26115 viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26117 .vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
26118 .cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
26119 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
26120 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26121 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
26122 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
26123 with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
26126 .vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
26127 .cindex "rate limiting"
26128 This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
26129 messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
26131 .vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
26132 .cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
26133 .cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
26134 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
26135 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
26136 recipient address against a list of recipients.
26138 .vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
26139 .cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
26140 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
26141 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26142 content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
26143 non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
26144 any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26146 .vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
26147 .cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
26148 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
26149 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
26150 .vindex "&$domain$&"
26151 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
26152 This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
26153 domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
26154 &$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
26155 of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
26156 lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
26157 RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
26158 influence the sender checking.
26160 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
26161 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
26163 .vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
26164 .cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
26165 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
26166 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
26167 This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
26168 for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
26172 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
26173 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
26175 .vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
26176 .cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
26177 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
26178 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26179 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
26180 SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26182 .vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
26183 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26184 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
26185 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
26186 .cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
26187 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
26188 This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
26189 certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
26190 server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
26191 or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
26193 .vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
26194 .cindex "CSA verification"
26195 This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
26196 send email. Details of how this works are given in section
26197 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
26199 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
26200 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26201 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
26202 .cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
26203 .cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
26204 .cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
26205 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
26206 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
26207 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
26208 of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
26209 is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
26210 However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
26211 that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
26212 to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
26213 might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
26215 Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
26216 section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
26217 &<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
26218 condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
26221 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
26222 !verify = header_sender
26225 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
26226 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26227 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
26228 .cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
26229 .cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
26230 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
26231 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
26232 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
26233 lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
26234 and &'Bcc:'&). Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
26235 permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
26236 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
26239 Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
26240 ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
26244 and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
26245 common as they used to be.
26247 .vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
26248 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26249 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
26250 .cindex "HELO" "verifying"
26251 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
26252 .cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
26253 .cindex "verifying" "HELO"
26254 This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
26255 client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
26256 attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
26257 condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
26258 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
26259 independently of this condition.
26261 For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
26262 option), this condition is always true.
26265 .vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind*&
26266 .cindex "verifying" "not blind"
26267 .cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
26268 This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
26269 Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
26270 &'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
26271 case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
26272 &'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
26273 used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
26275 There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
26276 recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
26279 .vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
26280 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26281 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
26282 .cindex "recipient" "verifying"
26283 .cindex "verifying" "recipient"
26284 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
26285 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
26286 recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
26287 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
26288 of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
26289 This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
26290 verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
26291 address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
26292 value for the child address.
26294 .vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup*&
26295 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26296 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
26297 .cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
26298 This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
26299 address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
26300 was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
26301 Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
26302 one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
26303 original IP address.
26305 If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
26306 is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
26308 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
26309 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26310 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
26311 .cindex "sender" "verifying"
26312 .cindex "verifying" "sender"
26313 This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
26314 message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
26315 the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
26316 condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
26318 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
26319 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
26320 If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
26321 value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
26322 value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
26323 statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
26324 want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
26326 Details of verification are given later, starting at section
26327 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
26328 to avoid doing it more than once per message.
26330 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
26331 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26332 This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
26333 verified as a sender.
26338 .section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
26339 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
26340 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
26341 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
26342 In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
26343 is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
26344 address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
26345 domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
26346 special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
26347 address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
26349 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
26350 dialups.mail-abuse.org
26352 the following records are looked up:
26354 43.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
26355 43.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
26357 As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
26358 Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
26359 to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
26360 use two separate conditions:
26362 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
26363 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
26365 If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
26366 behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
26367 record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
26370 This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
26371 (which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
26372 blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
26373 following special items in the list:
26375 &`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
26376 &`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
26377 &`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
26379 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
26380 .cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
26381 .cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
26382 Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
26384 deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
26386 Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
26387 warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
26389 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
26390 warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
26391 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
26393 DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session,
26394 so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
26395 connection. Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
26396 connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
26400 .section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
26401 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
26402 By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
26403 of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
26404 after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
26406 deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
26408 This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
26409 use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
26410 MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
26411 &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
26416 .section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
26417 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
26418 There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
26419 addresses (see for example the &'domain based zones'& link at
26420 &url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
26421 with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
26422 listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
26424 deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
26425 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
26427 This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
26428 RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
26429 example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
26430 up by this example is
26432 tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
26434 A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
26435 addresses. For example:
26437 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
26438 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
26440 The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
26441 name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
26446 .section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
26447 .cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
26448 The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
26449 names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
26450 name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
26451 As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
26452 this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
26453 either to double the separators like this:
26455 dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
26457 or to change the separator character, like this:
26459 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
26461 If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
26462 blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
26463 occurs. Consider this condition:
26465 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
26467 The DNS lookups that occur are:
26469 2.1.168.192.black.list.tld
26470 a.domain.black.list.tld
26472 Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
26473 address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
26474 are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
26475 or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
26476 only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
26477 successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
26478 error for a previous item.
26480 The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
26481 syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
26483 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
26484 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
26486 However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
26487 is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
26489 deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
26490 $sender_address_domain \
26491 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
26493 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
26494 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
26495 $sender_address_domain} }} }
26497 Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
26498 multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
26499 and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
26500 of expanding the condition might be something like this:
26502 dnslists = sbl.spahmaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
26504 Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
26505 domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
26507 The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
26508 &$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
26513 .section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
26514 .cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
26515 DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
26516 just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
26517 RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
26518 The values used on the RBL+ list are:
26522 127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
26524 127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
26525 127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
26526 127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
26528 Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
26529 different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
26530 see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
26533 .section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
26534 .cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
26535 .cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
26536 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
26537 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
26538 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
26539 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
26540 When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
26541 the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
26542 &`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
26543 (for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
26544 the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
26545 &$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
26546 cases, for example:
26548 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
26550 the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
26551 &$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
26552 For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
26553 might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
26555 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
26557 If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
26558 &`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
26560 If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
26561 addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
26562 The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
26563 record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
26564 very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
26567 You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
26568 &-- although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
26569 expanded until after it has failed. For example:
26571 deny hosts = !+local_networks
26572 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
26574 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
26579 .section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
26580 .cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
26581 You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
26582 in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
26585 deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
26587 rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
26588 any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
26589 that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
26590 describes how multiple records are handled.
26592 More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
26593 separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
26594 &%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
26596 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
26598 If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
26599 addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
26600 first. For example:
26602 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
26603 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
26606 If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
26607 listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
26608 In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
26609 true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
26610 tested. For example:
26612 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
26614 matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
26615 want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
26616 being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
26618 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
26620 matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
26625 .section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
26626 You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
26629 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
26631 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
26632 IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
26634 deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
26636 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
26637 IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
26638 words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
26639 the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
26641 &*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
26642 host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
26644 If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
26645 previous example is precisely equivalent to
26647 deny dnslists = a.b.c
26648 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
26650 However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
26651 Consider this example:
26653 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
26655 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
26658 Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
26660 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
26662 deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
26663 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
26664 deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
26666 which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
26671 .section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
26672 A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
26673 thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
26674 is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
26675 the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
26676 the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
26678 dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
26680 What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
26681 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
26682 condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
26683 because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
26684 affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
26685 additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
26688 If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
26689 IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
26690 condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
26692 If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
26693 looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
26696 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
26698 and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
26699 false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
26701 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
26703 for the condition to be true.
26706 When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
26707 the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
26709 If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
26710 addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
26712 dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
26714 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
26715 false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
26717 If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true there is at least one
26718 looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
26720 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
26722 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
26723 true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
26725 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
26727 for the condition to be false.
26729 When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
26730 between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
26735 .section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
26736 .cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
26737 When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
26738 the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
26739 the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
26740 address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
26741 only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
26742 can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
26743 in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
26746 A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
26747 two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
26748 do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
26749 If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
26750 restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
26751 a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
26752 domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
26755 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
26756 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
26758 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
26759 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
26761 For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
26762 &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
26763 match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
26764 value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
26765 record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
26766 The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
26768 If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
26769 given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
26770 the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
26772 reject dnslists = \
26773 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
26774 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
26775 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
26776 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
26778 In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
26779 values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
26780 done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
26784 .section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
26785 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
26786 .cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
26787 If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
26788 nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
26789 3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
26791 1.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
26792 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
26794 (split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
26795 lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
26796 IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
26798 *.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
26800 is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
26801 Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
26803 You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
26804 &%condition%& condition, as in this example:
26806 deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
26807 dnslists = some.list.example
26810 .section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
26811 .cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
26812 .cindex "limiting client sending rates"
26813 .oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
26814 The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
26815 which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
26816 &%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
26817 commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
26818 works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
26819 host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
26821 &`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
26823 If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
26824 period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
26826 As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
26827 &$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
26828 configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
26831 The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
26832 time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
26833 means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
26834 parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
26835 send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
26836 in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
26837 constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
26838 changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
26839 both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
26841 There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
26842 log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
26843 when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
26844 instructions when it is run with no arguments.
26846 The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
26847 sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
26848 retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
26849 which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
26850 By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
26851 of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
26852 user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
26853 &$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
26854 example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
26855 authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
26857 The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
26858 rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
26859 &`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
26862 Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& and the options onto the
26863 lookup key because they alter the meaning of the stored data. This is not true
26864 for the limit &'m'&, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will
26865 still remember clients' past behaviour, but if you alter the other ratelimit
26866 parameters Exim forgets past behaviour.
26868 Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to three options. One option
26869 specifies what Exim measures the rate of, and the second specifies how Exim
26870 handles excessively fast clients. The third option can be &`noupdate`&, to
26871 disable updating of the ratelimiting database (see section &<<rearatdat>>&).
26872 The options are separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may
26873 appear in any order.
26875 .section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
26876 The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate.
26878 The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
26879 the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified.
26881 The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. Note that it is
26882 best to use this option in the DATA ACL; if it is used in an earlier ACL it
26883 relies on the SIZE parameter specified by the client in its MAIL command,
26884 which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can follow the limit &'m'&
26885 in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits in kilobytes,
26886 megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
26888 The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which
26889 recipients are accepted. To be effective, it would need to be used in
26890 either the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& or the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. In the
26891 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& ACL, the number of recipients is incremented by one.
26892 In the case of a locally submitted message in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL,
26893 the number of recipients is incremented by the &%$recipients_count%&
26894 for the entire message. Note that in either case the rate limiting
26895 engine will see a message with many recipients as a large high-speed
26898 The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
26899 condition is processed. This can be used to limit the SMTP command rate.
26900 This command is essentially an alias of &%per_rcpt%& to make it clear
26901 that the effect is to limit the rate at which individual commands,
26902 rather than recipients, are accepted.
26904 .section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratophanfas"
26905 If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
26906 engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
26907 &%strict%& or &%leaky%& options. This is independent of the other
26908 counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
26909 rest of the ACL. The default mode is leaky, which avoids a sender's
26910 over-aggressive retry rate preventing it from getting any email through.
26912 The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
26913 updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
26914 of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
26915 actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
26916 counter-measures by the ACL until it slows down below the maximum rate. If
26917 the client stops attempting to send email for the time specified in the &'p'&
26918 parameter then its computed rate will decay exponentially to 37% of its peak
26919 value. You can work out the time (the number of smoothing periods) that a
26920 client is subjected to counter-measures after an over-limit burst with this
26923 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
26925 The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
26926 updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
26927 client's average rate of successfully sent email, which cannot be greater than
26928 the maximum allowed. If the client is over the limit it may suffer some
26929 counter-measures (as specified in the ACL), but it will still be able to send
26930 email at the configured maximum rate, whatever the rate of its attempts. This
26931 is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
26933 .section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
26934 Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
26935 when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
26936 (for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
26937 policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
26938 message. For example:
26940 # Log all senders' rates
26941 warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
26942 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
26944 # Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
26945 # at the decimal point.
26946 warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
26947 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
26948 $sender_rate_limit }s
26950 # Keep authenticated users under control
26951 deny authenticated = *
26952 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
26954 # System-wide rate limit
26955 defer message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
26956 ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
26958 # Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
26959 # set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
26960 defer message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
26961 messages per $sender_rate_period
26962 ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
26963 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
26964 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
26966 &*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
26967 especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
26968 bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
26969 making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
26970 RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
26971 this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
26972 hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
26975 .section "Reading ratelimit data without updating" "rearatdat"
26976 .cindex "rate limitint" "reading data without updating"
26977 If the &%noupdate%& option is present on a &%ratelimit%& ACL condition, Exim
26978 computes the rate and checks the limit as normal, but it does not update the
26979 saved data. This means that, in relevant ACLs, it is possible to lookup the
26980 existence of a specified (or auto-generated) ratelimit key without incrementing
26981 the ratelimit counter for that key. In order for this to be useful, another ACL
26982 entry must set the rate for the same key (otherwise it will always be zero).
26986 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict / noupdate
26987 log_message = RATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
26988 (max $sender_rate_limit)
26991 &'... some other logic and tests...'&
26995 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict / per_cmd
26996 condition = ${if le{$sender_rate}{$sender_rate_limit}}
26997 logwrite = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
26998 (max $sender_rate_limit)
27000 In this example, the rate is tested and used to deny access (when it is too
27001 high) in the connect ACL, but the actual computation of the remembered rate
27002 happens later, on a per-command basis, in another ACL.
27006 .section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
27007 .cindex "verifying address" "options for"
27008 .cindex "policy control" "address verification"
27009 Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
27010 &<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
27011 &<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
27012 The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
27013 verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
27014 other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
27016 verify = sender/callout
27017 verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
27019 The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
27020 address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
27021 difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
27022 be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
27023 (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
27024 The available options are as follows:
27027 If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
27028 remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
27029 check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
27031 If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
27032 normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
27033 options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
27034 verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
27036 The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
27037 discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
27039 The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
27040 immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
27041 generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
27042 discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
27045 .cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
27046 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
27047 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
27048 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
27049 After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
27050 error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
27053 warn !verify = sender
27054 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
27056 If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
27057 denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
27058 verification failure.
27060 In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
27061 appropriate) contains one of the following words:
27064 &%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
27065 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
27067 &%route%&: Routing failed.
27069 &%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
27070 occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
27071 connection, HELO, or MAIL).
27073 &%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
27075 &%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
27078 The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
27079 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
27084 .section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
27085 .cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
27086 .cindex "callout" "verification"
27087 .cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
27088 For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
27089 checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
27090 the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
27091 &'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
27092 a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
27093 address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
27094 sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
27095 deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
27098 Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
27099 request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
27100 described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
27101 lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
27102 cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
27103 caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
27105 Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
27106 the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
27107 callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
27108 callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
27109 on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
27111 If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
27112 second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
27113 one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
27114 &(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
27115 router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
27116 &%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
27117 &%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
27118 supplies a host list.
27120 The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
27121 remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
27122 specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
27123 specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
27124 specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
27125 the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
27126 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
27128 For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
27129 test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
27130 following SMTP commands are sent:
27132 &`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
27134 &`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
27137 LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
27140 A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
27141 for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
27142 the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
27143 that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
27144 do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
27145 &%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
27147 If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
27148 succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
27149 Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
27150 hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
27151 &%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
27153 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
27154 A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
27155 output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
27156 clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
27157 disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
27162 .section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
27163 .cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
27164 The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
27165 optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
27167 verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
27169 The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
27170 separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
27171 deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
27175 .vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
27176 .cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
27177 This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
27180 verify = sender/callout=5s
27182 The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
27183 remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
27184 the &%connect%& parameter.
27187 .vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
27188 .cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
27189 This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
27190 for making the SMTP connection. For example:
27192 verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
27194 If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
27196 .vitem &*defer_ok*&
27197 .cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
27198 When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
27199 of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
27200 updated in this circumstance.
27202 .vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
27203 .cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
27204 This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
27205 &'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
27206 accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
27207 unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
27210 .vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
27211 .cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
27212 When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
27213 verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
27214 sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
27215 whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
27216 MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
27217 as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
27218 (empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
27219 address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
27221 require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
27223 This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
27226 .vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
27227 .cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
27228 This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
27231 verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
27233 This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
27234 commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
27235 be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
27236 very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
27237 (for example, when network connections are timing out).
27240 .vitem &*no_cache*&
27241 .cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
27242 .cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
27243 When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
27245 .vitem &*postmaster*&
27246 .cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
27247 When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
27248 check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
27249 rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
27250 the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
27251 used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
27252 made, until the cache record expires.
27254 .vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
27255 The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
27256 You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
27259 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
27261 If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
27262 one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
27264 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
27266 &*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
27267 account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
27268 a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
27269 postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
27273 .cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
27274 When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
27275 check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
27276 really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
27277 &%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
27279 $primary_host_name-$tod_epoch-testing
27281 The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
27282 parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
27283 specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
27284 a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
27285 succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
27287 .vitem &*use_postmaster*&
27288 .cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
27289 This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
27291 deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
27293 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
27294 It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
27295 performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
27296 that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
27297 domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
27299 .vitem &*use_sender*&
27300 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
27302 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
27304 It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
27305 command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
27306 need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
27307 sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
27308 usefulness of callout caching.
27311 If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
27312 command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
27313 &%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
27314 usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
27315 that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
27316 Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
27317 these circumstances.
27319 However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
27320 host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
27321 callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
27322 sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
27323 callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
27324 own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
27325 is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
27327 Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
27328 caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
27329 by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
27330 actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
27335 .section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
27336 .cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
27337 .cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
27338 .cindex "caching" "callout"
27339 Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
27340 used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
27341 option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
27342 different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
27343 a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
27344 entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
27346 When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
27347 the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
27350 The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
27351 independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
27352 (default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
27354 If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
27355 commands up to and including
27359 (but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
27360 any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
27361 domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
27362 making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
27363 separate expiry times for domain cache records:
27364 &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
27365 &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
27367 Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
27368 cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
27369 Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
27370 ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
27371 will eventually be noticed.
27373 The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
27374 being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
27375 behaviour will be the same.
27379 .section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
27380 .cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
27381 See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
27382 verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
27383 failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
27384 relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
27387 MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
27389 RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
27390 550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
27391 550-Called: 192.168.34.43
27392 550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
27393 550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
27394 550 Sender verification failed
27396 If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
27397 only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
27398 out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
27399 &`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
27402 verify = sender/no_details
27405 .section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
27406 .cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
27407 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
27408 A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
27409 during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
27410 or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
27411 it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
27414 When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
27415 continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
27416 verification also fails.
27418 When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
27419 verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
27422 This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
27423 way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
27424 example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
27427 aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
27429 work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
27430 redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
27431 mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
27432 verification to succeed.
27434 It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
27435 redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
27436 generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
27437 option. For example:
27439 require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
27441 In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
27442 the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
27444 When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
27445 redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
27446 also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
27447 address and a report is output for each of them.
27451 .section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
27452 .cindex "CSA" "verifying"
27453 Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
27454 which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
27455 special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
27456 domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
27457 Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
27461 This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
27462 valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
27463 succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
27464 &$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
27465 &"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
27466 be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
27468 The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
27469 detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
27470 looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
27471 address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
27474 The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
27476 The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
27478 The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
27479 (for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
27481 The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
27482 that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
27485 The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
27486 use for the DNS query. The default is:
27488 verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
27490 This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
27491 is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
27492 address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
27493 the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
27496 verify = csa/$sender_host_address
27498 In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
27499 This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
27500 &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
27502 If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
27503 is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
27504 making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
27505 using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
27506 default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
27507 default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
27508 (&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
27509 of legitimate HELO domains.
27511 The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
27512 direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
27513 search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
27514 addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
27517 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
27519 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
27520 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
27521 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
27526 .section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
27527 .cindex "BATV, verifying"
27528 Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
27529 of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
27530 Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
27531 recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
27532 bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
27533 spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
27535 There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
27536 &"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
27537 the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
27538 address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
27539 item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
27540 The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
27541 &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
27543 As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
27544 database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
27547 PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
27548 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
27551 Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
27552 list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
27555 # Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
27556 deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
27558 recipients = +batv_senders
27560 # Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
27561 deny message = Invalid reverse path signature.
27563 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
27564 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
27565 !condition = $prvscheck_result
27567 The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
27568 to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
27569 send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
27570 recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
27571 the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
27573 A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
27574 &%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
27575 prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
27576 the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
27577 the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
27578 timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
27579 of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
27581 There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
27582 you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
27583 deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
27584 router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
27588 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
27590 This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
27591 of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
27592 address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
27595 To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
27598 external_smtp_batv:
27600 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
27601 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
27602 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
27603 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
27606 If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
27610 .section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
27611 .cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
27612 .cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
27613 .cindex "policy control" "relay control"
27614 An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
27615 delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
27616 within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
27617 passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
27618 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
27619 but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
27621 Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
27622 A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
27623 relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
27624 a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
27625 with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
27626 same host is fulfilling both functions,
27628 . as illustrated in the diagram below,
27630 but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
27631 not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
27632 system to arbitrary domains.
27635 You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
27636 runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
27637 Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
27638 example, suppose you want to do the following:
27641 Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
27642 locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
27643 &'my.dom2.example'&.
27645 Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
27646 These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
27648 Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
27649 Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
27653 In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
27655 domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
27656 domainlist relay_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
27657 hostlist relay_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
27659 Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
27663 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_domains
27664 accept hosts = +relay_hosts
27666 The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
27667 the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
27668 statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
27669 hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
27670 than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
27671 default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
27672 in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
27676 .section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
27677 .cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
27678 You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
27679 that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
27680 the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
27682 For specifically testing for unwanted relaying, the host
27683 &'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a useful service. If you telnet to this
27684 host from the host on which Exim is running, using the normal telnet port, you
27685 will see a normal telnet connection message and then quite a long delay. Be
27686 patient. The remote host is making an SMTP connection back to your host, and
27687 trying a number of common probes to test for open relay vulnerability. The
27688 results of the tests will eventually appear on your terminal.
27693 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27694 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27696 .chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
27697 .scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
27698 The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
27699 as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
27700 was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
27701 maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
27704 It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
27705 &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
27706 scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
27707 messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
27708 chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
27710 If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
27711 Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
27712 &_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
27715 Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
27716 for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
27718 Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
27719 &%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
27720 run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
27722 An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
27723 of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
27725 Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
27728 Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
27731 There is another content-scanning configuration option for &_Local/Makefile_&,
27732 called WITH_OLD_DEMIME. If this is set, the old, deprecated &%demime%& ACL
27733 condition is compiled, in addition to all the other content-scanning features.
27735 Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
27736 added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
27737 changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
27738 EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
27739 this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
27740 &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
27742 All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
27743 temporarily created in a file called:
27745 <&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
27747 The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
27748 expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
27749 first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
27750 scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
27751 removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
27753 control = no_mbox_unspool
27755 has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
27756 same directory by default.
27760 .section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
27761 .cindex "virus scanning"
27762 .cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
27763 .cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
27764 The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
27765 It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
27766 specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
27767 in memory and thus are much faster.
27769 .oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
27770 You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in first part of the Exim configuration
27771 file to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
27772 are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
27774 &`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
27776 If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
27778 av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
27780 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with dollar character, it is expanded
27781 before use. The following scanner types are supported in this release:
27784 .vitem &%aveserver%&
27785 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
27786 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
27787 at &url(http://www.kaspersky.com). This scanner type takes one option,
27788 which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
27791 av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
27795 .cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
27796 This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
27797 &url(http://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
27798 unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
27799 in the MIME ACL. This no longer believed to be necessary. One option is
27800 required: either the path and name of a UNIX socket file, or a hostname or IP
27801 number, and a port, separated by space, as in the second of these examples:
27803 av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
27804 av_scanner = clamd:192.168.2.100 1234
27806 If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
27807 contributing the code for this scanner.
27810 .cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
27811 This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
27812 used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
27813 type takes 3 mandatory options:
27816 The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
27817 and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
27820 A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
27821 virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
27822 absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
27823 the &"trigger"& expression.
27826 Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
27827 match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
27828 &"name"& expression.
27831 For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
27833 Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
27835 For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
27836 name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
27837 for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
27838 configuration setting:
27840 av_scanner = cmdline:\
27841 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
27842 found in file:'(.+)'
27845 .cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
27846 The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(http://www.sald.com/)) interface takes one
27847 argument, either a full path to a UNIX socket, or an IP address and port
27848 separated by white space, as in these examples:
27850 av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
27851 av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
27853 If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
27854 is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
27857 .cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
27858 The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(http://www.f-secure.com)) takes one
27859 argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
27861 av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
27863 If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
27864 Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
27866 .vitem &%kavdaemon%&
27867 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
27868 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
27869 Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
27870 scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
27873 av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
27875 The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
27878 .cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
27879 This is a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users, though some
27880 parts of documentation are now available in English. You can get it at
27881 &url(http://linux.mks.com.pl/). The only option for this scanner type is
27882 the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
27883 provided that the demime facility is employed and also provided that mksd has
27884 been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
27886 av_scanner = mksd:2
27888 You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
27891 .cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
27892 Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
27893 You can get Sophie at &url(http://www.clanfield.info/sophie/). The only option
27894 for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
27895 client communication. For example:
27897 av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
27899 The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
27903 When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
27904 the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
27907 The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
27908 makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
27909 The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
27910 for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
27911 However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
27912 which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
27915 The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
27916 use. It can then be one of
27919 &"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
27920 The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
27923 &"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
27924 the condition fails immediately.
27926 A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
27927 condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
27928 expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
27931 You can append &`/defer_ok`& to the &%malware%& condition to accept messages
27932 even if there is a problem with the virus scanner. Otherwise, such a problem
27933 causes the ACL to defer.
27935 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
27936 When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
27937 &$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
27938 &%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
27941 If your virus scanner cannot unpack MIME and TNEF containers itself, you should
27942 use the &%demime%& condition (see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&) before the
27943 &%malware%& condition.
27945 Here is a very simple scanning example:
27947 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
27951 The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
27953 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
27955 malware = */defer_ok
27957 The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
27958 aveserver. It assumes you have set:
27960 av_scanner = $acl_m0
27962 in the main Exim configuration.
27964 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
27965 set acl_m0 = sophie
27968 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
27969 set acl_m0 = aveserver
27974 .section "Scanning with SpamAssassin" "SECTscanspamass"
27975 .cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
27976 .cindex "spam scanning"
27977 .cindex "SpamAssassin"
27978 The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
27979 score and a report for the message. You can get SpamAssassin at
27980 &url(http://www.spamassassin.org), or, if you have a working Perl
27981 installation, you can use CPAN by running:
27983 perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
27985 SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
27986 documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
27989 .oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
27990 After having installed and configured SpamAssassin, start the &%spamd%& daemon.
27991 By default, it listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783. If you use another host or
27992 port for &%spamd%&, you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global
27993 part of the Exim configuration as follows (example):
27995 spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 387
27997 You do not need to set this option if you use the default. As of version 2.60,
27998 &%spamd%& also supports communication over UNIX sockets. If you want to use
27999 these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute file name instead of a
28002 spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
28004 You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
28005 reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
28006 &%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
28007 option, separated with colons:
28009 spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
28010 192.168.2.11 783 : \
28013 Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported. The servers are queried in a random
28014 fashion. When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
28015 servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
28018 &*Warning*&: It is not possible to use the UNIX socket connection method with
28019 multiple &%spamd%& servers.
28021 The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
28022 a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
28023 used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
28026 .section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
28027 Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
28029 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
28032 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
28033 relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
28034 to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
28035 default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
28036 However, you must put something on the right-hand side.
28038 The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
28039 principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
28040 have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
28041 &%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA ACL in order to be able to
28042 read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
28045 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
28046 you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
28047 &"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
28050 Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
28051 large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
28052 are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
28055 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
28056 condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
28060 The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
28061 SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
28062 &%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
28063 it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
28065 .cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
28066 When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
28067 variables. With the exception of &$spam_score_int$&, these are usable only
28068 within ACLs; their values are not retained with the message and so cannot be
28069 used at delivery time.
28072 .vitem &$spam_score$&
28073 The spam score of the message, for example &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
28074 for inclusion in log or reject messages.
28076 .vitem &$spam_score_int$&
28077 The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
28078 example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
28079 because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
28080 The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in
28081 conditions. This variable is special; its value is saved with the message, and
28082 written to Exim's spool file. This means that it can be used during the whole
28083 life of the message on your Exim system, in particular, in routers or
28084 transports during the later delivery phase.
28086 .vitem &$spam_bar$&
28087 A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
28088 integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
28089 &$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
28090 headers, since MUAs can match on such strings.
28092 .vitem &$spam_report$&
28093 A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
28094 message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
28097 The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
28098 spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
28099 does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
28101 The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
28102 the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
28103 failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
28104 statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
28105 spam condition, like this:
28107 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
28108 spam = joe/defer_ok
28110 This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
28112 Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
28115 # put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
28116 warn spam = nobody:true
28117 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
28118 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
28120 # add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
28121 # is over threshold
28123 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
28125 # reject spam at high scores (> 12)
28126 deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
28128 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
28133 .section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
28134 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
28135 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
28136 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
28137 .oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
28138 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
28139 each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
28140 of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
28141 specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
28142 options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
28145 These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
28146 ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
28147 the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
28148 message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
28149 ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
28150 result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
28151 &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
28153 You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
28154 only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
28155 condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
28156 &%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
28157 &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
28159 At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
28160 information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
28161 of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
28162 parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
28163 part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
28166 &`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
28168 The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
28172 &"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
28174 The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
28175 &"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
28176 a sequential file name consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
28177 full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
28179 A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
28180 directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
28181 is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
28182 the full path and file name.
28184 If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
28185 filename, and the default path is then used.
28187 The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
28188 errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
28189 a file with its original, proposed filename using
28191 decode = $mime_filename
28193 However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
28194 anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
28195 automatically unlinked.
28197 For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
28198 content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
28199 as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
28200 variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
28201 before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
28203 The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
28204 used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
28205 respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
28207 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
28208 The following list describes all expansion variables that are
28209 available in the MIME ACL:
28212 .vitem &$mime_boundary$&
28213 If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$&) below, it should
28214 have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
28215 has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
28216 contains the empty string.
28218 .vitem &$mime_charset$&
28219 This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
28220 &'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
28226 Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
28227 case-insensitively.
28229 .vitem &$mime_content_description$&
28230 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
28231 header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
28232 implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
28233 only used for display purposes.
28235 .vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
28236 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
28237 header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
28239 .vitem &$mime_content_id$&
28240 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
28241 This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
28243 .vitem &$mime_content_size$&
28244 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
28245 successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
28246 size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
28247 has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
28249 .vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
28250 This variable contains the normalized content of the
28251 &'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
28252 type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
28254 .vitem &$mime_content_type$&
28255 If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
28256 value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
28257 are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
28261 application/octet-stream
28265 If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
28268 .vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
28269 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
28270 successfully run. It contains the full path and file name of the file
28271 containing the decoded data.
28276 .vitem &$mime_filename$&
28277 This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
28278 proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
28279 &'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
28280 RFC2047 decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done. If no filename was
28281 found, this variable contains the empty string.
28283 .vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
28284 This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
28285 attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
28286 content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
28288 The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
28289 cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
28293 The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
28296 If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
28297 so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
28300 If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
28301 and the rest are attachments.
28304 All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
28307 As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
28308 alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
28309 coverletter mail attached to non-HMTL coverletter mail will also be allowed:
28311 deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
28312 !condition = $mime_is_rfc822
28313 condition = $mime_is_coverletter
28314 condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
28316 .vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
28317 This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
28318 &"multipart"&, for example &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
28319 Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
28320 want to carry out specific actions on them.
28322 .vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
28323 This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
28324 checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
28325 decoding is fully recursive.
28327 .vitem &$mime_part_count$&
28328 This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
28329 starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
28330 counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
28331 &$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
28332 complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
28333 parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
28338 .section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
28339 .cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
28340 .cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
28341 You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
28342 the message, or on individual MIME parts.
28344 The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
28345 matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
28346 MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
28347 linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
28348 have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
28350 The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
28351 to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
28352 part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
28353 is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
28354 and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
28355 32K characters are checked.
28357 The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
28358 literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
28359 expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
28360 with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
28361 Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
28363 deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
28364 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
28366 The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
28367 &$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
28368 matching regular expression.
28370 &*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
28376 .section "The demime condition" "SECTdemimecond"
28377 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME checking"
28378 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
28379 The &%demime%& ACL condition provides MIME unpacking, sanity checking and file
28380 extension blocking. It is usable only in the DATA and non-SMTP ACLs. The
28381 &%demime%& condition uses a simpler interface to MIME decoding than the MIME
28382 ACL functionality, but provides no additional facilities. Please note that this
28383 condition is deprecated and kept only for backward compatibility. You must set
28384 the WITH_OLD_DEMIME option in &_Local/Makefile_& at build time to be able to
28385 use the &%demime%& condition.
28387 The &%demime%& condition unpacks MIME containers in the message. It detects
28388 errors in MIME containers and can match file extensions found in the message
28389 against a list. Using this facility produces files containing the unpacked MIME
28390 parts of the message in the temporary scan directory. If you do antivirus
28391 scanning, it is recommended that you use the &%demime%& condition before the
28392 antivirus (&%malware%&) condition.
28394 On the right-hand side of the &%demime%& condition you can pass a
28395 colon-separated list of file extensions that it should match against. For
28398 deny message = Found blacklisted file attachment
28399 demime = vbs:com:bat:pif:prf:lnk
28401 If one of the file extensions is found, the condition is true, otherwise it is
28402 false. If there is a temporary error while demimeing (for example, &"disk
28403 full"&), the condition defers, and the message is temporarily rejected (unless
28404 the condition is on a &%warn%& verb).
28406 The right-hand side is expanded before being treated as a list, so you can have
28407 conditions and lookups there. If it expands to an empty string, &"false"&, or
28408 zero (&"0"&), no demimeing is done and the condition is false.
28410 The &%demime%& condition set the following variables:
28413 .vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
28414 .vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
28415 When an error is detected in a MIME container, this variable contains the
28416 severity of the error, as an integer number. The higher the value, the more
28417 severe the error (the current maximum value is 3). If this variable is unset or
28418 zero, no error occurred.
28420 .vitem &$demime_reason$&
28421 .vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
28422 When &$demime_errorlevel$& is greater than zero, this variable contains a
28423 human-readable text string describing the MIME error that occurred.
28427 .vitem &$found_extension$&
28428 .vindex "&$found_extension$&"
28429 When the &%demime%& condition is true, this variable contains the file
28430 extension it found.
28433 Both &$demime_errorlevel$& and &$demime_reason$& are set by the first call of
28434 the &%demime%& condition, and are not changed on subsequent calls.
28436 If you do not want to check for file extensions, but rather use the &%demime%&
28437 condition for unpacking or error checking purposes, pass &"*"& as the
28438 right-hand side value. Here is a more elaborate example of how to use this
28441 # Reject messages with serious MIME container errors
28442 deny message = Found MIME error ($demime_reason).
28444 condition = ${if >{$demime_errorlevel}{2}{1}{0}}
28446 # Reject known virus spreading file extensions.
28447 # Accepting these is pretty much braindead.
28448 deny message = contains $found_extension file (blacklisted).
28449 demime = com:vbs:bat:pif:scr
28451 # Freeze .exe and .doc files. Postmaster can
28452 # examine them and eventually thaw them.
28453 deny log_message = Another $found_extension file.
28462 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28463 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28465 .chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
28466 "Local scan function"
28467 .scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
28468 .cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
28469 .cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
28470 In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
28471 want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
28473 The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
28474 passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
28475 a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
28476 condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
28477 non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
28479 To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
28480 possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
28481 in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
28482 can of course use a little C stub to call it.
28484 The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
28485 when Exim is just about to accept the message.
28486 It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
28487 well as messages arriving via SMTP.
28489 Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
28490 option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
28491 Zero means &"no timeout"&.
28492 Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
28493 before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
28494 are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
28495 incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
28496 For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
28497 code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
28501 .section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
28502 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
28503 To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
28504 function is before building Exim, by setting LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
28505 &_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
28506 directory, so you might set
28508 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
28510 for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&. It is called by
28511 Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
28512 be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
28513 function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
28514 commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
28515 _src/local_scan.c_.
28517 If you want to make use of Exim's run time configuration file to set options
28518 for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
28520 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
28522 in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
28527 .section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
28528 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
28529 You must include this line near the start of your code:
28531 #include "local_scan.h"
28533 This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
28534 prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
28535 almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
28536 for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
28537 It also contains the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
28538 strings and pointers to character strings:
28540 #define CS (char *)
28541 #define CCS (const char *)
28542 #define CSS (char **)
28543 #define US (unsigned char *)
28544 #define CUS (const unsigned char *)
28545 #define USS (unsigned char **)
28547 The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
28549 extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
28551 The arguments are as follows:
28554 &%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
28555 (the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
28556 recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
28558 The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
28559 character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
28560 id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
28561 macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
28562 case this changes in some future version.
28564 &%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
28565 string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
28568 The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
28571 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
28572 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
28573 The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
28574 the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
28575 newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
28576 maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
28578 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
28579 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
28580 queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
28582 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
28583 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
28584 queued without immediate delivery.
28586 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
28587 The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
28588 passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
28589 they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
28590 &`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
28593 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
28594 The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
28595 message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
28598 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
28599 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
28600 message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
28601 &%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
28602 &%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
28603 &%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
28604 same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
28606 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
28607 This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
28608 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
28611 If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
28612 reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
28613 &%-oe%& command line options.
28617 .section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
28618 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
28619 It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
28620 that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
28621 want to do this, you must have the line
28623 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
28625 in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
28626 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
28627 file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
28630 The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
28631 &`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
28632 and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
28633 alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
28634 variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
28635 entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
28637 static int my_integer_option = 42;
28638 static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
28640 optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
28641 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
28642 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
28645 int local_scan_options_count =
28646 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
28648 The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
28649 configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
28653 my_string = some string of text...
28655 The available types of option data are as follows:
28658 .vitem &*opt_bool*&
28659 This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
28660 variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
28661 that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
28662 whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
28663 TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
28666 .vitem &*opt_fixed*&
28667 This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
28668 The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
28669 multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
28672 This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
28673 &`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
28676 .vitem &*opt_mkint*&
28677 This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
28678 &%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
28679 printed with the suffix K or M.
28681 .vitem &*opt_octint*&
28682 This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
28683 octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
28684 always output in octal.
28686 .vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
28687 This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
28688 variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
28690 .vitem &*opt_time*&
28691 This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
28692 type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
28695 If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
28696 out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
28700 .section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
28701 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
28702 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
28703 are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
28704 Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
28705 including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
28706 C variables are as follows:
28709 .vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
28710 This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
28712 .vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
28713 This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
28715 .vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
28716 This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
28717 is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
28718 &[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
28721 The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
28722 testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
28723 other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
28726 The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
28727 by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
28731 Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
28732 selected, you should use code like this:
28734 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
28735 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
28737 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
28738 After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
28739 variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
28741 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
28742 A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
28745 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
28746 A pointer to the last of the header lines.
28748 .vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
28749 The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
28751 .vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
28752 This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
28753 &%-bh%& command line option.
28755 .vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
28756 The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
28757 is NULL for locally submitted messages.
28759 .vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
28760 The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
28761 command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
28762 specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
28764 .vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
28765 This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
28766 &$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
28768 .vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
28769 The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
28771 .vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
28772 The number of accepted recipients.
28774 .vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
28775 .cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
28776 .cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
28777 The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
28778 &%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
28779 can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
28780 below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
28781 adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
28782 &%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
28783 value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
28784 blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
28785 and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
28787 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
28788 The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
28790 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
28791 The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
28792 locally-submitted messages.
28794 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
28795 The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
28796 was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
28798 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
28799 The name of the sending host, if known.
28801 .vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
28802 The port on the sending host.
28804 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
28805 This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
28807 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
28808 This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
28810 .vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
28811 The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
28812 requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
28816 .section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
28817 The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
28818 You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
28819 (see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
28824 .vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
28825 A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
28827 .vitem &*int&~type*&
28828 A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
28829 characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
28830 Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
28831 with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
28832 rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
28833 lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
28835 .vitem &*int&~slen*&
28836 The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
28839 .vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
28840 A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
28841 a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
28846 .section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
28847 The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
28850 .vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
28851 This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
28853 .vitem &*int&~pno*&
28854 This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
28855 the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
28856 and must always contain -1 at this stage.
28858 .vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
28859 If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
28860 recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
28861 envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
28862 router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
28863 an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
28864 &%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
28865 is NULL for all recipients.
28870 .section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
28871 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
28872 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
28873 These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
28877 .vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
28878 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
28880 This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
28881 &%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
28882 be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
28883 for the process in &%newumask%&.
28885 Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
28886 and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
28887 standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
28888 descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
28889 argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
28891 The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
28893 .vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
28894 This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
28895 seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
28896 return value is as follows:
28901 The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
28907 The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
28913 The process timed out.
28917 The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
28920 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
28921 This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
28922 Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
28923 want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
28924 forks a subprocess that is running
28926 exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
28928 and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
28929 that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
28930 of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
28931 recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
28933 When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
28934 finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
28935 fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
28936 addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
28939 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
28940 *sender_authentication)*&
28941 This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
28944 &`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
28946 The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
28949 .vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
28950 This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
28951 output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
28952 calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
28953 conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
28955 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
28956 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
28959 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
28960 This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
28961 expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
28962 The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
28963 expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
28964 the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
28965 block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
28966 &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
28968 .vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
28969 This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
28970 existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
28971 character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
28972 substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
28973 if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
28975 .vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
28976 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
28977 This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
28978 chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
28980 If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
28981 &%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
28982 NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
28983 matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
28984 &%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
28985 found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
28986 marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
28987 option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
28988 top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
28989 headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
28991 header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
28992 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
28994 Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
28995 there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
28998 .vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
28999 This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
29000 occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
29001 particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
29002 match the specification, the function does nothing.
29005 .vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
29006 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
29007 This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
29008 a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
29009 colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
29010 &"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
29012 if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
29014 .vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
29015 .cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
29016 This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
29017 The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
29018 back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
29021 .vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
29022 This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
29023 zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
29024 to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
29025 string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
29026 yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
29027 easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
29028 added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
29030 .vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
29031 This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
29032 matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
29034 &`OK `& match succeeded
29035 &`FAIL `& match failed
29036 &`DEFER `& match deferred
29038 DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
29039 inability to contact a database.
29041 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
29043 This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
29044 controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
29045 &'lss_match_domain()'&.
29047 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
29049 This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
29050 controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
29051 matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
29053 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
29055 This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
29058 lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
29060 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
29061 An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
29062 is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
29063 looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
29064 values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
29065 returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
29068 .vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
29070 This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
29071 is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
29072 &`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
29073 them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
29074 arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
29075 contain any newlines, not even at the end.
29078 .vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
29079 This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
29080 is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
29081 with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
29083 This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
29084 described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
29085 the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
29086 value afterwards. For example:
29088 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
29089 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
29090 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
29093 .vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
29094 This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
29095 recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
29096 matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
29103 .vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
29104 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
29105 This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
29106 these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
29107 from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
29108 a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
29109 made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
29110 binary string is returned with an error message.
29112 The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
29113 maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
29114 encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
29116 .cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
29117 .cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
29118 If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
29119 contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
29120 not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
29122 The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
29123 &%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
29124 which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
29126 If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
29127 argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
29128 set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
29129 returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
29133 .vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
29134 This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
29137 .vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
29138 The arguments of this function are like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
29139 output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
29140 stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
29141 SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
29142 is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
29143 opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
29144 test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
29147 If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
29148 output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
29150 Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
29151 must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
29152 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
29153 LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
29154 initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
29155 to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
29156 that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
29158 smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
29159 return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
29161 Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
29162 the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
29163 &'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
29164 multiple output lines.
29166 The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
29167 does not automatically flush pending output, and therefore does not test
29168 the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
29169 detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
29170 you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
29171 dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
29172 arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
29175 .vitem &*void&~*store_get(int)*&
29176 This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
29177 chunk of memory whose size is given by the argument. Exim bombs out if it ever
29178 runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
29180 .vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int)*&
29181 This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
29182 permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
29184 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
29187 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
29190 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
29191 These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
29192 The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
29193 number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
29194 and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
29195 pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
29201 .section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
29202 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
29203 No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
29204 The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
29205 recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
29206 to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
29207 message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
29210 Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
29211 data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
29212 connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
29213 one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
29215 If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
29216 in the same SMTP connection, you should set
29218 store_pool = POOL_PERM
29220 before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
29221 restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
29222 the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
29223 set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
29225 The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
29226 &'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
29227 There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
29228 block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
29235 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29236 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29238 .chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
29239 .scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
29240 .scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
29241 .scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
29242 The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
29243 that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
29244 also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
29245 they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
29247 The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
29248 is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
29249 It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
29250 commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
29251 The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
29253 The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
29254 is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
29255 the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
29256 If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
29257 of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
29258 prevent it happening on retries.
29260 .vindex "&$domain$&"
29261 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
29262 &*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
29263 specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
29264 &$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
29265 you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
29266 independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
29267 described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
29270 .section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
29271 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
29272 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
29273 The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
29274 setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
29275 other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
29276 &%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
29278 system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
29279 system_filter_user = exim
29281 If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
29282 &%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
29283 specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
29284 &%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
29285 &%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
29286 by the &%reply%& command.
29289 .section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
29290 You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
29291 filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
29292 are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
29294 If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
29295 you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
29299 .section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
29300 The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
29301 files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
29302 mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
29303 available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
29304 If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
29307 .cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
29308 There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
29309 files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
29310 is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
29311 &%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
29312 subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
29313 manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
29315 &*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
29316 specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
29317 succeed, it will not be tried again.
29318 If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
29319 arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
29321 When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
29322 &$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
29323 users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
29324 to which users' filter files can refer.
29328 .section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
29329 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
29330 The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
29331 of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
29332 filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
29336 .section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
29337 .cindex "freezing messages"
29338 .cindex "message" "freezing"
29339 .cindex "message" "forced failure"
29340 .cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
29341 .cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
29342 .cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
29343 There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
29344 always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
29345 filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
29346 for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
29347 word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
29349 fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
29351 The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
29353 The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
29354 message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
29355 and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
29356 delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
29357 that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
29360 The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
29361 not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
29362 filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
29363 is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
29365 .cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
29366 .cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
29367 The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
29368 well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
29369 up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
29370 log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
29371 two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
29372 strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
29373 message. For example:
29375 fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
29376 because it contains attachments that we are \
29377 not prepared to receive."
29380 .cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
29381 Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
29382 the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
29383 the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
29384 command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
29385 Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
29388 if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
29389 then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
29391 though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
29392 alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
29393 generated by the filter.
29395 The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
29397 &%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
29398 set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
29404 to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
29405 failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
29410 .section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
29411 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
29412 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
29413 .cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
29414 Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
29416 headers add <string>
29417 headers remove <string>
29419 The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
29420 added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
29421 filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
29422 space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
29423 forced to fail, the command has no effect.
29425 You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
29426 continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
29427 including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
29430 headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
29431 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
29434 Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
29435 be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
29436 space after input continuations is ignored.
29438 The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
29439 This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
29440 those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
29441 &'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
29442 header with the same name, they are all removed.
29444 The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
29445 of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
29446 from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
29447 modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
29448 Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
29449 used for all recipients of the message.
29451 During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
29452 header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
29453 that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
29454 routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
29455 routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
29456 until the message is actually being written (see section
29457 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
29459 If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
29460 added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
29461 present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
29462 present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
29463 message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
29464 conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
29465 modified more than once.
29467 Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
29468 use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
29471 headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
29472 headers remove "Subject"
29473 headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
29474 headers remove "Old-Subject"
29479 .section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
29480 .cindex "envelope sender"
29481 In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
29483 errors_to <some address>
29485 in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
29486 delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
29487 user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
29490 unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
29492 to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
29493 address if its delivery failed.
29497 .section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
29498 .vindex "&$domain$&"
29499 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
29500 In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
29501 delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
29502 operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
29503 such as &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used, and indeed, the choice of
29504 filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
29505 which implements such a filter:
29510 domains = +local_domains
29511 file = /central/filters/$local_part
29516 The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
29517 &%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
29518 the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
29519 use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
29521 Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
29522 specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
29523 its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
29524 address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
29526 .ecindex IIDsysfil1
29527 .ecindex IIDsysfil2
29528 .ecindex IIDsysfil3
29535 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29536 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29538 .chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
29539 .scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
29540 Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
29541 all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
29542 these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
29543 this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
29544 removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
29545 before it is placed on Exim's queue.
29547 Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
29548 &"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
29549 that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
29550 its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
29551 set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
29553 &*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
29554 or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
29555 loopback interface specially in any way.
29557 If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
29558 that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
29563 .section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
29564 .cindex "message" "submission"
29565 .cindex "submission mode"
29566 Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
29567 &%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
29568 received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
29569 state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
29571 control = submission
29573 in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
29574 &<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
29575 a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
29576 known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
29577 example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
29578 interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
29580 warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
29581 control = submission
29583 .cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
29584 There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
29585 is used to separate options. For example:
29587 control = submission/sender_retain
29589 Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
29590 true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
29591 of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
29592 the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
29593 authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
29594 &'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
29595 attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
29597 When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
29598 domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
29601 control = submission/domain=some.domain
29603 The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
29604 &<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
29605 that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
29606 &'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
29608 accept authenticated = *
29609 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
29610 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
29611 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
29613 Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
29614 option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
29615 the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
29617 bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
29619 then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
29622 Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
29624 .cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
29625 By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
29626 used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
29627 specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
29629 &*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
29630 ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
29631 untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
29632 specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
29633 does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
29634 spoof another's address.
29636 .section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
29637 .cindex "line endings"
29638 .cindex "carriage return"
29640 RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
29641 linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
29642 SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
29643 conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
29644 use CRLF or just CR.
29646 Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
29647 using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
29648 receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
29649 Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
29650 MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
29651 has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
29652 that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
29653 other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
29657 LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
29659 CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
29662 The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
29663 nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
29666 If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
29667 the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
29668 is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
29669 people trying to play silly games.
29671 If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
29672 bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
29680 .section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
29681 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
29682 .cindex "address" "qualification"
29683 By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
29684 host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
29685 SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
29686 messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
29687 requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
29689 Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
29690 sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
29691 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
29692 cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
29693 value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
29695 .oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
29696 .oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
29697 Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
29698 that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
29699 line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
29700 are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
29701 other words, such qualification is also controlled by
29702 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
29707 .section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
29708 .cindex "&""From""& line"
29709 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
29710 .cindex "sender" "address"
29711 .oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
29712 .oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
29713 .cindex "envelope sender"
29714 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
29715 Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
29716 with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
29717 &"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
29719 From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
29720 From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
29722 This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
29723 Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
29724 via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
29725 such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
29726 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
29727 and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
29728 regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
29729 default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
29730 that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
29732 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
29733 When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
29734 a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
29735 contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
29736 then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
29737 qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
29738 the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
29740 If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
29741 sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
29742 that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
29744 Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
29745 treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
29746 as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
29747 incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
29751 .section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
29752 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
29753 RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
29754 &`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
29755 recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
29756 &'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
29757 &'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
29760 &'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
29761 processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
29764 This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
29765 address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
29769 A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
29770 is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
29772 If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
29773 &%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
29774 &'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
29776 For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
29779 For a locally-submitted message,
29780 if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
29781 &'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
29782 the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
29783 included in log lines in this case.
29785 The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
29786 &%Resent-%& header lines are present.
29792 .section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
29793 Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
29794 includes the header line:
29796 Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
29799 .section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
29800 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
29801 If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
29802 message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
29803 extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
29804 existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
29807 .section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
29808 .cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
29809 If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
29810 Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
29811 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
29813 .section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
29814 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
29815 .oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
29816 &'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
29817 set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
29818 the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
29819 in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
29820 set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
29824 .section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
29825 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
29826 .oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
29827 &'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
29828 Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
29829 generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
29830 messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
29831 (the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
29835 .section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
29836 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
29837 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
29838 .cindex "message" "submission"
29839 .cindex "submission mode"
29840 If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
29841 adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
29844 The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
29845 message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
29847 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
29848 The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
29850 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
29851 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
29852 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
29854 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
29855 part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
29857 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
29858 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
29862 A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
29864 If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
29865 line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
29866 containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
29867 are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
29868 They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
29869 &%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
29870 &%qualify_domain%&.
29872 For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
29873 &'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
29874 user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
29875 name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
29878 .section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
29879 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
29880 .cindex "message" "submission"
29881 .oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
29882 If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
29883 &'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
29884 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
29885 to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
29886 creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
29887 message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
29888 followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
29889 in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
29890 &%message_id_header_domain%& options.
29893 .section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
29894 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
29895 A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
29896 contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
29897 Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
29899 The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
29900 have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
29901 line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
29902 that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
29904 Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
29905 changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
29906 -H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
29909 .section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
29910 .cindex "&'References:'& header line"
29911 Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
29912 header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
29913 section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
29914 header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
29915 responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
29916 processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
29917 than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
29918 incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
29919 11 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
29923 .section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
29924 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
29925 .oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
29926 &'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
29927 it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
29928 transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
29929 transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
29930 default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
29934 .section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
29935 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
29936 .cindex "message" "submission"
29937 For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
29938 existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
29939 these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
29940 &%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
29943 When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
29944 &%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
29945 control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
29946 &'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
29947 that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
29948 &%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
29949 be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
29950 appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
29951 line is added to the message.
29953 If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
29954 the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
29955 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
29956 options true at the same time.
29958 .cindex "submission mode"
29959 By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
29960 received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
29961 a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
29962 not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
29964 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
29965 First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
29966 authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
29967 created as follows:
29970 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
29971 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
29972 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
29974 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
29975 is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
29977 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
29978 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
29981 This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
29982 are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
29983 added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
29984 by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
29986 .cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
29987 &*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
29988 the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
29989 except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
29993 .section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
29994 "SECTheadersaddrem"
29995 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
29996 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
29997 When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
29998 specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
29999 process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
30000 modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
30001 as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
30003 In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
30004 specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
30005 addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
30006 changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
30007 transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
30008 they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
30010 &*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
30011 the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
30012 expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
30014 For both routers and transports, the result of expanding a &%headers_add%&
30015 option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
30016 newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
30018 headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
30019 X-added-second: another added header line
30021 Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
30023 The result of expanding &%headers_remove%& must consist of a colon-separated
30024 list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
30025 often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
30026 not part of the names. For example:
30028 headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
30030 When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router, its value
30031 is expanded at routing time, and then associated with all addresses that are
30032 accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
30033 an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
30034 forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
30036 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
30037 However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
30038 the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
30039 &"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
30041 Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
30042 settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
30043 dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
30046 The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
30047 with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
30048 these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
30049 recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
30050 consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
30051 names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
30052 instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
30054 After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
30055 lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
30056 the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
30057 header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
30059 This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
30060 the following consequences:
30063 The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
30064 remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
30065 to it, at all times.
30067 Header lines that are added by a router's
30068 &%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
30069 expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
30071 Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
30072 in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
30074 Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
30075 a later router or by a transport.
30077 An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
30078 removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
30080 headers_remove = subject
30081 headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
30085 &*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
30086 for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
30092 .section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
30093 .cindex "address" "constructed"
30094 .cindex "constructed address"
30095 When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
30098 <&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
30102 Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
30104 The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
30105 otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
30106 &"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
30107 ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
30108 upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
30109 &%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
30110 The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
30111 there is no password file entry.
30114 In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
30115 parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
30116 characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
30117 including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
30118 &%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
30119 characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
30120 &%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
30121 is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
30125 .section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
30126 .cindex "case of local parts"
30127 .cindex "local part" "case of"
30128 RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
30129 be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
30130 addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
30131 because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
30132 routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
30133 original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
30136 .cindex "mixed-case login names"
30137 If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
30138 assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
30139 your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
30140 correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
30144 domains = +local_domains
30145 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
30146 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
30149 For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
30150 (&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
30151 up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
30152 on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
30153 local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
30157 .section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
30158 .cindex "dot" "in local part"
30159 .cindex "local part" "dots in"
30160 RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
30161 part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
30162 middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
30163 empty components for compatibility.
30167 .section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
30168 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
30169 Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
30170 happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
30171 in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
30172 &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
30174 Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
30175 in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
30176 routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
30177 example, a header such as
30181 might get rewritten as
30183 To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
30185 Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
30186 does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
30189 Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
30190 addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
30191 result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
30192 deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
30193 immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
30194 routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
30195 .ecindex IIDmesproc
30199 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30200 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30202 .chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
30203 .scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
30204 .scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
30205 Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
30206 LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
30207 closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
30208 processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
30211 SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
30213 SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
30215 Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
30218 For mail delivery, the following are available:
30221 SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
30223 LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
30226 LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
30229 Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
30230 the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
30233 &'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
30234 stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
30235 used to contain the envelope information.
30239 .section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
30240 .cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
30241 .cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
30242 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
30243 .cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
30246 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
30247 Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
30248 The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
30249 processing is the same in both cases.
30251 If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
30252 parameter is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
30253 command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
30254 &%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
30255 such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
30256 .cindex "transport" "filter"
30257 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
30258 transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
30261 If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
30262 pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
30263 required for the transaction.
30265 If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
30266 was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
30267 server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
30269 If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
30270 the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
30271 in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
30273 .cindex "carriage return"
30275 Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
30276 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
30277 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
30280 If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
30281 characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
30282 same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
30283 even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
30284 of the &%max_rcpts%& option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
30285 they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpts%& addresses
30286 each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
30287 in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
30288 significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
30290 When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
30291 message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
30292 records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
30293 particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
30295 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
30296 Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
30297 a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
30298 See the next section for more detail about error handling.
30300 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
30301 .cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
30302 When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
30303 looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
30304 messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
30305 creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
30306 a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
30307 so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
30308 does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
30309 turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
30311 The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
30312 limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
30314 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
30315 The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
30316 identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
30317 square bracket of the IP address.
30322 .section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
30323 .cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
30324 .cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
30325 .cindex "host" "error"
30326 Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
30327 message errors, and recipient errors.
30330 .vitem "&*Host errors*&"
30331 A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
30332 particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
30335 Connection refused or timed out,
30337 Any error response code on connection,
30339 Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
30341 Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
30343 I/O errors at any time,
30345 Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
30346 the &"."& at the end of the data.
30349 For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
30350 EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
30351 error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
30352 host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
30353 the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
30354 alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
30355 host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
30356 made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
30358 .vitem "&*Message errors*&"
30359 .cindex "message" "error"
30360 A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
30361 particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
30362 message errors are:
30365 Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
30368 Timeout after MAIL,
30370 Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
30371 timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
30372 connection at any other time.
30375 For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
30376 to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
30377 temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
30378 addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
30379 a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
30380 message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
30381 that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
30382 time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
30383 affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
30384 it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
30386 If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
30387 to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
30388 over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
30391 .vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
30392 .cindex "recipient" "error"
30393 A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
30394 recipient errors are:
30397 Any error response to RCPT,
30399 Timeout after RCPT.
30402 For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
30403 recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
30404 sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
30405 address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
30406 used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
30407 routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
30408 operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
30409 to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
30410 if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
30411 (&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
30412 have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
30413 the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
30414 the retry clock is reset.
30416 The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
30417 host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
30418 other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
30419 in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
30420 proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
30421 than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
30422 if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
30423 through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
30424 recipient's retry time.
30427 In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
30428 current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
30429 tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
30430 own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
30431 until the next delivery attempt.
30433 Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
30434 MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
30435 would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
30436 host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
30437 What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
30440 The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
30441 these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
30442 procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
30443 response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
30444 it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
30445 message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
30446 helpful to treat this case as a message error.
30448 Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
30449 host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
30450 or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
30451 the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
30452 then to be treated as a host error.
30454 There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
30455 terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
30456 reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
30457 should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
30458 host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
30463 .section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
30464 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
30465 .cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
30468 Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
30469 listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
30470 &_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
30472 smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
30474 Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
30475 agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
30476 a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
30477 the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
30478 with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
30479 stream and exits with an error code.
30481 By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
30482 disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
30483 unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
30484 &%smtp_connection%& log selector.
30486 .cindex "carriage return"
30488 Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
30489 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
30490 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
30492 Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
30493 sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
30494 sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
30496 .cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
30497 .cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
30498 One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
30499 HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
30500 commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
30501 the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
30502 Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
30503 match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
30505 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
30506 .cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
30507 The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
30508 a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
30509 &%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
30510 false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
30511 &%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
30512 value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
30513 message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
30515 When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
30516 its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
30517 logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
30519 The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
30520 prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
30521 number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
30522 &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
30523 rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
30525 The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
30526 subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
30527 for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
30528 things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
30529 processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
30530 sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
30531 it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
30533 When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
30534 and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
30535 high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
30536 &%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
30537 applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
30539 Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
30540 can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
30541 &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
30542 number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
30543 SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
30544 &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
30545 subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
30546 a delivery process.
30548 The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
30549 &%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
30550 started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
30551 handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
30552 however, available with &'inetd'&.
30554 Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
30555 are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
30556 to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
30557 section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
30559 Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
30560 MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
30561 &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
30565 .section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
30566 .cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
30567 If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
30568 commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
30569 the error response to the last command. The default value for
30570 &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
30571 abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
30572 circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
30575 .section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
30576 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
30577 .cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
30578 A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
30579 something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
30580 address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
30581 sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
30582 &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
30583 drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
30584 default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
30585 broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
30589 .section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
30590 .cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
30591 The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
30592 DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
30593 many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
30594 denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
30595 client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
30596 defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
30598 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
30599 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
30600 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
30601 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
30602 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
30605 The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
30606 STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
30607 RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
30609 You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
30610 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
30611 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
30612 the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
30613 specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
30618 .section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
30619 When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
30620 runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
30621 appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
30622 If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
30624 .cindex "VRFY" "processing"
30625 When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
30626 called with the &%-bv%& option.
30628 .cindex "EXPN" "processing"
30629 When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
30630 EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
30631 than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
30632 as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
30633 of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
30634 VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
30639 .section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
30640 .cindex "ETRN" "processing"
30641 RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
30642 overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
30643 disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
30644 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
30645 should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
30647 The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
30648 delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
30649 the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
30650 text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
30651 specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
30652 the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
30653 argument. For example,
30661 which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
30662 containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
30663 default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
30664 for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
30665 a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
30667 .cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
30668 Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
30669 record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
30670 the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
30671 the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
30672 a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
30673 left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
30674 Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
30676 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
30677 For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
30678 used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
30679 whatever the form of its argument. For
30682 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
30683 $sender_host_address
30685 .vindex "&$domain$&"
30686 The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
30687 expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
30688 and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
30689 wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
30690 under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
30691 for it to change them before running the command.
30695 .section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
30696 .cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
30697 Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
30698 standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
30699 line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
30700 &%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
30701 messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
30702 sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
30703 an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
30704 identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
30705 runs for RCPT commands:
30709 This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
30713 .section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
30714 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
30715 .cindex "batched SMTP output"
30716 Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
30717 batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
30718 be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
30719 delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
30720 envelope along with the message.
30722 The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
30723 MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
30724 the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
30725 HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
30726 can be used to specify it.
30728 Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
30729 one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
30730 to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
30731 this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
30732 chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
30735 When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
30736 sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
30737 transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
30742 driver = manualroute
30743 transport = smtp_appendfile
30744 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
30748 driver = appendfile
30749 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
30754 This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
30755 format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
30756 message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
30760 .section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
30761 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
30762 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
30763 The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
30764 reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
30765 is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
30766 sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
30767 rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
30768 and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
30769 as NOOP; QUIT quits.
30771 No policy checking is done for BSMTP input. That is, no ACL is run at anytime.
30772 In this respect it is like non-SMTP local input.
30774 If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
30775 the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
30776 standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
30777 make some use of automatically, for example:
30779 554 Unexpected end of file
30780 Transaction started in line 10
30781 Error detected in line 14
30783 It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
30786 An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
30787 The error message was:
30789 501 '>' missing at end of address
30791 The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
30792 The error was detected in line 12.
30793 The SMTP command at fault was:
30795 rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
30797 1 previous message was successfully processed.
30798 The rest of the batch was abandoned.
30800 The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
30801 messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
30803 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
30804 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
30808 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30809 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30811 .chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
30812 "Customizing messages"
30813 When a message fails to be delivered, or remains on the queue for more than a
30814 configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
30815 to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
30816 the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
30817 string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
30819 The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
30820 cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
30821 option. Exim also adds the line
30823 Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
30825 to all warning and bounce messages,
30828 .section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
30829 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
30830 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
30831 If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
30832 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
30833 delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
30834 &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
30836 When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
30837 constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
30838 separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
30839 opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
30840 logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
30843 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
30844 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
30845 Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
30846 expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
30847 the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
30848 &$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
30849 option, rounded to a whole number.
30851 The items must appear in the file in the following order:
30854 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
30855 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
30857 The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
30858 failing addresses with their error messages.
30860 The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
30861 returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
30863 The fourth item is used to introduce the copy of the message that is returned
30864 as part of the error report.
30866 The fifth item is added after the fourth one if the returned message is
30867 truncated because it is bigger than &%return_size_limit%&.
30869 The sixth item is added after the copy of the original message.
30872 The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
30873 following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
30874 other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
30876 Subject: Mail delivery failed
30877 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
30878 {: returning message to sender}}
30880 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
30882 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
30883 {that you sent }{sent by
30887 }}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
30888 This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
30890 The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
30892 ------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
30895 ------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
30897 ------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
30900 .section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
30901 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
30902 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
30903 The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
30904 warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
30908 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
30909 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
30911 The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
30912 the delayed addresses.
30914 The third item then ends the message.
30917 The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
30918 have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
30920 Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
30921 $warn_message_delay
30923 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
30925 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
30926 {that you sent }{sent by
30930 }}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
30931 more than $warn_message_delay on the queue on $primary_hostname.
30933 The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
30934 The subject of the message is: $h_subject
30935 The date of the message is: $h_date
30937 The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
30939 No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
30940 continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
30941 intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
30942 mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
30943 the message will be returned to you.
30945 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
30946 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
30947 However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
30948 appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
30949 &$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
30950 minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
30951 of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
30952 multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
30958 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30959 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30961 .chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
30962 This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
30963 common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
30967 .section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
30968 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
30969 If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
30970 should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
30971 routing explicitly:
30973 send_to_smart_host:
30974 driver = manualroute
30975 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
30976 transport = remote_smtp
30978 You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
30979 If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
30980 receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
30981 synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
30982 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
30987 .section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
30988 .cindex "mailing lists"
30989 Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
30990 requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
30991 Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
30993 The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
30994 is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
30995 independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
30996 lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
31000 domains = lists.example
31001 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
31004 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
31007 This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
31008 in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
31009 such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
31010 routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
31012 The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
31013 expanded into a file name or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
31016 .oindex "&%errors_to%&"
31017 The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
31018 taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
31019 original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
31020 the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
31022 For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
31023 &'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
31024 &_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
31025 &'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
31026 There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
31027 the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
31028 such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
31029 or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
31030 &%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
31034 .section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
31035 .cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
31036 If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
31037 delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
31038 list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
31039 list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
31040 addresses are not rigorously checked.
31042 If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
31043 entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
31044 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
31045 whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
31046 &%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
31050 .section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
31051 .cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
31052 Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
31053 in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
31054 recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
31055 cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
31056 delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
31057 account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
31058 the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
31059 message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
31061 If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
31062 on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
31063 router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
31064 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
31065 &"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
31066 subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
31067 failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
31068 pre-existing messages.
31070 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
31071 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
31072 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
31073 &%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
31074 one level of expansion anyway.
31078 .section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
31079 .cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
31080 The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
31081 send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
31082 from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
31083 &%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
31085 The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
31086 of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
31090 domains = lists.example
31091 local_part_suffix = -request
31092 file = /usr/lists/$local_part$local_part_suffix
31097 domains = lists.example
31098 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
31099 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
31100 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
31103 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
31108 domains = lists.example
31110 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
31112 All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
31113 they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
31114 &%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
31117 The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
31118 checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
31119 checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
31120 necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
31121 because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
31122 not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
31123 means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
31124 &%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
31125 &"unrouteable address"& error.
31127 The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
31128 a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
31129 the address, giving a suitable error message.
31134 .section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
31136 .cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
31137 .cindex "envelope sender"
31138 Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(http://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
31139 are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
31140 address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
31141 the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
31142 if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
31143 original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
31145 .oindex &%errors_to%&
31146 .oindex &%return_path%&
31147 Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
31148 facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
31149 list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
31150 these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
31151 host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
31152 of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
31153 of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
31159 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
31160 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
31162 This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
31163 SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
31164 &"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
31165 local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
31166 example, that a message whose return path has been set to
31167 &'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
31168 &'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
31171 somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
31173 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
31174 For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
31175 have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
31176 achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
31177 might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
31178 &$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
31180 Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
31181 probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
31182 extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
31183 can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
31187 domains = ! +local_domains
31189 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
31190 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
31193 If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
31194 of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
31195 routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
31196 errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
31199 On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
31200 &(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
31201 SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
31202 and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
31203 of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
31207 domains = ! +local_domains
31208 transport = remote_smtp
31210 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
31211 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
31214 Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
31215 configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
31216 Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
31217 router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
31220 The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
31221 message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
31222 host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
31223 a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
31224 a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
31225 than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
31233 .section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
31234 .cindex "virtual domains"
31235 .cindex "domain" "virtual"
31236 The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
31240 A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
31241 aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
31242 top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
31244 One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
31245 with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
31246 have login accounts on that host.
31249 The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
31250 the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
31251 aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
31252 virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
31253 whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
31254 to a router of this form:
31258 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
31259 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain}}
31262 The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
31263 is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
31264 domain that is being processed. When the router runs, it looks up the local
31265 part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
31266 setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
31267 string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
31269 This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias file names
31270 follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
31271 can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
31272 a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
31274 The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
31275 way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
31276 valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
31280 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
31281 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
31282 transport = my_mailboxes
31284 The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
31285 can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
31286 file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
31287 option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
31288 because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
31292 driver = appendfile
31293 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part
31296 This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
31297 required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
31299 The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
31300 requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
31301 up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
31302 information about the domains.
31306 .section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
31307 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
31308 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
31309 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
31310 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
31311 Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
31312 incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
31313 allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
31314 identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
31315 parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
31316 &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
31317 example, consider this router:
31322 file = $home/.forward
31323 local_part_suffix = -*
31324 local_part_suffix_optional
31327 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
31328 It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
31329 &'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
31330 cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
31332 if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
31333 save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
31336 If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
31337 fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
31338 &%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
31339 control over which suffixes are valid.
31341 Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
31342 &_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
31348 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
31349 local_part_suffix = -*
31350 local_part_suffix_optional
31353 If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
31354 example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
31355 does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
31356 subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
31357 &_.forward_& file to use as a default.
31361 .section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
31362 .cindex "vacation processing"
31363 The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
31364 a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
31365 (see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
31366 This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
31367 that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
31370 A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
31371 can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
31372 alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
31373 &_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
31375 spqr, vacation-spqr
31378 The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
31379 vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
31380 user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
31381 ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
31382 to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
31386 Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
31387 use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
31391 .section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
31392 .cindex "message" "copying every"
31393 Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
31394 be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
31395 command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
31396 each day's messages.
31398 There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
31399 messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
31400 delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
31401 notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
31405 .section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
31406 .cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
31407 It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
31408 Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
31409 arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
31410 permanently connected.
31412 Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
31413 particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
31414 Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
31417 .section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
31418 It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
31419 host to remain on Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
31420 approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
31421 being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
31422 some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
31423 to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
31424 resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
31426 A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
31427 intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
31428 into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
31429 format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
31430 destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
31431 in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
31434 On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
31435 you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
31436 intermittent host. For example:
31438 cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
31440 This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
31441 which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
31442 online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
31443 options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
31444 causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
31445 connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
31448 If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
31449 issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
31450 mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
31451 used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
31452 avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
31453 Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
31454 arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
31458 .section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
31459 The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
31460 increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
31461 connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
31462 delivered immediately.
31464 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
31465 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
31466 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
31467 Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
31468 not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
31469 possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
31470 each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
31471 avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
31472 &%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
31473 first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
31474 normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
31475 destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
31476 single SMTP connection.
31480 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31481 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31483 .chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
31484 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
31485 .cindex "client, non-queueing"
31486 .cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
31487 On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
31488 email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
31489 configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
31490 However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
31491 configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
31492 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
31495 If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
31496 run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
31497 any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
31498 continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
31499 email is not desirable.
31501 There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
31502 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
31503 any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
31504 host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
31505 informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
31506 to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
31507 to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
31509 There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
31510 that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
31511 ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
31512 before sending a message to the smart host.
31514 Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
31515 tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
31516 overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
31518 .oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
31519 There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
31520 Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
31521 assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
31522 just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
31523 compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
31524 router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
31526 When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
31530 A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
31531 In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
31533 Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
31534 assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
31535 &%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
31536 does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
31537 successful, a zero return code is given.
31539 Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
31540 be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
31541 the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
31542 must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
31543 deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
31546 If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
31547 failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
31548 successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
31550 Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
31551 is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
31552 smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
31553 the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
31554 there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
31556 If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
31557 connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
31558 failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
31560 When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
31561 (as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
31562 value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
31563 are ever generated.
31565 No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
31567 A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
31568 true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
31569 &%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
31572 The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
31573 the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
31574 deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
31575 privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
31576 to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
31577 the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
31582 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31583 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31585 .chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
31586 .scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
31587 .cindex "log" "types of"
31588 Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
31593 The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
31594 line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
31595 down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
31596 out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
31597 them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
31598 they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
31599 analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
31600 &<<SECTmailstat>>&).
31602 .cindex "reject log"
31603 The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
31604 of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
31605 The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
31606 the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
31607 is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
31608 lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
31609 reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
31610 host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
31611 can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
31614 .cindex "panic log"
31615 .cindex "system log"
31616 When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
31617 error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
31618 are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
31619 other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
31620 therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
31621 regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
31622 panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
31623 is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
31624 message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
31627 Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
31628 example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
31629 In the log file, this would be all on one line:
31631 2001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
31634 By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
31635 ways of changing this:
31638 You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
31643 the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
31645 If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
31648 2003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
31652 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
31653 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
31654 Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
31655 request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
31656 &<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
31657 brackets, immediately after the time and date.
31662 .section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
31663 .cindex "log" "destination"
31664 .cindex "log" "to file"
31665 .cindex "log" "to syslog"
31667 The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
31668 should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
31669 are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
31670 arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
31671 It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
31672 need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
31673 Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
31675 The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
31676 &_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the run time
31677 configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
31678 references to the host name:
31680 log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
31682 It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
31683 rather than at run time, because then the setting is available right from the
31684 start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
31685 before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
31686 configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
31689 The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
31690 list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
31691 facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
31692 colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
31693 otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
31694 point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
31695 implying the use of a default path.
31697 When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
31698 LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
31699 &"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
31700 mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
31701 files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
31702 equivalent to the setting:
31704 log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
31706 If you do not specify anything at build time or run time, that is where the
31709 A log file path may also contain &`%D`& if datestamped log file names are in
31710 use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
31712 Here are some examples of possible settings:
31714 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
31715 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
31716 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
31717 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
31719 If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
31724 .section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
31725 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
31726 .cindex "cycling logs"
31727 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
31728 .cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
31729 Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
31730 log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
31731 provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
31732 main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
31733 keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
31735 An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
31736 and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
31737 example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
31738 message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
31739 that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
31740 something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
31741 ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
31742 &[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
31743 does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
31744 tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
31745 for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
31750 .section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
31751 .cindex "log" "datestamped files"
31752 Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
31753 periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
31754 for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_&.
31755 Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting the
31756 &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& at the point where the
31757 datestamp is required. For example:
31759 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
31760 log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
31761 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
31763 As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
31764 examples of names generated by the above examples:
31766 /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
31767 /var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
31768 /var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
31770 When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
31771 files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
31772 will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
31773 run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
31775 The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
31776 is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
31777 When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& is removed from the string.
31778 In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following non-alphanumeric
31779 character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric character is
31780 removed. Thus, the three examples above would give these panic log names:
31782 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
31783 /var/log/exim-panic.log
31784 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
31788 .section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
31789 .cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
31790 The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
31791 except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
31792 Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
31793 that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
31794 &"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
31795 by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
31796 &%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
31797 SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
31798 &_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
31799 LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
31800 the time and host name to each line.
31801 The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
31804 &'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
31806 &'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
31808 &'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
31811 Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
31812 written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
31813 these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
31814 by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
31816 Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
31817 entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
31818 these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
31819 calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
31820 870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
31821 additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
31822 replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
31823 RFC 3164, you should set
31825 SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
31827 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
31828 lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
31830 To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
31831 entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
31832 where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
31833 components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
31834 because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
31835 delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
31836 870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
31837 &'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
31838 name, and pid as added by syslog:
31840 [1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
31841 [2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
31842 [3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
31843 [4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
31846 The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
31849 [1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
31850 [2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
31851 [3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
31852 [4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
31854 [6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
31855 [7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
31856 [8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
31857 [9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
31858 [10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
31859 [11\18] 09:43 +0100
31861 [13\18] Subject: this is a test header
31862 [18\18] X-something: this is another header
31863 [15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
31866 [18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
31868 Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
31869 without modification.
31871 If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
31872 display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
31873 the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
31878 .section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
31879 One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
31880 successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
31881 picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
31882 timestamp. The flags are:
31884 &`<=`& message arrival
31885 &`=>`& normal message delivery
31886 &`->`& additional address in same delivery
31887 &`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
31888 &`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
31889 &`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
31893 .section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
31894 .cindex "log" "reception line"
31895 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
31896 message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
31897 several lines in order to fit it on the page:
31899 2002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
31900 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
31901 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
31903 The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
31904 bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
31905 generated, this is followed by an item of the form
31909 which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
31913 For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
31914 record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
31915 received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
31916 host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
31917 above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
31918 &%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
31919 by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
31920 verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
31921 EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
31922 name in parentheses.
31924 Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
31925 without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
31926 the log containing text like these examples:
31928 H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
31929 H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
31931 This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
31934 For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
31935 the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
31938 .cindex "authentication" "logging"
31939 .cindex "AUTH" "logging"
31940 For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
31941 message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
31942 of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
31943 extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
31944 session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
31945 suite that was used.
31947 The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
31948 hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
31949 value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
31950 there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
31951 was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
31952 &%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
31953 authenticator name.
31955 .cindex "size" "of message"
31956 The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
31957 received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
31958 headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
31959 message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
31962 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
31963 data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
31967 .section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
31968 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
31969 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
31970 delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
31971 deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into two lines in order
31972 to fit it on the page:
31974 2002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
31975 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
31976 2002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
31977 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
31978 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
31980 For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
31981 after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
31982 intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
31983 last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
31984 fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
31986 If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
31987 for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
31989 &`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
31991 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
31992 parentheses afterwards.
31994 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
31995 When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
31996 SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
31997 flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
31998 down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the IP address in the log
31999 lines for the second and subsequent messages.
32001 The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
32002 &"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
32004 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
32005 data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
32008 .section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
32009 .cindex "discarded messages"
32010 .cindex "message" "discarded"
32011 .cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
32012 When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
32013 obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
32015 2002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
32016 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
32018 is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
32019 because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
32021 1999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
32022 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
32026 .section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
32027 When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
32029 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
32030 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
32032 In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
32033 last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
32034 written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
32036 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
32037 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
32039 When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
32040 a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
32041 appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
32045 .section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
32046 .cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
32047 If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
32048 following form is logged:
32050 1995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
32051 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
32053 If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
32054 the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
32056 2002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
32057 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
32058 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
32059 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
32060 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
32062 The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
32063 used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
32064 disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
32065 flagged with &`**`&.
32069 .section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
32070 .cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
32071 If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
32072 used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
32073 &"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
32077 .section "Completion" "SECID257"
32080 2002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
32082 is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
32083 at the end of its processing.
32088 .section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
32089 .cindex "log" "summary of fields"
32090 A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
32091 the following table:
32093 &`A `& authenticator name (and optional id)
32094 &`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
32095 &` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
32096 &`CV `& certificate verification status
32097 &`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
32098 &`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
32099 &`DT `& on &`=>`& lines: time taken for a delivery
32100 &`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
32101 &`H `& host name and IP address
32102 &`I `& local interface used
32103 &`id `& message id for incoming message
32104 &`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
32105 &` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
32106 &`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
32107 &` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
32108 &`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
32109 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
32110 &`S `& size of message
32111 &`ST `& shadow transport name
32112 &`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
32113 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
32114 &`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
32115 &`X `& TLS cipher suite
32119 .section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
32120 Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
32121 self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
32124 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
32125 &'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
32126 during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
32127 This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
32128 during the first delivery attempt.
32130 &'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
32131 temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
32132 for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
32134 .cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
32135 &'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
32136 some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
32137 common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
32138 &'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
32141 .cindex "error" "ignored"
32142 &'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
32145 Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
32146 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
32148 A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
32149 failed. The delivery was discarded.
32151 A delivery set up by a router configured with
32152 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
32153 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
32157 failed. The delivery was discarded.
32165 .section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
32166 .cindex "log" "selectors"
32167 By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
32168 default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
32169 &%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
32172 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
32174 The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
32175 selection marked by asterisks:
32177 &`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
32178 &` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
32179 &` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
32180 &` arguments `& command line arguments
32181 &`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
32182 &`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
32183 &` deliver_time `& time taken to perform delivery
32184 &` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
32185 &`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
32186 &`*etrn `& ETRN commands
32187 &`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
32188 &` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
32189 &` incoming_interface `& incoming interface on <= lines
32190 &` incoming_port `& incoming port on <= lines
32191 &`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
32192 &` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
32193 &`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
32194 &` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
32195 &` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
32196 &` pid `& Exim process id
32197 &` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
32198 &` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
32199 &`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
32200 &`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
32201 &` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
32202 &` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
32203 &`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
32204 &`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
32205 &`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
32206 &` smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
32207 &` smtp_connection `& SMTP connections
32208 &` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
32209 &` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
32210 &` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
32211 &` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
32212 &` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
32213 &` tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
32214 &`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
32215 &` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
32216 &` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
32218 &` all `& all of the above
32220 More details on each of these items follows:
32223 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
32224 &%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
32225 its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
32226 this log selector is set.
32228 .cindex "log" "rewriting"
32229 .cindex "rewriting" "logging"
32230 &%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
32231 rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
32232 such users cannot access the log).
32234 .cindex "log" "full parentage"
32235 &%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
32236 delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
32237 parentheses between them.
32239 .cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
32240 .cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
32241 &%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
32242 to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
32243 feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
32244 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
32245 privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
32246 that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
32247 are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
32248 because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
32249 only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
32250 between the caller and Exim.
32252 .cindex "log" "connection rejections"
32253 &%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
32254 connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
32256 .cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
32257 .cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
32258 &%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
32259 started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
32260 messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
32261 process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
32263 .cindex "log" "delivery duration"
32264 &%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
32265 perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
32267 .cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
32268 .cindex "size" "of message"
32269 &%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
32270 the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
32272 .cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
32273 .cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
32274 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
32275 &%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
32276 DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
32278 .cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
32279 .cindex "ETRN" "logging"
32280 &%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
32281 is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
32282 command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
32283 selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
32285 .cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
32286 &%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
32287 any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
32288 log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
32289 routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
32291 .cindex "log" "ident timeout"
32292 .cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
32293 &%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
32294 client's ident port times out.
32296 .cindex "log" "incoming interface"
32297 .cindex "interface" "logging"
32298 &%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
32299 to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
32300 followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
32301 added to other SMTP log lines, for example &"SMTP connection from"&, and to
32304 .cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
32305 .cindex "port" "logging remote"
32306 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
32307 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
32308 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
32309 &%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
32310 added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
32311 in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
32312 changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
32313 &$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
32314 important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
32316 .cindex "log" "dropped connection"
32317 &%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
32318 connection is unexpectedly dropped.
32320 .cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
32321 .cindex "port" "logging outgoint remote"
32322 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging ougtoing remote port"
32323 &%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
32324 containing => tags) following the IP address. This option is not included in
32325 the default setting, because for most ordinary configurations, the remote port
32326 number is always 25 (the SMTP port).
32328 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
32329 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
32330 &%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
32331 immediately after the time and date.
32333 .cindex "log" "queue run"
32334 .cindex "queue runner" "logging"
32335 &%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
32337 .cindex "log" "queue time"
32338 &%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
32339 local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
32340 &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
32341 includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
32342 This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
32343 delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
32344 message has been successfully received.
32346 &%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
32347 the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
32348 example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
32349 message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
32351 .cindex "log" "recipients"
32352 &%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
32353 as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
32354 that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
32355 addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
32357 Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
32360 .cindex "log" "sender reception"
32361 &%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
32362 the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
32363 &"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
32365 .cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
32366 &%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
32367 rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
32368 log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
32369 rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
32371 .cindex "log" "retry defer"
32372 &%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
32373 retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
32374 message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
32377 .cindex "log" "return path"
32378 &%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
32379 the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
32380 This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
32381 or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
32383 .cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
32384 &%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
32385 and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
32386 This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
32387 necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
32389 .cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
32390 &%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
32391 gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
32392 the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
32395 .cindex "log" "size rejection"
32396 &%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
32399 .cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
32400 .cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
32401 &%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
32402 queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
32404 .cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
32405 The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
32407 .cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
32408 .cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
32409 &%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP dialogue for
32410 outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
32411 A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
32414 .cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
32415 .cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
32416 &%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an SMTP connection is
32417 established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
32418 &%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
32419 only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
32420 processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
32421 dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
32422 not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
32423 of connections unless this selector is enabled.
32425 For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
32426 included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
32427 reset if the daemon is restarted.
32428 Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
32429 subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
32430 whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
32431 match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
32432 logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
32434 .cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
32435 .cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
32436 &%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
32437 RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
32438 and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
32439 line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
32441 .cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
32442 .cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
32443 &%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
32444 connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
32445 the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
32446 does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
32447 an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
32448 already have their own log lines.
32450 The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
32451 way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
32452 If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
32453 an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
32454 DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
32455 the same logging options.
32457 Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
32458 is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
32462 shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
32463 than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
32464 the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
32465 setting of 10 for &%smtp_accep_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
32466 have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
32468 .cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
32469 .cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
32470 &%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
32471 encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
32472 because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
32473 been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
32474 it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
32475 received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
32477 .cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
32478 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
32479 .cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
32480 .cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
32481 .cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
32482 &%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
32483 encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
32484 external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
32485 using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
32487 .cindex "log" "subject"
32488 .cindex "subject, logging"
32489 &%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
32490 preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
32491 Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
32492 specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
32493 unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
32495 .cindex "log" "certificate verification"
32496 &%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
32497 when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
32498 verified, and &`CV=no`& if not.
32500 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
32501 .cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
32502 &%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
32503 connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
32505 .cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
32506 .cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
32507 &%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
32508 connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
32509 added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
32511 .cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
32512 &%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
32513 result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
32517 .section "Message log" "SECID260"
32518 .cindex "message" "log file for"
32519 .cindex "log" "message log; description of"
32520 .cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
32521 .oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
32522 In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
32523 that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
32524 they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
32525 message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
32526 makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
32527 to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
32528 is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
32529 only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
32531 On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
32532 per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
32533 &%message_logs%& option false.
32539 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32540 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32542 .chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
32543 .scindex IIDutils "utilities"
32544 A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
32545 described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
32546 the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
32548 .itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
32549 .irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
32550 "list what Exim processes are doing"
32551 .irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
32552 .irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
32553 .irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
32554 .irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
32556 .irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
32557 .irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
32558 "extract statistics from the log"
32559 .irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
32560 "check address acceptance from given IP"
32561 .irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
32562 .irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
32563 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
32564 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
32565 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
32566 .irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
32569 Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
32570 &'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
32571 &url(http://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
32576 .section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
32577 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
32578 .cindex "process, querying"
32580 On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
32581 (most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
32582 a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
32583 Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
32584 processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
32585 second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
32586 order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
32587 send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
32589 &*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
32590 use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
32591 script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
32594 Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
32595 varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
32596 but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
32597 system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
32598 it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
32601 &`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
32602 &`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
32603 &`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
32604 &`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
32606 An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
32608 164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
32609 10483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
32610 10492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
32611 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
32612 10592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
32613 10628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
32615 The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
32616 been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
32620 .section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
32621 .cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
32622 .cindex "queue" "grepping"
32623 This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
32627 to obtain a queue listing with undelivered recipients only, and then greps the
32628 output to select messages that match given criteria. The following selection
32629 options are available:
32632 .vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
32633 Match the sender address. The field that is tested is enclosed in angle
32634 brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
32638 .vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
32639 Match a recipient address. The field that is tested is not enclosed in angle
32642 .vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
32643 Match against the size field.
32645 .vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
32646 Match messages that are younger than the given time.
32648 .vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
32649 Match messages that are older than the given time.
32652 Match only frozen messages.
32655 Match only non-frozen messages.
32658 The following options control the format of the output:
32662 Display only the count of matching messages.
32665 Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
32669 Display message ids only.
32672 Brief format &-- one line per message.
32675 Display messages in reverse order.
32678 There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
32682 .section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
32683 .cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
32684 .cindex "queue" "summary"
32685 The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
32686 -bp`& and produces a summary of the messages on the queue. Thus, you use it by
32687 running a command such as
32689 exim -bp | exiqsumm
32691 The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
32692 it, as in the following example:
32694 3 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
32696 Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
32697 volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
32698 been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
32699 number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
32701 A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
32702 domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
32703 the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
32704 respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
32705 domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
32706 separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
32709 The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
32710 this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
32711 generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
32712 option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
32713 level"& addresses).
32718 .section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
32720 .cindex "&'exigrep'&"
32721 .cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
32722 The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
32723 files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
32724 extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
32725 match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
32726 given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
32727 The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
32728 If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
32729 included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
32731 &`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
32733 If no log file names are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
32735 The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
32736 condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
32737 they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds on the queue.
32739 By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
32740 makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
32741 large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
32742 option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
32743 case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
32745 The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
32746 pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
32747 regular expression.
32749 The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
32750 if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
32752 If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
32753 ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
32754 whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
32757 .section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
32758 .cindex "&'exipick'&"
32759 John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
32760 lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
32761 of &'exipick'&'s facilities, visit the web page at
32762 &url(http://www.exim.org/eximwiki/ToolExipickManPage) or run &'exipick'& with
32763 the &%--help%& option.
32766 .section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
32767 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
32768 .cindex "cycling logs"
32769 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
32770 The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
32771 &'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
32772 you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
32773 &<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
32774 for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
32775 There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
32777 &%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
32778 default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
32780 &%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
32781 &%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
32782 overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
32786 Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the file names get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
32787 the main log file name is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
32788 run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
32789 &_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
32790 &%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
32791 logs are handled similarly.
32793 If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
32794 &_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
32795 to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
32796 any existing log files.
32798 If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
32799 the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
32800 using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
32801 setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
32802 root &%crontab%& entry of the form
32804 1 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
32806 assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
32807 &'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
32811 .section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
32812 .cindex "statistics"
32813 .cindex "&'eximstats'&"
32814 A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
32815 information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
32816 Exim log files are also supported by the &'Lire'& system produced by the
32817 LogReport Foundation &url(http://www.logreport.org).
32819 The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
32820 latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
32821 lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
32822 various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
32823 list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
32825 eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
32827 By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
32828 messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
32829 both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
32830 are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
32831 addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
32832 options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
32833 also produced per user.
32835 The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
32836 histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
32837 hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
32838 example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
32839 as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
32841 Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
32842 have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
32843 messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
32844 and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
32845 recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
32846 an entirely separate message.
32848 &'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
32849 of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
32850 each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
32851 not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
32852 least one address that failed.
32854 The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
32855 or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
32856 transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
32857 (default per hour), information about the time messages spent on the queue,
32858 a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
32859 senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
32860 and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
32862 The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
32863 came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
32864 without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
32866 There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
32867 outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
32868 by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
32870 perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
32873 .section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
32874 .cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
32875 .cindex "policy control" "checking access"
32876 .cindex "checking access"
32877 The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
32878 debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
32879 policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
32880 familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
32881 sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
32882 access?"& without bothering with any further details.
32884 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
32885 two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
32887 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
32889 The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
32890 given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
32891 connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
32892 is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
32895 550 Relay not permitted
32897 When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
32898 for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
32899 options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
32900 that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
32903 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
32904 -f himself@there.example
32906 Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
32907 mandatory arguments.
32909 Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
32910 while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
32911 &%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
32915 .section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
32916 .cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
32917 .cindex "building DBM files"
32918 .cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
32919 .cindex "lower casing"
32920 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
32921 The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
32922 the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
32923 &<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
32924 names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
32925 can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
32927 A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
32928 the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
32929 &'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
32930 strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
32933 The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
32934 single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
32935 It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
32939 If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
32940 configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two file
32941 names must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions create
32942 a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
32944 exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
32946 reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
32947 &_/etc/aliases.db_&.
32949 In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
32950 Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
32951 environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
32952 &'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
32953 when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
32954 recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the file name.
32956 If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
32957 finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
32958 option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
32959 this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
32960 &%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
32961 There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
32962 &%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
32968 .section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
32969 .cindex "retry" "times"
32970 .cindex "&'exinext'&"
32971 A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
32972 fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
32973 complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
32974 information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
32975 is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
32976 output. For example:
32978 $ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
32979 kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
32980 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
32981 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
32982 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
32983 roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
32984 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
32985 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
32986 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
32987 past final cutoff time
32989 You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
32990 will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
32991 A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
32992 message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
32993 suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
32994 &'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
32997 The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
32998 of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
32999 passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
33000 configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
33001 file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
33002 environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
33006 .section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
33007 .cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
33008 .cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
33009 Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
33010 uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
33011 arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
33012 second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
33015 &'retry'&: the database of retry information
33017 &'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
33020 &'callout'&: the callout cache
33022 &'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
33024 &'misc'&: other hints data
33027 The &'misc'& database is used for
33030 Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
33032 Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
33033 &(smtp)& transport)
33038 .section "exim_dumpdb" "SECID261"
33039 .cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
33040 The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
33041 &'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
33042 spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
33044 exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
33046 Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
33048 T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
33049 31-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
33051 The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
33052 of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
33053 transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
33054 a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
33055 address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
33056 transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
33057 to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
33058 and a textual description of the error.
33060 The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
33061 the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
33062 ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
33065 Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
33066 consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
33067 waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
33068 one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
33069 may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
33070 may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
33075 .section "exim_tidydb" "SECID262"
33076 .cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
33077 The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
33078 database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
33079 days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
33080 updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
33081 since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
33082 for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
33083 updated sufficiently often.
33085 The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
33086 followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
33087 the retry database:
33089 exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
33091 Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
33092 message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
33093 they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
33094 are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
33095 types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
33096 message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
33097 queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
33098 &'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
33099 For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
33100 removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
33101 whenever it removes information from the database.
33103 Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
33104 needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
33105 down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
33106 first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
33107 records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
33109 It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
33110 hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
33111 a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
33112 work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
33113 but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
33114 After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
33115 point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
33118 &*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
33119 databases is likely to keep on increasing.
33124 .section "exim_fixdb" "SECID263"
33125 .cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
33126 The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
33127 Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
33128 getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
33129 is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
33130 key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
33133 If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
33134 except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
33135 out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
33136 data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
33137 by new data, for example:
33141 resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
33142 sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
33143 used as optional separators.
33148 .section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
33149 .cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
33150 .cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
33151 .cindex "locking mailboxes"
33152 The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
33153 Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
33154 &'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
33155 a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
33156 the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
33157 argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
33158 second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
33159 is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
33160 is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
33164 Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
33167 Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
33170 .vitem &%-interval%&
33171 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
33172 interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
33174 .vitem &%-lockfile%&
33175 Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
33178 Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
33181 Suppress verification output.
33183 .vitem &%-retries%&
33184 This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
33185 the lock (default 10).
33187 .vitem &%-restore_time%&
33188 This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
33189 locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
33190 example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
33193 .vitem &%-timeout%&
33194 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
33195 timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
33196 default), a non-blocking call is used.
33199 Generate verbose output.
33202 If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
33203 default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
33204 mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
33205 &%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
33206 requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
33207 file does not last for ever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
33208 more than 30 minutes old.
33210 The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
33211 &%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
33212 to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
33213 &_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
33214 number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
33215 can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
33217 The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
33218 &%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
33219 suppresses all output except error messages.
33223 exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
33225 runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
33227 &`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
33228 <&'some commands'&>
33231 runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
33232 suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
33235 exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
33236 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
33238 Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
33239 second argument &-- hence the quotes.
33243 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33244 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33246 .chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
33247 .scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
33248 .cindex "X-windows"
33249 .cindex "&'eximon'&"
33250 .cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
33251 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
33252 The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
33253 about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
33254 perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
33255 such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
33256 monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
33260 .section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
33261 The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
33262 script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
33263 binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
33264 be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
33265 &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
33266 parameters are for.
33268 The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
33269 a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
33270 preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
33272 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
33274 (in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
33275 the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
33276 overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
33277 &'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
33278 syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
33280 X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
33281 way. For example, a resource setting of the form
33283 Eximon*background: gray94
33285 changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
33286 stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
33287 black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
33288 data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
33289 &"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
33290 For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
33291 reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
33294 Eximon*highlight: gray
33297 .cindex "admin user"
33298 In order to see the contents of messages on the queue, and to operate on them,
33299 &'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
33301 The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
33302 more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
33303 main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
33304 delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
33305 different parts of the display.
33310 .section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
33311 .cindex "stripchart"
33312 The first stripchart is always a count of messages on the queue. Its name can
33313 be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
33314 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
33315 configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
33316 it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
33317 hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
33318 received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
33319 period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
33320 parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
33322 The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
33323 displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
33324 title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
33325 For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
33327 It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
33328 a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
33329 to a single partition.
33331 .cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
33332 This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
33333 the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
33334 this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
33335 100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
33336 SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
33337 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
33342 .section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
33343 .cindex "size" "of monitor window"
33344 .cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
33345 .cindex "window size"
33346 Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
33347 to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
33348 shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
33349 stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
33350 the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
33351 in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
33353 When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
33354 currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
33355 size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
33356 remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
33358 The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
33359 stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
33360 the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
33361 The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
33362 &'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
33363 the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
33365 Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
33366 built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
33367 START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
33371 .section "The log display" "SECID267"
33372 .cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
33373 The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
33374 the main log is maintained.
33375 To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
33376 removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
33377 The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
33378 syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
33379 to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
33381 The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
33382 move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
33383 scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
33384 LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
33385 to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
33386 much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
33387 a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
33388 only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
33389 available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
33390 normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
33391 configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
33393 Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
33394 and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
33395 respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
33396 It cannot go further back up the log.
33398 The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
33399 normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
33400 by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
33401 by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
33402 back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
33403 the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
33405 Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
33406 There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
33407 the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
33408 happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
33409 &"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
33410 ^C is typed the search is cancelled.
33412 The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
33413 widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
33414 &"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
33415 eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
33416 However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
33417 provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
33418 come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
33419 unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
33420 on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
33425 .section "The queue display" "SECID268"
33426 .cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
33427 The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
33428 are on the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
33429 as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
33430 parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
33431 at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
33432 the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
33433 there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
33434 to force an update of the queue display at any time.
33436 When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
33437 and this can make it hard to deal with other messages on the queue. To help
33438 with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
33439 pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
33440 type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
33441 such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
33442 of the texts, the message is not displayed.
33444 If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
33445 are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
33446 example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
33447 &'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
33448 has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
33449 cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
33450 a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
33452 While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
33453 else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
33454 queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
33455 pressing the &"Hide"& button.
33457 The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
33458 time it has been on the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
33459 message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
33460 a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
33461 recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
33462 listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
33463 an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
33466 .cindex "frozen messages" "display"
33467 If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
33469 The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
33470 of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
33471 The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
33472 available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
33473 display is updated.
33477 .section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
33478 .cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
33479 If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
33480 pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
33481 line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
33484 If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
33485 MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
33486 set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
33487 value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
33488 run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
33490 EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
33492 The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
33496 &'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
33497 in a new text window.
33499 &'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
33500 information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
33501 &<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
33503 &'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
33504 displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
33505 amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
33506 option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at run time.
33508 &'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
33509 delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
33510 frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
33511 a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
33512 up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
33514 &'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
33515 that the message be frozen.
33517 .cindex "thawing messages"
33518 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
33519 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
33520 &'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
33521 that the message be thawed.
33523 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
33524 &'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
33525 that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
33526 for any remaining undelivered addresses.
33528 &'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
33529 that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
33532 &'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
33533 be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
33534 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
33535 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
33536 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
33537 additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
33538 which case no action is taken.
33540 &'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
33541 can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
33542 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
33543 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
33544 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
33545 recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
33546 case no action is taken.
33548 &'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
33549 mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
33551 &'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
33552 sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
33553 &%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
33554 in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
33555 bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
33556 not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
33557 the address is qualified with that domain.
33560 When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
33561 other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
33562 particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
33563 output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
33564 from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
33565 &_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
33566 if no output is generated.
33568 The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
33569 thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
33570 &_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
33571 force an update of the display after one of these actions.
33573 In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
33574 cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
33575 and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
33582 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33583 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33585 .chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
33586 .scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
33587 This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
33588 which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
33590 For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
33591 Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
33592 existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
33593 chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
33594 security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
33595 its security as compared with other MTAs.
33597 What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
33598 have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
33599 absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
33600 as soon as possible.
33603 .section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
33604 .cindex "security" "build-time features"
33605 There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
33606 to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
33607 Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
33608 penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
33611 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
33612 start of any file names used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these file
33613 names are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if the
33614 value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
33615 &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
33616 default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
33618 If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
33619 which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
33620 into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
33621 configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
33623 If ALT_CONFIG_ROOT_ONLY is defined, root privilege is retained for &%-C%&
33624 and &%-D%& only if the caller of Exim is root. Without it, the Exim user may
33625 also use &%-C%& and &%-D%& and retain privilege. Setting this option locks out
33626 the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message
33627 reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by
33628 that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain
33629 privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost.
33630 However, root can test reception and delivery using two separate commands.
33631 ALT_CONFIG_ROOT_ONLY is not set by default.
33633 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
33636 FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
33637 never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
33638 option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
33639 to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
33640 is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
33646 .section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
33648 .cindex "root privilege"
33649 The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
33650 privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
33651 example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
33652 may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
33653 discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
33654 is required for two things:
33657 To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
33658 the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
33661 To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
33662 perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
33666 It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
33667 receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
33668 obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
33669 For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
33670 &_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
33671 group"&. Their values can be changed by the run time configuration, though this
33672 is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
33673 &'mail'& or another user name altogether.
33675 Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
33676 abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
33677 &[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
33679 After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
33680 uid and gid in the following cases:
33685 If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
33686 the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
33687 calling process is not running as root or the Exim user, the uid and gid are
33688 changed to those of the calling process.
33689 However, if ALT_CONFIG_ROOT_ONLY is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, only
33690 root callers may use &%-C%& and &%-D%& without losing privilege, and if
33691 DISABLE_D_OPTION is set, the &%-D%& option may not be used at all.
33696 If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
33697 (&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
33700 If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
33701 process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
33702 uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
33703 runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
33704 testing address verification
33707 (the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
33710 For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
33711 remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
33714 The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
33717 A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
33718 user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
33719 function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
33720 will be used during message reception.
33722 A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
33723 job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
33725 A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
33726 but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
33727 subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
33728 deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
33729 remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
33730 subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
33731 while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
33732 generating bounce and warning messages.
33734 While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
33735 process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
33736 this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
33737 gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
33739 A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
33740 the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
33746 .section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
33747 .cindex "privilege, running without"
33748 .cindex "unprivileged running"
33749 .cindex "root privilege" "running without"
33750 Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
33751 operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
33752 by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
33753 gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
33754 (and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
33755 routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
33759 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
33760 Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
33761 that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
33762 correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
33764 An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
33765 to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
33766 process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
33767 when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
33768 SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
33770 It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
33771 stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
33772 been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
33775 If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
33776 set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
33777 to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
33779 In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
33780 those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
33781 Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
33782 that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
33783 discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
33784 have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
33785 number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
33786 address this problem at this time.
33788 For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
33789 is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
33790 &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
33791 be used in the most straightforward way.
33793 If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
33794 number of restrictions on what you can do:
33797 You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
33798 &%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
33799 normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
33800 work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
33801 explicit specification of another user causes an error.
33803 Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
33804 not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
33806 Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
33807 the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
33808 and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
33809 enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
33811 Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
33812 some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
33815 They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
33816 implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
33817 mode of the mailbox files themselves.
33819 You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
33820 owned by the Exim user.
33822 You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
33823 on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
33824 mailboxes need to be created manually.
33829 These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
33830 However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
33831 gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
33832 gives more security at essentially no cost.
33834 If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
33835 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
33840 .section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
33841 Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
33842 are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
33846 .section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
33847 .cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
33848 .cindex "IP source routing"
33849 Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
33850 some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
33851 IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
33852 IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
33856 .section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
33857 Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
33858 be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
33863 .section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
33864 .cindex "trusted users"
33865 .cindex "admin user"
33866 .cindex "privileged user"
33867 .cindex "user" "trusted"
33868 .cindex "user" "admin"
33869 Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
33870 able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
33871 addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
33872 local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
33873 permit a remote host to be specified.
33876 However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
33877 in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
33878 message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
33879 but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
33880 permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
33881 the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
33883 Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
33884 other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
33885 the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
33886 as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
33887 group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
33889 Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
33890 can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
33891 them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
33892 the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
33893 includes the contents of files on the spool.
33897 By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
33898 delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
33899 restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
33900 Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
33901 queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
33902 setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
33904 Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
33905 the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
33906 the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
33907 group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
33908 the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
33909 unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
33914 .section "Spool files" "SECID275"
33915 .cindex "spool directory" "files"
33916 Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
33917 set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
33918 &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
33919 any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
33923 .section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
33924 Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
33925 of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
33926 with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
33927 to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
33932 .section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
33933 The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
33934 are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
33935 Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
33940 .section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
33941 Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
33942 to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
33943 does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
33944 arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
33948 .section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
33949 .cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
33950 A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
33951 &'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
33952 The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
33953 that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
33954 conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
33956 The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
33957 the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
33962 .section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
33963 Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
33964 formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
33965 the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
33969 .section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
33970 These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
33971 enough to hold the result.
33972 .ecindex IIDsecurcon
33977 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33978 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33980 .chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
33981 .scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
33982 .scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
33983 .scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
33984 .cindex "spool files" "editing"
33985 A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
33986 followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
33987 the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
33988 kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
33989 two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
33990 is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
33991 themselves are recoverable.
33993 Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
33994 need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
33995 on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
33998 You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
33999 fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
34000 which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
34001 place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
34002 lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
34004 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
34005 If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
34006 &$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect. At
34007 present, this value is not used by Exim, but there is no guarantee that this
34008 will always be the case.
34010 If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
34012 If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
34015 All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
34017 Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
34018 its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
34019 files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
34020 the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
34021 the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
34022 is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
34023 file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
34024 -J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
34027 .section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
34028 .cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
34029 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
34030 The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
34031 process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
34032 gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
34033 message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
34034 normally the Exim user.
34036 The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
34037 transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
34038 empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
34039 in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
34040 created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
34041 &%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
34042 leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
34043 &"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
34045 The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
34046 was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
34047 start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
34048 warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
34050 There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
34051 order, and are omitted when not relevant:
34054 .vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
34055 This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
34056 &%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
34057 recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
34058 this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
34059 identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
34060 the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
34061 the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
34062 the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
34065 .vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
34066 A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
34067 defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
34068 The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
34069 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
34070 character. It may contain internal newlines.
34072 .vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
34073 A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
34074 Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
34075 length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
34076 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
34077 character. It may contain internal newlines.
34079 .vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
34080 This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
34081 &$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
34083 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
34084 This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
34085 lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
34086 transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
34087 messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
34089 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
34090 This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
34091 (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
34092 time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
34093 hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
34095 .vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
34096 The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
34097 &-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
34099 .vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
34100 The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
34101 &$authenticated_sender$& variable.
34103 .vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
34104 This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is always
34107 .vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
34108 This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
34109 present if the number is greater than zero.
34111 .vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
34112 This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
34113 file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
34115 .vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
34116 .cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
34117 The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
34119 .vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
34120 This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
34123 .vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
34124 This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
34125 the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
34128 .vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
34129 If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
34130 the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
34131 &$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
34133 .vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
34134 This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
34135 address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
34137 .vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
34138 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
34139 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
34140 This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
34141 if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
34142 received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
34144 .vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
34145 For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
34146 unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
34147 ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
34148 supplied by the remote host, if any.
34150 .vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
34151 This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
34152 which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
34153 generated messages.
34156 The message is from a local sender.
34158 .vitem &%-localerror%&
34159 The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
34161 .vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
34162 This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
34163 when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
34164 variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
34166 .vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
34167 The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
34168 Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
34171 A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
34172 actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
34175 .vitem &%-received_protocol%&
34176 This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
34177 the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
34179 .vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
34180 The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
34181 to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
34183 .vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
34184 If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
34185 of &$spam_score_int$&.
34187 .vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
34188 A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
34189 certificate was verified by the server.
34191 .vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
34192 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
34193 name of the cipher suite that was used.
34195 .vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
34196 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
34197 was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
34201 Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
34202 is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
34203 line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
34204 is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
34205 the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
34206 balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
34207 to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
34208 original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
34209 addresses are complete.
34211 If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
34212 the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
34213 Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
34214 tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
34215 right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
34216 follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
34218 YY darcy@austen.fict.example
34219 NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
34220 NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
34222 After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
34223 This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
34224 recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
34225 delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
34229 editor@thesaurus.ref.example
34230 darcy@austen.fict.example
34232 alice@wonderland.fict.example
34234 However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
34235 result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
34236 line is of the following form:
34238 <&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
34239 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
34241 The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
34242 the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
34243 fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
34244 original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
34245 envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
34246 length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
34247 characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
34248 that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
34251 A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
34252 which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
34253 when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
34254 character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
34255 embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
34259 .row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
34260 .row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
34261 .row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
34262 .row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
34263 .row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
34264 .row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
34265 .row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
34266 .row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
34267 .row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
34268 .row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
34271 Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
34272 purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
34273 typical set of headers:
34275 111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
34276 id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
34277 049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
34278 038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
34279 042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
34280 049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
34281 099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
34282 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
34283 104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
34284 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
34285 038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
34287 The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
34288 &'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
34289 unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
34290 .ecindex IIDforspo1
34291 .ecindex IIDforspo2
34292 .ecindex IIDforspo3
34294 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34295 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34297 .chapter "Support for DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail) - RFC4871" "CHID12" &&&
34301 Since version 4.70, DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default. It can be
34302 disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in Local/Makefile.
34304 Exim's DKIM implementation allows to
34306 Sign outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
34307 It can co-exist with all other Exim features, including transport filters.
34309 Verify signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
34310 ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
34311 different signature context.
34314 In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
34315 default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
34316 Exim's standard controls.
34318 Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
34319 on by default for logging purposes. For each signature in incoming email,
34320 exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
34321 signature status. Here is an example:
34323 2009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM: d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
34325 You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
34326 or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
34327 control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
34328 where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
34332 .section "Signing outgoing messages" "SECID513"
34333 .cindex "DKIM" "signing"
34335 Signing is implemented by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
34336 These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
34338 .option dkim_domain smtp string&!! unset
34340 The domain you want to sign with. The result of this expanded
34341 option is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable.
34343 .option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
34345 This sets the key selector string. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion
34346 variable to look up a matching selector. The result is put in the expansion
34347 variable &%$dkim_selector%& which should be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
34348 option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
34350 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
34352 This sets the private key to use. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
34353 &%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
34354 The result can either
34356 be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor, including line breaks.
34358 start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
34361 be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
34362 be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
34366 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
34368 This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
34369 The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
34370 The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
34371 only supports using the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
34373 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
34375 This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
34376 should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
34377 either "1" or "true", Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
34378 unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
34381 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! unset
34383 When set, this option must expand to (or be specified as) a colon-separated
34384 list of header names. Headers with these names will be included in the message
34385 signature. When unspecified, the header names recommended in RFC4871 will be
34389 .section "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" "SECID514"
34390 .cindex "DKIM" "verification"
34392 Verification of DKIM signatures in incoming email is implemented via the
34393 &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL. By default, this ACL is called once for each
34394 syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
34396 To evaluate the signature in the ACL a large number of expansion variables
34397 containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
34398 runtime of the ACL.
34400 Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
34401 more advanced policies. For that reason, the global option
34402 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, and a global expansion variable
34403 &%$dkim_signing_domains%& exist.
34405 The global option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
34406 list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
34407 called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
34408 the expansion variable &%$dkim_signing_domains%& already contains a colon-
34409 separated list of signer domains for the message. When &%dkim_verify_signers%&
34410 is not specified in the main configuration, it defaults as:
34412 dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signing_domains
34414 This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
34415 DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
34416 call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
34418 dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signing_domains
34420 This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
34421 and "ebay.com", plus all domains that have signatures in the message. You can
34422 also be more creative in constructing your policy. Example:
34424 dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signing_domains
34427 Inside the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&, the following expansion variables are
34428 available (from most to least important):
34431 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
34432 A string describing the general status of the signature. One of
34434 &%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
34437 &%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
34438 More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
34440 &%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
34441 available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
34443 &%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
34445 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
34446 A string giving a litte bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
34447 "fail" or "invalid". One of
34449 &%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
34450 key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
34452 &%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
34453 record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
34455 &%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
34456 body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
34457 means that the message body was modified in transit.
34459 &%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
34460 could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
34461 re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
34462 DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
34464 .vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
34465 The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
34466 ab actual signature in the message. It does NOT neccessarily carry the
34467 domain that is currently being evaluated. Please use the &%dkim_signers%& ACL
34468 condition for that.
34469 .vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
34470 The signing identity. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
34471 ab actual signature in the message. It does NOT neccessarily carry the
34472 identity that is currently being evaluated. Please use the &%dkim_signers%& ACL
34473 condition for that.
34474 .vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
34475 The key record selector string
34476 .vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
34477 The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
34478 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
34479 The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
34480 .vitem &%dkim_canon_headers%&
34481 The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
34482 .vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
34483 A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
34484 (copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
34485 .vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
34486 The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
34487 limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
34488 that this variable always expands to an integer value.
34489 .vitem &%$dkim_created%&
34490 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
34491 When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
34492 .vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
34493 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
34494 signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
34495 signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
34496 integer size comparisons against this value.
34497 .vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
34498 A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
34499 .vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
34500 "1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
34501 .vitem &%$dkim_key_nosubdomaining%&
34502 "1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
34503 .vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
34504 Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
34506 .vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
34507 Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
34509 .vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
34510 Notes from the key record (tag n=)
34513 In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
34516 .vitem &%dkim_signers%&
34517 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
34518 for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying.
34519 This is typically used to restrict an ACL verb to a group of domains or identities, like:
34522 # Warn when message apparently from GMail has no signature at all
34523 warn log_message = GMail sender without DKIM signature
34524 sender_domains = gmail.com
34525 dkim_signers = gmail.com
34529 .vitem &%dkim_status%&
34530 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
34531 results agains the actual result of verification. This is typically used
34532 to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, like:
34535 deny message = Message from Paypal with invalid or missing signature
34536 sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
34537 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
34538 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
34541 The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
34542 see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
34543 for more information of what they mean.
34547 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34548 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34550 .chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
34551 "Adding drivers or lookups"
34552 .cindex "adding drivers"
34553 .cindex "new drivers, adding"
34554 .cindex "drivers" "adding new"
34555 The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
34556 authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
34559 Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
34560 existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
34562 Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
34564 <&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
34566 where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
34567 code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
34568 should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
34570 Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
34572 #define <type>_NEWDRIVER
34575 Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
34576 and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
34578 Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
34579 &_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
34580 driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
34582 Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
34585 Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
34586 as for other drivers and lookups.
34589 Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
34590 proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
34591 occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
34592 options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
34593 searched using a binary chop procedure.
34595 There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
34596 the interface that is expected.
34601 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34602 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34604 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34605 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
34606 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
34607 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
34609 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34614 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
34615 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
34619 .makeindex "Options index" "option"
34620 .makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
34621 .makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
34624 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34625 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////